(x_draw_phys_cursor_glyph): Take into account that a box
[bpt/emacs.git] / src / xterm.c
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2 Copyright (C) 1989, 93, 94, 95, 96, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002
3 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
6
7 GNU Emacs is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
10 any later version.
11
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs; see the file COPYING. If not, write to
19 the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330,
20 Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
21
22 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
23 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
24
25 #include <config.h>
26
27 /* On 4.3 these lose if they come after xterm.h. */
28 /* Putting these at the beginning seems to be standard for other .c files. */
29 #include <signal.h>
30
31 #include <stdio.h>
32
33 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
34
35 #include "lisp.h"
36 #include "blockinput.h"
37
38 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
39 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
40 #include "syssignal.h"
41
42 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
43 if this is not done before the other system files. */
44 #include "xterm.h"
45 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
46
47 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
48 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
49 #ifndef makedev
50 #include <sys/types.h>
51 #endif /* makedev */
52
53 #ifdef BSD_SYSTEM
54 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
55 #endif /* ! defined (BSD_SYSTEM) */
56
57 #include "systty.h"
58 #include "systime.h"
59
60 #ifndef INCLUDED_FCNTL
61 #include <fcntl.h>
62 #endif
63 #include <ctype.h>
64 #include <errno.h>
65 #include <setjmp.h>
66 #include <sys/stat.h>
67 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
68 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
69
70 #include "charset.h"
71 #include "coding.h"
72 #include "ccl.h"
73 #include "frame.h"
74 #include "dispextern.h"
75 #include "fontset.h"
76 #include "termhooks.h"
77 #include "termopts.h"
78 #include "termchar.h"
79 #include "gnu.h"
80 #include "disptab.h"
81 #include "buffer.h"
82 #include "window.h"
83 #include "keyboard.h"
84 #include "intervals.h"
85 #include "process.h"
86 #include "atimer.h"
87 #include "keymap.h"
88
89 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
90 #include <X11/Shell.h>
91 #endif
92
93 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
94 #include <sys/time.h>
95 #endif
96 #ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H
97 #include <unistd.h>
98 #endif
99
100 #ifdef USE_LUCID
101 extern int xlwmenu_window_p (Widget w, Window window);
102 extern void xlwmenu_redisplay P_ ((Widget));
103 #endif
104
105 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
106
107 extern void free_frame_menubar P_ ((struct frame *));
108 extern struct frame *x_menubar_window_to_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
109 int));
110
111 #if (XtSpecificationRelease >= 5) && !defined(NO_EDITRES)
112 #define HACK_EDITRES
113 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages ();
114 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
115
116 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
117
118 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
119 #if defined USE_MOTIF
120 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
121 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
122 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
123
124 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
125 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
126 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
127 #define ARROW_SCROLLBAR
128 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ScrollbarP.h>
129 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
130 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
131 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
132 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
133 #ifndef XtNpickTop
134 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
135 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
136 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
137 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
138
139 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
140
141 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
142 #define x_any_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
143 #define x_top_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
144 #endif
145
146 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
147 #include "widget.h"
148 #ifndef XtNinitialState
149 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
150 #endif
151 #endif
152
153 #define abs(x) ((x) < 0 ? -(x) : (x))
154
155 #define BETWEEN(X, LOWER, UPPER) ((X) >= (LOWER) && (X) < (UPPER))
156
157 \f
158 /* Fringe bitmaps. */
159
160 enum fringe_bitmap_type
161 {
162 NO_FRINGE_BITMAP,
163 LEFT_TRUNCATION_BITMAP,
164 RIGHT_TRUNCATION_BITMAP,
165 OVERLAY_ARROW_BITMAP,
166 CONTINUED_LINE_BITMAP,
167 CONTINUATION_LINE_BITMAP,
168 ZV_LINE_BITMAP
169 };
170
171 /* Bitmap drawn to indicate lines not displaying text if
172 `indicate-empty-lines' is non-nil. */
173
174 #define zv_width 8
175 #define zv_height 72
176 #define zv_period 3
177 static unsigned char zv_bits[] = {
178 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00,
179 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00,
180 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00,
181 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00,
182 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00,
183 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00,
184 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00,
185 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00};
186
187 /* An arrow like this: `<-'. */
188
189 #define left_width 8
190 #define left_height 8
191 static unsigned char left_bits[] = {
192 0x18, 0x0c, 0x06, 0x3f, 0x3f, 0x06, 0x0c, 0x18};
193
194 /* Right truncation arrow bitmap `->'. */
195
196 #define right_width 8
197 #define right_height 8
198 static unsigned char right_bits[] = {
199 0x18, 0x30, 0x60, 0xfc, 0xfc, 0x60, 0x30, 0x18};
200
201 /* Marker for continued lines. */
202
203 #define continued_width 8
204 #define continued_height 8
205 static unsigned char continued_bits[] = {
206 0x3c, 0x7c, 0xc0, 0xe4, 0xfc, 0x7c, 0x3c, 0x7c};
207
208 /* Marker for continuation lines. */
209
210 #define continuation_width 8
211 #define continuation_height 8
212 static unsigned char continuation_bits[] = {
213 0x3c, 0x3e, 0x03, 0x27, 0x3f, 0x3e, 0x3c, 0x3e};
214
215 /* Overlay arrow bitmap. */
216
217 #if 0
218 /* A bomb. */
219 #define ov_width 8
220 #define ov_height 8
221 static unsigned char ov_bits[] = {
222 0x30, 0x08, 0x3c, 0x7e, 0x7a, 0x7a, 0x62, 0x3c};
223 #else
224 /* A triangular arrow. */
225 #define ov_width 8
226 #define ov_height 8
227 static unsigned char ov_bits[] = {
228 0x03, 0x0f, 0x1f, 0x3f, 0x3f, 0x1f, 0x0f, 0x03};
229
230 #endif
231
232 extern Lisp_Object Qhelp_echo;
233
234 \f
235 /* Non-nil means Emacs uses toolkit scroll bars. */
236
237 Lisp_Object Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars;
238
239 /* If a string, XTread_socket generates an event to display that string.
240 (The display is done in read_char.) */
241
242 static Lisp_Object help_echo;
243 static Lisp_Object help_echo_window;
244 static Lisp_Object help_echo_object;
245 static int help_echo_pos;
246
247 /* Temporary variable for XTread_socket. */
248
249 static Lisp_Object previous_help_echo;
250
251 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
252 start. */
253
254 static int any_help_event_p;
255
256 /* Non-zero means autoselect window with the mouse cursor. */
257
258 int mouse_autoselect_window;
259
260 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
261 static Lisp_Object last_window;
262
263 /* Non-zero means draw block and hollow cursor as wide as the glyph
264 under it. For example, if a block cursor is over a tab, it will be
265 drawn as wide as that tab on the display. */
266
267 int x_stretch_cursor_p;
268
269 /* Non-zero means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties. */
270
271 int x_use_underline_position_properties;
272
273 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
274 use. */
275
276 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
277
278 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
279 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
280 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
281 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
282
283 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
284
285 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
286 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
287 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
288 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
289
290 extern struct frame *updating_frame;
291
292 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
293
294 struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
295
296 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
297 /* The application context for Xt use. */
298 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
299 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
300 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
301
302 /* Nominal cursor position -- where to draw output.
303 HPOS and VPOS are window relative glyph matrix coordinates.
304 X and Y are window relative pixel coordinates. */
305
306 struct cursor_pos output_cursor;
307
308 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
309
310 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
311
312 /* Mouse movement.
313
314 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
315 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
316 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
317 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
318
319 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
320
321 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
322 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
323 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
324 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
325 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
326 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
327 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
328 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
329 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
330 is off. */
331
332 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
333
334 FRAME_PTR last_mouse_frame;
335 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
336 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
337
338 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
339
340 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
341 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
342 an ordinary motion.
343
344 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
345 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
346 event. */
347
348 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
349
350 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
351 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
352 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
353 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
354 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
355 it's somewhat accurate. */
356
357 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
358
359 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
360 events. */
361
362 #ifdef __STDC__
363 static int volatile input_signal_count;
364 #else
365 static int input_signal_count;
366 #endif
367
368 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
369
370 static int x_noop_count;
371
372 /* Initial values of argv and argc. */
373
374 extern char **initial_argv;
375 extern int initial_argc;
376
377 extern Lisp_Object Vcommand_line_args, Vsystem_name;
378
379 /* Tells if a window manager is present or not. */
380
381 extern Lisp_Object Vx_no_window_manager;
382
383 extern Lisp_Object Qface, Qmouse_face;
384
385 extern int errno;
386
387 /* A mask of extra modifier bits to put into every keyboard char. */
388
389 extern EMACS_INT extra_keyboard_modifiers;
390
391 /* The keysyms to use for the various modifiers. */
392
393 Lisp_Object Vx_alt_keysym, Vx_hyper_keysym, Vx_meta_keysym, Vx_super_keysym;
394 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
395
396 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
397 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1, Qutf_8;
398
399 extern XrmDatabase x_load_resources P_ ((Display *, char *, char *, char *));
400 extern Lisp_Object x_icon_type P_ ((struct frame *));
401
402
403 /* Enumeration for overriding/changing the face to use for drawing
404 glyphs in x_draw_glyphs. */
405
406 enum draw_glyphs_face
407 {
408 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT,
409 DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO,
410 DRAW_CURSOR,
411 DRAW_MOUSE_FACE,
412 DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED,
413 DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
414 };
415
416 static int cursor_in_mouse_face_p P_ ((struct window *));
417 static int clear_mouse_face P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
418 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 P_ ((Display *, Colormap, XColor *));
419 static void x_set_window_size_1 P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
420 static const XColor *x_color_cells P_ ((Display *, int *));
421 static void x_update_window_end P_ ((struct window *, int, int));
422 static void frame_to_window_pixel_xy P_ ((struct window *, int *, int *));
423 void x_delete_display P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
424 static unsigned int x_x_to_emacs_modifiers P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
425 unsigned));
426 static int fast_find_position P_ ((struct window *, int, int *, int *,
427 int *, int *, Lisp_Object));
428 static int fast_find_string_pos P_ ((struct window *, int, Lisp_Object,
429 int *, int *, int *, int *, int));
430 static void set_output_cursor P_ ((struct cursor_pos *));
431 static struct glyph *x_y_to_hpos_vpos P_ ((struct window *, int, int,
432 int *, int *, int *, int));
433 static void note_mode_line_or_margin_highlight P_ ((struct window *, int,
434 int, int));
435 static void note_mouse_highlight P_ ((struct frame *, int, int));
436 static void note_tool_bar_highlight P_ ((struct frame *f, int, int));
437 static void x_handle_tool_bar_click P_ ((struct frame *, XButtonEvent *));
438 static void show_mouse_face P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
439 enum draw_glyphs_face));
440 static int x_io_error_quitter P_ ((Display *));
441 int x_catch_errors P_ ((Display *));
442 void x_uncatch_errors P_ ((Display *, int));
443 void x_lower_frame P_ ((struct frame *));
444 void x_scroll_bar_clear P_ ((struct frame *));
445 int x_had_errors_p P_ ((Display *));
446 void x_wm_set_size_hint P_ ((struct frame *, long, int));
447 void x_raise_frame P_ ((struct frame *));
448 void x_set_window_size P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
449 void x_wm_set_window_state P_ ((struct frame *, int));
450 void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap P_ ((struct frame *, int));
451 void x_initialize P_ ((void));
452 static void x_font_min_bounds P_ ((XFontStruct *, int *, int *));
453 static int x_compute_min_glyph_bounds P_ ((struct frame *));
454 static void x_draw_phys_cursor_glyph P_ ((struct window *,
455 struct glyph_row *,
456 enum draw_glyphs_face));
457 static void x_update_end P_ ((struct frame *));
458 static void XTframe_up_to_date P_ ((struct frame *));
459 static void XTset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
460 static void XTreset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
461 static void XTcursor_to P_ ((int, int, int, int));
462 static void x_write_glyphs P_ ((struct glyph *, int));
463 static void x_clear_end_of_line P_ ((int));
464 static void x_clear_frame P_ ((void));
465 static void x_clear_cursor P_ ((struct window *));
466 static void frame_highlight P_ ((struct frame *));
467 static void frame_unhighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
468 static void x_new_focus_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *, struct frame *));
469 static void XTframe_rehighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
470 static void x_frame_rehighlight P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
471 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *));
472 static void x_draw_bar_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
473 enum text_cursor_kinds));
474 static int x_intersect_rectangles P_ ((XRectangle *, XRectangle *,
475 XRectangle *));
476 static void expose_frame P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int, int));
477 static int expose_window_tree P_ ((struct window *, XRectangle *));
478 static int expose_window P_ ((struct window *, XRectangle *));
479 static void expose_area P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *,
480 XRectangle *, enum glyph_row_area));
481 static int expose_line P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *,
482 XRectangle *));
483 static void x_update_cursor_in_window_tree P_ ((struct window *, int));
484 static void x_update_window_cursor P_ ((struct window *, int));
485 static void x_erase_phys_cursor P_ ((struct window *));
486 void x_display_and_set_cursor P_ ((struct window *, int, int, int, int, int));
487 static void x_draw_fringe_bitmap P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *,
488 enum fringe_bitmap_type, int left_p));
489
490 static void x_clip_to_row P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *,
491 GC, int));
492 static int x_phys_cursor_in_rect_p P_ ((struct window *, XRectangle *));
493 static void x_draw_row_fringe_bitmaps P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *));
494 static void notice_overwritten_cursor P_ ((struct window *, enum glyph_row_area,
495 int, int, int, int));
496 static void x_flush P_ ((struct frame *f));
497 static void x_update_begin P_ ((struct frame *));
498 static void x_update_window_begin P_ ((struct window *));
499 static void x_draw_vertical_border P_ ((struct window *));
500 static void x_after_update_window_line P_ ((struct glyph_row *));
501 static INLINE void take_vertical_position_into_account P_ ((struct it *));
502 static void x_produce_stretch_glyph P_ ((struct it *));
503 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar P_ ((Window));
504 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion P_ ((struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
505 enum scroll_bar_part *,
506 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
507 unsigned long *));
508 static void x_check_fullscreen P_ ((struct frame *));
509 static void x_check_fullscreen_move P_ ((struct frame *));
510
511 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
512
513 static void
514 x_flush (f)
515 struct frame *f;
516 {
517 BLOCK_INPUT;
518 if (f == NULL)
519 {
520 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
521 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
522 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
523 }
524 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
525 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
526 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
527 }
528
529
530 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
531 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
532 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
533 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
534 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
535 performance. */
536
537 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
538
539 \f
540 /***********************************************************************
541 Debugging
542 ***********************************************************************/
543
544 #if 0
545
546 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
547 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
548
549 struct record
550 {
551 char *locus;
552 int type;
553 };
554
555 struct record event_record[100];
556
557 int event_record_index;
558
559 record_event (locus, type)
560 char *locus;
561 int type;
562 {
563 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
564 event_record_index = 0;
565
566 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
567 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
568 event_record_index++;
569 }
570
571 #endif /* 0 */
572
573
574 \f
575 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
576
577 struct x_display_info *
578 x_display_info_for_display (dpy)
579 Display *dpy;
580 {
581 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
582
583 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
584 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
585 return dpyinfo;
586
587 return 0;
588 }
589
590
591 \f
592 /***********************************************************************
593 Starting and ending an update
594 ***********************************************************************/
595
596 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
597 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
598 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
599 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
600 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
601
602 static void
603 x_update_begin (f)
604 struct frame *f;
605 {
606 /* Nothing to do. */
607 }
608
609
610 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
611 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
612 position of W. */
613
614 static void
615 x_update_window_begin (w)
616 struct window *w;
617 {
618 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
619 struct x_display_info *display_info = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
620
621 updated_window = w;
622 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
623
624 BLOCK_INPUT;
625
626 if (f == display_info->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
627 {
628 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
629 display_info->mouse_face_defer = 1;
630
631 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
632 highlighting. */
633 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
634 display_info->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
635
636 #if 0 /* Rows in a current matrix containing glyphs in mouse-face have
637 their mouse_face_p flag set, which means that they are always
638 unequal to rows in a desired matrix which never have that
639 flag set. So, rows containing mouse-face glyphs are never
640 scrolled, and we don't have to switch the mouse highlight off
641 here to prevent it from being scrolled. */
642
643 /* Can we tell that this update does not affect the window
644 where the mouse highlight is? If so, no need to turn off.
645 Likewise, don't do anything if the frame is garbaged;
646 in that case, the frame's current matrix that we would use
647 is all wrong, and we will redisplay that line anyway. */
648 if (!NILP (display_info->mouse_face_window)
649 && w == XWINDOW (display_info->mouse_face_window))
650 {
651 int i;
652
653 for (i = 0; i < w->desired_matrix->nrows; ++i)
654 if (MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (w->desired_matrix, i))
655 break;
656
657 if (i < w->desired_matrix->nrows)
658 clear_mouse_face (display_info);
659 }
660 #endif /* 0 */
661 }
662
663 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
664 }
665
666
667 /* Draw a vertical window border to the right of window W if W doesn't
668 have vertical scroll bars. */
669
670 static void
671 x_draw_vertical_border (w)
672 struct window *w;
673 {
674 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
675
676 /* Redraw borders between horizontally adjacent windows. Don't
677 do it for frames with vertical scroll bars because either the
678 right scroll bar of a window, or the left scroll bar of its
679 neighbor will suffice as a border. */
680 if (!WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
681 && !FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
682 {
683 int x0, x1, y0, y1;
684
685 window_box_edges (w, -1, &x0, &y0, &x1, &y1);
686 x1 += FRAME_X_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f);
687 y1 -= 1;
688
689 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
690 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x1, y0, x1, y1);
691 }
692 }
693
694
695 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
696
697 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
698 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
699
700 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
701 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
702 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
703
704 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
705 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
706 here. */
707
708 static void
709 x_update_window_end (w, cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p)
710 struct window *w;
711 int cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p;
712 {
713 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
714
715 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
716 {
717 BLOCK_INPUT;
718
719 if (cursor_on_p)
720 x_display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
721 output_cursor.vpos,
722 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
723
724 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
725 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
726 }
727
728 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
729 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
730 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
731 {
732 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
733 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
734 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
735 }
736
737 updated_window = NULL;
738 }
739
740
741 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
742 update_end. */
743
744 static void
745 x_update_end (f)
746 struct frame *f;
747 {
748 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
749 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
750
751 BLOCK_INPUT;
752 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
753 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
754 }
755
756
757 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
758 complete update has been performed. The global variable
759 updated_window is not available here. */
760
761 static void
762 XTframe_up_to_date (f)
763 struct frame *f;
764 {
765 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
766 {
767 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
768
769 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
770 || f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
771 {
772 BLOCK_INPUT;
773 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
774 note_mouse_highlight (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
775 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
776 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
777 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
778 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
779 }
780 }
781 }
782
783
784 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
785 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
786 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
787 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
788 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
789 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
790
791 static void
792 x_after_update_window_line (desired_row)
793 struct glyph_row *desired_row;
794 {
795 struct window *w = updated_window;
796 struct frame *f;
797 int width, height;
798
799 xassert (w);
800
801 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
802 {
803 BLOCK_INPUT;
804 x_draw_row_fringe_bitmaps (w, desired_row);
805 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
806 }
807
808 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
809 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
810 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
811 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
812 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
813 overhead is very small. */
814 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
815 && desired_row->full_width_p
816 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
817 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
818 width != 0)
819 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
820 height > 0))
821 {
822 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
823
824 /* Internal border is drawn below the tool bar. */
825 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
826 && w == XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window))
827 y -= width;
828
829 BLOCK_INPUT;
830 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
831 0, y, width, height, False);
832 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
833 f->output_data.x->pixel_width - width,
834 y, width, height, False);
835 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
836 }
837 }
838
839
840 /* Draw the bitmap WHICH in one of the left or right fringes of
841 window W. ROW is the glyph row for which to display the bitmap; it
842 determines the vertical position at which the bitmap has to be
843 drawn. */
844
845 static void
846 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (w, row, which, left_p)
847 struct window *w;
848 struct glyph_row *row;
849 enum fringe_bitmap_type which;
850 int left_p;
851 {
852 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
853 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
854 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
855 int x, y, wd, h, dy;
856 int b1, b2;
857 unsigned char *bits = NULL;
858 Pixmap pixmap;
859 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
860 struct face *face;
861 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
862
863 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
864 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc, 1);
865
866 /* Convert row to frame coordinates. */
867 y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
868
869 switch (which)
870 {
871 case NO_FRINGE_BITMAP:
872 wd = 0;
873 h = 0;
874 break;
875
876 case LEFT_TRUNCATION_BITMAP:
877 wd = left_width;
878 h = left_height;
879 bits = left_bits;
880 break;
881
882 case OVERLAY_ARROW_BITMAP:
883 wd = ov_width;
884 h = ov_height;
885 bits = ov_bits;
886 break;
887
888 case RIGHT_TRUNCATION_BITMAP:
889 wd = right_width;
890 h = right_height;
891 bits = right_bits;
892 break;
893
894 case CONTINUED_LINE_BITMAP:
895 wd = continued_width;
896 h = continued_height;
897 bits = continued_bits;
898 break;
899
900 case CONTINUATION_LINE_BITMAP:
901 wd = continuation_width;
902 h = continuation_height;
903 bits = continuation_bits;
904 break;
905
906 case ZV_LINE_BITMAP:
907 wd = zv_width;
908 h = zv_height - (y % zv_period);
909 bits = zv_bits + (y % zv_period);
910 break;
911
912 default:
913 abort ();
914 }
915
916 /* Clip bitmap if too high. */
917 if (h > row->height)
918 h = row->height;
919
920 /* Set dy to the offset in the row to start drawing the bitmap. */
921 dy = (row->height - h) / 2;
922
923 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, FRINGE_FACE_ID);
924 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (f, face);
925
926 /* Clear left fringe if no bitmap to draw or if bitmap doesn't fill
927 the fringe. */
928 b1 = b2 = -1;
929 if (left_p)
930 {
931 if (wd > FRAME_X_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f))
932 wd = FRAME_X_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f);
933 x = (WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, 0)
934 - wd
935 - (FRAME_X_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f) - wd) / 2);
936 if (wd < FRAME_X_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f) || row->height > h)
937 {
938 /* If W has a vertical border to its left, don't draw over it. */
939 int border = ((XFASTINT (w->left) > 0
940 && !FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
941 ? 1 : 0);
942 b1 = (window_box_left (w, -1)
943 - FRAME_X_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f)
944 + border);
945 b2 = (FRAME_X_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f) - border);
946 }
947 }
948 else
949 {
950 if (wd > FRAME_X_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f))
951 wd = FRAME_X_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f);
952 x = (window_box_right (w, -1)
953 + (FRAME_X_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f) - wd) / 2);
954 /* Clear right fringe if no bitmap to draw of if bitmap doesn't fill
955 the fringe. */
956 if (wd < FRAME_X_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f) || row->height > h)
957 {
958 b1 = window_box_right (w, -1);
959 b2 = FRAME_X_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f);
960 }
961 }
962
963 if (b1 >= 0)
964 {
965 int header_line_height = WINDOW_DISPLAY_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
966
967 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
968 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
969 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
970 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
971 if (face->stipple)
972 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
973 else
974 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
975
976 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc,
977 b1,
978 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
979 row->y)),
980 b2,
981 row->visible_height);
982 if (!face->stipple)
983 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
984 }
985
986 if (which != NO_FRINGE_BITMAP)
987 {
988 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
989 by the server. */
990 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, wd, h,
991 face->foreground,
992 face->background, depth);
993 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0, wd, h, x, y + dy);
994 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
995 }
996
997 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
998 }
999
1000
1001 /* Draw fringe bitmaps for glyph row ROW on window W. Call this
1002 function with input blocked. */
1003
1004 static void
1005 x_draw_row_fringe_bitmaps (w, row)
1006 struct window *w;
1007 struct glyph_row *row;
1008 {
1009 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
1010 enum fringe_bitmap_type bitmap;
1011
1012 xassert (interrupt_input_blocked);
1013
1014 /* If row is completely invisible, because of vscrolling, we
1015 don't have to draw anything. */
1016 if (row->visible_height <= 0)
1017 return;
1018
1019 if (FRAME_X_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f) != 0)
1020 {
1021 /* Decide which bitmap to draw in the left fringe. */
1022 if (row->overlay_arrow_p)
1023 bitmap = OVERLAY_ARROW_BITMAP;
1024 else if (row->truncated_on_left_p)
1025 bitmap = LEFT_TRUNCATION_BITMAP;
1026 else if (MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (row))
1027 bitmap = CONTINUATION_LINE_BITMAP;
1028 else if (row->indicate_empty_line_p)
1029 bitmap = ZV_LINE_BITMAP;
1030 else
1031 bitmap = NO_FRINGE_BITMAP;
1032
1033 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (w, row, bitmap, 1);
1034 }
1035
1036 if (FRAME_X_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f) != 0)
1037 {
1038 /* Decide which bitmap to draw in the right fringe. */
1039 if (row->truncated_on_right_p)
1040 bitmap = RIGHT_TRUNCATION_BITMAP;
1041 else if (row->continued_p)
1042 bitmap = CONTINUED_LINE_BITMAP;
1043 else if (row->indicate_empty_line_p && FRAME_X_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f) == 0)
1044 bitmap = ZV_LINE_BITMAP;
1045 else
1046 bitmap = NO_FRINGE_BITMAP;
1047
1048 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (w, row, bitmap, 0);
1049 }
1050 }
1051
1052 \f
1053
1054 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
1055 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
1056 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
1057 rarely happens). */
1058
1059 static void
1060 XTset_terminal_modes ()
1061 {
1062 }
1063
1064 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
1065 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
1066
1067 static void
1068 XTreset_terminal_modes ()
1069 {
1070 }
1071
1072
1073 \f
1074 /***********************************************************************
1075 Output Cursor
1076 ***********************************************************************/
1077
1078 /* Set the global variable output_cursor to CURSOR. All cursor
1079 positions are relative to updated_window. */
1080
1081 static void
1082 set_output_cursor (cursor)
1083 struct cursor_pos *cursor;
1084 {
1085 output_cursor.hpos = cursor->hpos;
1086 output_cursor.vpos = cursor->vpos;
1087 output_cursor.x = cursor->x;
1088 output_cursor.y = cursor->y;
1089 }
1090
1091
1092 /* Set a nominal cursor position.
1093
1094 HPOS and VPOS are column/row positions in a window glyph matrix. X
1095 and Y are window text area relative pixel positions.
1096
1097 If this is done during an update, updated_window will contain the
1098 window that is being updated and the position is the future output
1099 cursor position for that window. If updated_window is null, use
1100 selected_window and display the cursor at the given position. */
1101
1102 static void
1103 XTcursor_to (vpos, hpos, y, x)
1104 int vpos, hpos, y, x;
1105 {
1106 struct window *w;
1107
1108 /* If updated_window is not set, work on selected_window. */
1109 if (updated_window)
1110 w = updated_window;
1111 else
1112 w = XWINDOW (selected_window);
1113
1114 /* Set the output cursor. */
1115 output_cursor.hpos = hpos;
1116 output_cursor.vpos = vpos;
1117 output_cursor.x = x;
1118 output_cursor.y = y;
1119
1120 /* If not called as part of an update, really display the cursor.
1121 This will also set the cursor position of W. */
1122 if (updated_window == NULL)
1123 {
1124 BLOCK_INPUT;
1125 x_display_cursor (w, 1, hpos, vpos, x, y);
1126 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (SELECTED_FRAME ()));
1127 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1128 }
1129 }
1130
1131
1132 \f
1133 /***********************************************************************
1134 Display Iterator
1135 ***********************************************************************/
1136
1137 /* Function prototypes of this page. */
1138
1139 static struct face *x_get_glyph_face_and_encoding P_ ((struct frame *,
1140 struct glyph *,
1141 XChar2b *,
1142 int *));
1143 static struct face *x_get_char_face_and_encoding P_ ((struct frame *, int,
1144 int, XChar2b *, int,
1145 int));
1146 static XCharStruct *x_per_char_metric P_ ((XFontStruct *, XChar2b *));
1147 static void x_encode_char P_ ((int, XChar2b *, struct font_info *));
1148 static void x_append_glyph P_ ((struct it *));
1149 static void x_append_composite_glyph P_ ((struct it *));
1150 static void x_append_stretch_glyph P_ ((struct it *it, Lisp_Object,
1151 int, int, double));
1152 static void x_produce_glyphs P_ ((struct it *));
1153 static void x_produce_image_glyph P_ ((struct it *it));
1154
1155
1156 /* Get metrics of character CHAR2B in FONT. Value is null if CHAR2B
1157 is not contained in the font. */
1158
1159 static INLINE XCharStruct *
1160 x_per_char_metric (font, char2b)
1161 XFontStruct *font;
1162 XChar2b *char2b;
1163 {
1164 /* The result metric information. */
1165 XCharStruct *pcm = NULL;
1166
1167 xassert (font && char2b);
1168
1169 if (font->per_char != NULL)
1170 {
1171 if (font->min_byte1 == 0 && font->max_byte1 == 0)
1172 {
1173 /* min_char_or_byte2 specifies the linear character index
1174 corresponding to the first element of the per_char array,
1175 max_char_or_byte2 is the index of the last character. A
1176 character with non-zero CHAR2B->byte1 is not in the font.
1177 A character with byte2 less than min_char_or_byte2 or
1178 greater max_char_or_byte2 is not in the font. */
1179 if (char2b->byte1 == 0
1180 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
1181 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
1182 pcm = font->per_char + char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2;
1183 }
1184 else
1185 {
1186 /* If either min_byte1 or max_byte1 are nonzero, both
1187 min_char_or_byte2 and max_char_or_byte2 are less than
1188 256, and the 2-byte character index values corresponding
1189 to the per_char array element N (counting from 0) are:
1190
1191 byte1 = N/D + min_byte1
1192 byte2 = N\D + min_char_or_byte2
1193
1194 where:
1195
1196 D = max_char_or_byte2 - min_char_or_byte2 + 1
1197 / = integer division
1198 \ = integer modulus */
1199 if (char2b->byte1 >= font->min_byte1
1200 && char2b->byte1 <= font->max_byte1
1201 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
1202 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
1203 {
1204 pcm = (font->per_char
1205 + ((font->max_char_or_byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2 + 1)
1206 * (char2b->byte1 - font->min_byte1))
1207 + (char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2));
1208 }
1209 }
1210 }
1211 else
1212 {
1213 /* If the per_char pointer is null, all glyphs between the first
1214 and last character indexes inclusive have the same
1215 information, as given by both min_bounds and max_bounds. */
1216 if (char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
1217 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
1218 pcm = &font->max_bounds;
1219 }
1220
1221 return ((pcm == NULL
1222 || (pcm->width == 0 && (pcm->rbearing - pcm->lbearing) == 0))
1223 ? NULL : pcm);
1224 }
1225
1226
1227 /* Encode CHAR2B using encoding information from FONT_INFO. CHAR2B is
1228 the two-byte form of C. Encoding is returned in *CHAR2B. */
1229
1230 static INLINE void
1231 x_encode_char (c, char2b, font_info)
1232 int c;
1233 XChar2b *char2b;
1234 struct font_info *font_info;
1235 {
1236 int charset = CHAR_CHARSET (c);
1237 XFontStruct *font = font_info->font;
1238
1239 /* FONT_INFO may define a scheme by which to encode byte1 and byte2.
1240 This may be either a program in a special encoder language or a
1241 fixed encoding. */
1242 if (font_info->font_encoder)
1243 {
1244 /* It's a program. */
1245 struct ccl_program *ccl = font_info->font_encoder;
1246
1247 if (CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 1)
1248 {
1249 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
1250 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte2;
1251 }
1252 else
1253 {
1254 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
1255 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte1;
1256 ccl->reg[2] = char2b->byte2;
1257 }
1258
1259 ccl_driver (ccl, NULL, NULL, 0, 0, NULL);
1260
1261 /* We assume that MSBs are appropriately set/reset by CCL
1262 program. */
1263 if (font->max_byte1 == 0) /* 1-byte font */
1264 char2b->byte1 = 0, char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[1];
1265 else
1266 char2b->byte1 = ccl->reg[1], char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[2];
1267 }
1268 else if (font_info->encoding[charset])
1269 {
1270 /* Fixed encoding scheme. See fontset.h for the meaning of the
1271 encoding numbers. */
1272 int enc = font_info->encoding[charset];
1273
1274 if ((enc == 1 || enc == 2)
1275 && CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 2)
1276 char2b->byte1 |= 0x80;
1277
1278 if (enc == 1 || enc == 3)
1279 char2b->byte2 |= 0x80;
1280 }
1281 }
1282
1283
1284 /* Get face and two-byte form of character C in face FACE_ID on frame
1285 F. The encoding of C is returned in *CHAR2B. MULTIBYTE_P non-zero
1286 means we want to display multibyte text. DISPLAY_P non-zero means
1287 make sure that X resources for the face returned are allocated.
1288 Value is a pointer to a realized face that is ready for display if
1289 DISPLAY_P is non-zero. */
1290
1291 static INLINE struct face *
1292 x_get_char_face_and_encoding (f, c, face_id, char2b, multibyte_p, display_p)
1293 struct frame *f;
1294 int c, face_id;
1295 XChar2b *char2b;
1296 int multibyte_p, display_p;
1297 {
1298 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, face_id);
1299
1300 if (!multibyte_p)
1301 {
1302 /* Unibyte case. We don't have to encode, but we have to make
1303 sure to use a face suitable for unibyte. */
1304 char2b->byte1 = 0;
1305 char2b->byte2 = c;
1306 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (f, face, c);
1307 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, face_id);
1308 }
1309 else if (c < 128 && face_id < BASIC_FACE_ID_SENTINEL)
1310 {
1311 /* Case of ASCII in a face known to fit ASCII. */
1312 char2b->byte1 = 0;
1313 char2b->byte2 = c;
1314 }
1315 else
1316 {
1317 int c1, c2, charset;
1318
1319 /* Split characters into bytes. If c2 is -1 afterwards, C is
1320 really a one-byte character so that byte1 is zero. */
1321 SPLIT_CHAR (c, charset, c1, c2);
1322 if (c2 > 0)
1323 char2b->byte1 = c1, char2b->byte2 = c2;
1324 else
1325 char2b->byte1 = 0, char2b->byte2 = c1;
1326
1327 /* Maybe encode the character in *CHAR2B. */
1328 if (face->font != NULL)
1329 {
1330 struct font_info *font_info
1331 = FONT_INFO_FROM_ID (f, face->font_info_id);
1332 if (font_info)
1333 x_encode_char (c, char2b, font_info);
1334 }
1335 }
1336
1337 /* Make sure X resources of the face are allocated. */
1338 if (display_p)
1339 {
1340 xassert (face != NULL);
1341 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (f, face);
1342 }
1343
1344 return face;
1345 }
1346
1347
1348 /* Get face and two-byte form of character glyph GLYPH on frame F.
1349 The encoding of GLYPH->u.ch is returned in *CHAR2B. Value is
1350 a pointer to a realized face that is ready for display. */
1351
1352 static INLINE struct face *
1353 x_get_glyph_face_and_encoding (f, glyph, char2b, two_byte_p)
1354 struct frame *f;
1355 struct glyph *glyph;
1356 XChar2b *char2b;
1357 int *two_byte_p;
1358 {
1359 struct face *face;
1360
1361 xassert (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH);
1362 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, glyph->face_id);
1363
1364 if (two_byte_p)
1365 *two_byte_p = 0;
1366
1367 if (!glyph->multibyte_p)
1368 {
1369 /* Unibyte case. We don't have to encode, but we have to make
1370 sure to use a face suitable for unibyte. */
1371 char2b->byte1 = 0;
1372 char2b->byte2 = glyph->u.ch;
1373 }
1374 else if (glyph->u.ch < 128
1375 && glyph->face_id < BASIC_FACE_ID_SENTINEL)
1376 {
1377 /* Case of ASCII in a face known to fit ASCII. */
1378 char2b->byte1 = 0;
1379 char2b->byte2 = glyph->u.ch;
1380 }
1381 else
1382 {
1383 int c1, c2, charset;
1384
1385 /* Split characters into bytes. If c2 is -1 afterwards, C is
1386 really a one-byte character so that byte1 is zero. */
1387 SPLIT_CHAR (glyph->u.ch, charset, c1, c2);
1388 if (c2 > 0)
1389 char2b->byte1 = c1, char2b->byte2 = c2;
1390 else
1391 char2b->byte1 = 0, char2b->byte2 = c1;
1392
1393 /* Maybe encode the character in *CHAR2B. */
1394 if (charset != CHARSET_ASCII)
1395 {
1396 struct font_info *font_info
1397 = FONT_INFO_FROM_ID (f, face->font_info_id);
1398 if (font_info)
1399 {
1400 x_encode_char (glyph->u.ch, char2b, font_info);
1401 if (two_byte_p)
1402 *two_byte_p
1403 = ((XFontStruct *) (font_info->font))->max_byte1 > 0;
1404 }
1405 }
1406 }
1407
1408 /* Make sure X resources of the face are allocated. */
1409 xassert (face != NULL);
1410 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (f, face);
1411 return face;
1412 }
1413
1414
1415 /* Store one glyph for IT->char_to_display in IT->glyph_row.
1416 Called from x_produce_glyphs when IT->glyph_row is non-null. */
1417
1418 static INLINE void
1419 x_append_glyph (it)
1420 struct it *it;
1421 {
1422 struct glyph *glyph;
1423 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
1424
1425 xassert (it->glyph_row);
1426 xassert (it->char_to_display != '\n' && it->char_to_display != '\t');
1427
1428 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
1429 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
1430 {
1431 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
1432 glyph->object = it->object;
1433 glyph->pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
1434 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
1435 glyph->type = CHAR_GLYPH;
1436 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
1437 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
1438 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
1439 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = (it->phys_ascent > it->ascent
1440 || it->phys_descent > it->descent);
1441 glyph->padding_p = 0;
1442 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = it->glyph_not_available_p;
1443 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
1444 glyph->u.ch = it->char_to_display;
1445 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
1446 }
1447 }
1448
1449 /* Store one glyph for the composition IT->cmp_id in IT->glyph_row.
1450 Called from x_produce_glyphs when IT->glyph_row is non-null. */
1451
1452 static INLINE void
1453 x_append_composite_glyph (it)
1454 struct it *it;
1455 {
1456 struct glyph *glyph;
1457 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
1458
1459 xassert (it->glyph_row);
1460
1461 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
1462 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
1463 {
1464 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
1465 glyph->object = it->object;
1466 glyph->pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
1467 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
1468 glyph->type = COMPOSITE_GLYPH;
1469 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
1470 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
1471 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
1472 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = (it->phys_ascent > it->ascent
1473 || it->phys_descent > it->descent);
1474 glyph->padding_p = 0;
1475 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
1476 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
1477 glyph->u.cmp_id = it->cmp_id;
1478 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
1479 }
1480 }
1481
1482
1483 /* Change IT->ascent and IT->height according to the setting of
1484 IT->voffset. */
1485
1486 static INLINE void
1487 take_vertical_position_into_account (it)
1488 struct it *it;
1489 {
1490 if (it->voffset)
1491 {
1492 if (it->voffset < 0)
1493 /* Increase the ascent so that we can display the text higher
1494 in the line. */
1495 it->ascent += abs (it->voffset);
1496 else
1497 /* Increase the descent so that we can display the text lower
1498 in the line. */
1499 it->descent += it->voffset;
1500 }
1501 }
1502
1503
1504 /* Produce glyphs/get display metrics for the image IT is loaded with.
1505 See the description of struct display_iterator in dispextern.h for
1506 an overview of struct display_iterator. */
1507
1508 static void
1509 x_produce_image_glyph (it)
1510 struct it *it;
1511 {
1512 struct image *img;
1513 struct face *face;
1514
1515 xassert (it->what == IT_IMAGE);
1516
1517 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
1518 img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->image_id);
1519 xassert (img);
1520
1521 /* Make sure X resources of the face and image are loaded. */
1522 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (it->f, face);
1523 prepare_image_for_display (it->f, img);
1524
1525 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = image_ascent (img, face);
1526 it->descent = it->phys_descent = img->height + 2 * img->vmargin - it->ascent;
1527 it->pixel_width = img->width + 2 * img->hmargin;
1528
1529 it->nglyphs = 1;
1530
1531 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
1532 {
1533 if (face->box_line_width > 0)
1534 {
1535 it->ascent += face->box_line_width;
1536 it->descent += face->box_line_width;
1537 }
1538
1539 if (it->start_of_box_run_p)
1540 it->pixel_width += abs (face->box_line_width);
1541 if (it->end_of_box_run_p)
1542 it->pixel_width += abs (face->box_line_width);
1543 }
1544
1545 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
1546
1547 if (it->glyph_row)
1548 {
1549 struct glyph *glyph;
1550 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
1551
1552 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
1553 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
1554 {
1555 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
1556 glyph->object = it->object;
1557 glyph->pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
1558 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
1559 glyph->type = IMAGE_GLYPH;
1560 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
1561 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
1562 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
1563 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = 0;
1564 glyph->padding_p = 0;
1565 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
1566 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
1567 glyph->u.img_id = img->id;
1568 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
1569 }
1570 }
1571 }
1572
1573
1574 /* Append a stretch glyph to IT->glyph_row. OBJECT is the source
1575 of the glyph, WIDTH and HEIGHT are the width and height of the
1576 stretch. ASCENT is the percentage/100 of HEIGHT to use for the
1577 ascent of the glyph (0 <= ASCENT <= 1). */
1578
1579 static void
1580 x_append_stretch_glyph (it, object, width, height, ascent)
1581 struct it *it;
1582 Lisp_Object object;
1583 int width, height;
1584 double ascent;
1585 {
1586 struct glyph *glyph;
1587 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
1588
1589 xassert (ascent >= 0 && ascent <= 1);
1590
1591 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
1592 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
1593 {
1594 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
1595 glyph->object = object;
1596 glyph->pixel_width = width;
1597 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
1598 glyph->type = STRETCH_GLYPH;
1599 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
1600 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
1601 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
1602 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = 0;
1603 glyph->padding_p = 0;
1604 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
1605 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
1606 glyph->u.stretch.ascent = height * ascent;
1607 glyph->u.stretch.height = height;
1608 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
1609 }
1610 }
1611
1612
1613 /* Produce a stretch glyph for iterator IT. IT->object is the value
1614 of the glyph property displayed. The value must be a list
1615 `(space KEYWORD VALUE ...)' with the following KEYWORD/VALUE pairs
1616 being recognized:
1617
1618 1. `:width WIDTH' specifies that the space should be WIDTH *
1619 canonical char width wide. WIDTH may be an integer or floating
1620 point number.
1621
1622 2. `:relative-width FACTOR' specifies that the width of the stretch
1623 should be computed from the width of the first character having the
1624 `glyph' property, and should be FACTOR times that width.
1625
1626 3. `:align-to HPOS' specifies that the space should be wide enough
1627 to reach HPOS, a value in canonical character units.
1628
1629 Exactly one of the above pairs must be present.
1630
1631 4. `:height HEIGHT' specifies that the height of the stretch produced
1632 should be HEIGHT, measured in canonical character units.
1633
1634 5. `:relative-height FACTOR' specifies that the height of the
1635 stretch should be FACTOR times the height of the characters having
1636 the glyph property.
1637
1638 Either none or exactly one of 4 or 5 must be present.
1639
1640 6. `:ascent ASCENT' specifies that ASCENT percent of the height
1641 of the stretch should be used for the ascent of the stretch.
1642 ASCENT must be in the range 0 <= ASCENT <= 100. */
1643
1644 #define NUMVAL(X) \
1645 ((INTEGERP (X) || FLOATP (X)) \
1646 ? XFLOATINT (X) \
1647 : - 1)
1648
1649
1650 static void
1651 x_produce_stretch_glyph (it)
1652 struct it *it;
1653 {
1654 /* (space :width WIDTH :height HEIGHT. */
1655 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
1656 extern Lisp_Object Qspace;
1657 #endif
1658 extern Lisp_Object QCwidth, QCheight, QCascent;
1659 extern Lisp_Object QCrelative_width, QCrelative_height;
1660 extern Lisp_Object QCalign_to;
1661 Lisp_Object prop, plist;
1662 double width = 0, height = 0, ascent = 0;
1663 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
1664 XFontStruct *font = face->font ? face->font : FRAME_FONT (it->f);
1665
1666 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (it->f, face);
1667
1668 /* List should start with `space'. */
1669 xassert (CONSP (it->object) && EQ (XCAR (it->object), Qspace));
1670 plist = XCDR (it->object);
1671
1672 /* Compute the width of the stretch. */
1673 if (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCwidth),
1674 NUMVAL (prop) > 0)
1675 /* Absolute width `:width WIDTH' specified and valid. */
1676 width = NUMVAL (prop) * CANON_X_UNIT (it->f);
1677 else if (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCrelative_width),
1678 NUMVAL (prop) > 0)
1679 {
1680 /* Relative width `:relative-width FACTOR' specified and valid.
1681 Compute the width of the characters having the `glyph'
1682 property. */
1683 struct it it2;
1684 unsigned char *p = BYTE_POS_ADDR (IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
1685
1686 it2 = *it;
1687 if (it->multibyte_p)
1688 {
1689 int maxlen = ((IT_BYTEPOS (*it) >= GPT ? ZV : GPT)
1690 - IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
1691 it2.c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (p, maxlen, it2.len);
1692 }
1693 else
1694 it2.c = *p, it2.len = 1;
1695
1696 it2.glyph_row = NULL;
1697 it2.what = IT_CHARACTER;
1698 x_produce_glyphs (&it2);
1699 width = NUMVAL (prop) * it2.pixel_width;
1700 }
1701 else if (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCalign_to),
1702 NUMVAL (prop) > 0)
1703 width = NUMVAL (prop) * CANON_X_UNIT (it->f) - it->current_x;
1704 else
1705 /* Nothing specified -> width defaults to canonical char width. */
1706 width = CANON_X_UNIT (it->f);
1707
1708 /* Compute height. */
1709 if (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCheight),
1710 NUMVAL (prop) > 0)
1711 height = NUMVAL (prop) * CANON_Y_UNIT (it->f);
1712 else if (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCrelative_height),
1713 NUMVAL (prop) > 0)
1714 height = FONT_HEIGHT (font) * NUMVAL (prop);
1715 else
1716 height = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
1717
1718 /* Compute percentage of height used for ascent. If
1719 `:ascent ASCENT' is present and valid, use that. Otherwise,
1720 derive the ascent from the font in use. */
1721 if (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCascent),
1722 NUMVAL (prop) > 0 && NUMVAL (prop) <= 100)
1723 ascent = NUMVAL (prop) / 100.0;
1724 else
1725 ascent = (double) font->ascent / FONT_HEIGHT (font);
1726
1727 if (width <= 0)
1728 width = 1;
1729 if (height <= 0)
1730 height = 1;
1731
1732 if (it->glyph_row)
1733 {
1734 Lisp_Object object = it->stack[it->sp - 1].string;
1735 if (!STRINGP (object))
1736 object = it->w->buffer;
1737 x_append_stretch_glyph (it, object, width, height, ascent);
1738 }
1739
1740 it->pixel_width = width;
1741 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = height * ascent;
1742 it->descent = it->phys_descent = height - it->ascent;
1743 it->nglyphs = 1;
1744
1745 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
1746 {
1747 if (face->box_line_width > 0)
1748 {
1749 it->ascent += face->box_line_width;
1750 it->descent += face->box_line_width;
1751 }
1752
1753 if (it->start_of_box_run_p)
1754 it->pixel_width += abs (face->box_line_width);
1755 if (it->end_of_box_run_p)
1756 it->pixel_width += abs (face->box_line_width);
1757 }
1758
1759 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
1760 }
1761
1762 /* Return proper value to be used as baseline offset of font that has
1763 ASCENT and DESCENT to draw characters by the font at the vertical
1764 center of the line of frame F.
1765
1766 Here, out task is to find the value of BOFF in the following figure;
1767
1768 -------------------------+-----------+-
1769 -+-+---------+-+ | |
1770 | | | | | |
1771 | | | | F_ASCENT F_HEIGHT
1772 | | | ASCENT | |
1773 HEIGHT | | | | |
1774 | | |-|-+------+-----------|------- baseline
1775 | | | | BOFF | |
1776 | |---------|-+-+ | |
1777 | | | DESCENT | |
1778 -+-+---------+-+ F_DESCENT |
1779 -------------------------+-----------+-
1780
1781 -BOFF + DESCENT + (F_HEIGHT - HEIGHT) / 2 = F_DESCENT
1782 BOFF = DESCENT + (F_HEIGHT - HEIGHT) / 2 - F_DESCENT
1783 DESCENT = FONT->descent
1784 HEIGHT = FONT_HEIGHT (FONT)
1785 F_DESCENT = (F->output_data.x->font->descent
1786 - F->output_data.x->baseline_offset)
1787 F_HEIGHT = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (F)
1788 */
1789
1790 #define VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET(FONT, F) \
1791 ((FONT)->descent \
1792 + (FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT ((F)) - FONT_HEIGHT ((FONT)) \
1793 + (FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT ((F)) > FONT_HEIGHT ((FONT)))) / 2 \
1794 - ((F)->output_data.x->font->descent - (F)->output_data.x->baseline_offset))
1795
1796 /* Produce glyphs/get display metrics for the display element IT is
1797 loaded with. See the description of struct display_iterator in
1798 dispextern.h for an overview of struct display_iterator. */
1799
1800 static void
1801 x_produce_glyphs (it)
1802 struct it *it;
1803 {
1804 it->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
1805
1806 if (it->what == IT_CHARACTER)
1807 {
1808 XChar2b char2b;
1809 XFontStruct *font;
1810 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
1811 XCharStruct *pcm;
1812 int font_not_found_p;
1813 struct font_info *font_info;
1814 int boff; /* baseline offset */
1815 /* We may change it->multibyte_p upon unibyte<->multibyte
1816 conversion. So, save the current value now and restore it
1817 later.
1818
1819 Note: It seems that we don't have to record multibyte_p in
1820 struct glyph because the character code itself tells if or
1821 not the character is multibyte. Thus, in the future, we must
1822 consider eliminating the field `multibyte_p' in the struct
1823 glyph. */
1824 int saved_multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
1825
1826 /* Maybe translate single-byte characters to multibyte, or the
1827 other way. */
1828 it->char_to_display = it->c;
1829 if (!ASCII_BYTE_P (it->c))
1830 {
1831 if (unibyte_display_via_language_environment
1832 && SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (it->c)
1833 && (it->c >= 0240
1834 || !NILP (Vnonascii_translation_table)))
1835 {
1836 it->char_to_display = unibyte_char_to_multibyte (it->c);
1837 it->multibyte_p = 1;
1838 it->face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, it->char_to_display);
1839 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
1840 }
1841 else if (!SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (it->c)
1842 && !it->multibyte_p)
1843 {
1844 it->multibyte_p = 1;
1845 it->face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, it->char_to_display);
1846 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
1847 }
1848 }
1849
1850 /* Get font to use. Encode IT->char_to_display. */
1851 x_get_char_face_and_encoding (it->f, it->char_to_display,
1852 it->face_id, &char2b,
1853 it->multibyte_p, 0);
1854 font = face->font;
1855
1856 /* When no suitable font found, use the default font. */
1857 font_not_found_p = font == NULL;
1858 if (font_not_found_p)
1859 {
1860 font = FRAME_FONT (it->f);
1861 boff = it->f->output_data.x->baseline_offset;
1862 font_info = NULL;
1863 }
1864 else
1865 {
1866 font_info = FONT_INFO_FROM_ID (it->f, face->font_info_id);
1867 boff = font_info->baseline_offset;
1868 if (font_info->vertical_centering)
1869 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, it->f) - boff;
1870 }
1871
1872 if (it->char_to_display >= ' '
1873 && (!it->multibyte_p || it->char_to_display < 128))
1874 {
1875 /* Either unibyte or ASCII. */
1876 int stretched_p;
1877
1878 it->nglyphs = 1;
1879
1880 pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b);
1881 it->ascent = font->ascent + boff;
1882 it->descent = font->descent - boff;
1883
1884 if (pcm)
1885 {
1886 it->phys_ascent = pcm->ascent + boff;
1887 it->phys_descent = pcm->descent - boff;
1888 it->pixel_width = pcm->width;
1889 }
1890 else
1891 {
1892 it->glyph_not_available_p = 1;
1893 it->phys_ascent = font->ascent + boff;
1894 it->phys_descent = font->descent - boff;
1895 it->pixel_width = FONT_WIDTH (font);
1896 }
1897
1898 /* If this is a space inside a region of text with
1899 `space-width' property, change its width. */
1900 stretched_p = it->char_to_display == ' ' && !NILP (it->space_width);
1901 if (stretched_p)
1902 it->pixel_width *= XFLOATINT (it->space_width);
1903
1904 /* If face has a box, add the box thickness to the character
1905 height. If character has a box line to the left and/or
1906 right, add the box line width to the character's width. */
1907 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
1908 {
1909 int thick = face->box_line_width;
1910
1911 if (thick > 0)
1912 {
1913 it->ascent += thick;
1914 it->descent += thick;
1915 }
1916 else
1917 thick = -thick;
1918
1919 if (it->start_of_box_run_p)
1920 it->pixel_width += thick;
1921 if (it->end_of_box_run_p)
1922 it->pixel_width += thick;
1923 }
1924
1925 /* If face has an overline, add the height of the overline
1926 (1 pixel) and a 1 pixel margin to the character height. */
1927 if (face->overline_p)
1928 it->ascent += 2;
1929
1930 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
1931
1932 /* If we have to actually produce glyphs, do it. */
1933 if (it->glyph_row)
1934 {
1935 if (stretched_p)
1936 {
1937 /* Translate a space with a `space-width' property
1938 into a stretch glyph. */
1939 double ascent = (double) font->ascent / FONT_HEIGHT (font);
1940 x_append_stretch_glyph (it, it->object, it->pixel_width,
1941 it->ascent + it->descent, ascent);
1942 }
1943 else
1944 x_append_glyph (it);
1945
1946 /* If characters with lbearing or rbearing are displayed
1947 in this line, record that fact in a flag of the
1948 glyph row. This is used to optimize X output code. */
1949 if (pcm && (pcm->lbearing < 0 || pcm->rbearing > pcm->width))
1950 it->glyph_row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p = 1;
1951 }
1952 }
1953 else if (it->char_to_display == '\n')
1954 {
1955 /* A newline has no width but we need the height of the line. */
1956 it->pixel_width = 0;
1957 it->nglyphs = 0;
1958 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = font->ascent + boff;
1959 it->descent = it->phys_descent = font->descent - boff;
1960
1961 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1962 && face->box_line_width > 0)
1963 {
1964 it->ascent += face->box_line_width;
1965 it->descent += face->box_line_width;
1966 }
1967 }
1968 else if (it->char_to_display == '\t')
1969 {
1970 int tab_width = it->tab_width * CANON_X_UNIT (it->f);
1971 int x = it->current_x + it->continuation_lines_width;
1972 int next_tab_x = ((1 + x + tab_width - 1) / tab_width) * tab_width;
1973
1974 /* If the distance from the current position to the next tab
1975 stop is less than a canonical character width, use the
1976 tab stop after that. */
1977 if (next_tab_x - x < CANON_X_UNIT (it->f))
1978 next_tab_x += tab_width;
1979
1980 it->pixel_width = next_tab_x - x;
1981 it->nglyphs = 1;
1982 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = font->ascent + boff;
1983 it->descent = it->phys_descent = font->descent - boff;
1984
1985 if (it->glyph_row)
1986 {
1987 double ascent = (double) it->ascent / (it->ascent + it->descent);
1988 x_append_stretch_glyph (it, it->object, it->pixel_width,
1989 it->ascent + it->descent, ascent);
1990 }
1991 }
1992 else
1993 {
1994 /* A multi-byte character. Assume that the display width of the
1995 character is the width of the character multiplied by the
1996 width of the font. */
1997
1998 /* If we found a font, this font should give us the right
1999 metrics. If we didn't find a font, use the frame's
2000 default font and calculate the width of the character
2001 from the charset width; this is what old redisplay code
2002 did. */
2003 pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b);
2004 if (font_not_found_p || !pcm)
2005 {
2006 int charset = CHAR_CHARSET (it->char_to_display);
2007
2008 it->glyph_not_available_p = 1;
2009 it->pixel_width = (FONT_WIDTH (FRAME_FONT (it->f))
2010 * CHARSET_WIDTH (charset));
2011 it->phys_ascent = font->ascent + boff;
2012 it->phys_descent = font->descent - boff;
2013 }
2014 else
2015 {
2016 it->pixel_width = pcm->width;
2017 it->phys_ascent = pcm->ascent + boff;
2018 it->phys_descent = pcm->descent - boff;
2019 if (it->glyph_row
2020 && (pcm->lbearing < 0
2021 || pcm->rbearing > pcm->width))
2022 it->glyph_row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p = 1;
2023 }
2024 it->nglyphs = 1;
2025 it->ascent = font->ascent + boff;
2026 it->descent = font->descent - boff;
2027 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2028 {
2029 int thick = face->box_line_width;
2030
2031 if (thick > 0)
2032 {
2033 it->ascent += thick;
2034 it->descent += thick;
2035 }
2036 else
2037 thick = - thick;
2038
2039 if (it->start_of_box_run_p)
2040 it->pixel_width += thick;
2041 if (it->end_of_box_run_p)
2042 it->pixel_width += thick;
2043 }
2044
2045 /* If face has an overline, add the height of the overline
2046 (1 pixel) and a 1 pixel margin to the character height. */
2047 if (face->overline_p)
2048 it->ascent += 2;
2049
2050 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
2051
2052 if (it->glyph_row)
2053 x_append_glyph (it);
2054 }
2055 it->multibyte_p = saved_multibyte_p;
2056 }
2057 else if (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION)
2058 {
2059 /* Note: A composition is represented as one glyph in the
2060 glyph matrix. There are no padding glyphs. */
2061 XChar2b char2b;
2062 XFontStruct *font;
2063 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
2064 XCharStruct *pcm;
2065 int font_not_found_p;
2066 struct font_info *font_info;
2067 int boff; /* baseline offset */
2068 struct composition *cmp = composition_table[it->cmp_id];
2069
2070 /* Maybe translate single-byte characters to multibyte. */
2071 it->char_to_display = it->c;
2072 if (unibyte_display_via_language_environment
2073 && SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (it->c)
2074 && (it->c >= 0240
2075 || (it->c >= 0200
2076 && !NILP (Vnonascii_translation_table))))
2077 {
2078 it->char_to_display = unibyte_char_to_multibyte (it->c);
2079 }
2080
2081 /* Get face and font to use. Encode IT->char_to_display. */
2082 it->face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, it->char_to_display);
2083 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
2084 x_get_char_face_and_encoding (it->f, it->char_to_display,
2085 it->face_id, &char2b, it->multibyte_p, 0);
2086 font = face->font;
2087
2088 /* When no suitable font found, use the default font. */
2089 font_not_found_p = font == NULL;
2090 if (font_not_found_p)
2091 {
2092 font = FRAME_FONT (it->f);
2093 boff = it->f->output_data.x->baseline_offset;
2094 font_info = NULL;
2095 }
2096 else
2097 {
2098 font_info = FONT_INFO_FROM_ID (it->f, face->font_info_id);
2099 boff = font_info->baseline_offset;
2100 if (font_info->vertical_centering)
2101 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, it->f) - boff;
2102 }
2103
2104 /* There are no padding glyphs, so there is only one glyph to
2105 produce for the composition. Important is that pixel_width,
2106 ascent and descent are the values of what is drawn by
2107 draw_glyphs (i.e. the values of the overall glyphs composed). */
2108 it->nglyphs = 1;
2109
2110 /* If we have not yet calculated pixel size data of glyphs of
2111 the composition for the current face font, calculate them
2112 now. Theoretically, we have to check all fonts for the
2113 glyphs, but that requires much time and memory space. So,
2114 here we check only the font of the first glyph. This leads
2115 to incorrect display very rarely, and C-l (recenter) can
2116 correct the display anyway. */
2117 if (cmp->font != (void *) font)
2118 {
2119 /* Ascent and descent of the font of the first character of
2120 this composition (adjusted by baseline offset). Ascent
2121 and descent of overall glyphs should not be less than
2122 them respectively. */
2123 int font_ascent = font->ascent + boff;
2124 int font_descent = font->descent - boff;
2125 /* Bounding box of the overall glyphs. */
2126 int leftmost, rightmost, lowest, highest;
2127 int i, width, ascent, descent;
2128
2129 cmp->font = (void *) font;
2130
2131 /* Initialize the bounding box. */
2132 if (font_info
2133 && (pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b)))
2134 {
2135 width = pcm->width;
2136 ascent = pcm->ascent;
2137 descent = pcm->descent;
2138 }
2139 else
2140 {
2141 width = FONT_WIDTH (font);
2142 ascent = font->ascent;
2143 descent = font->descent;
2144 }
2145
2146 rightmost = width;
2147 lowest = - descent + boff;
2148 highest = ascent + boff;
2149 leftmost = 0;
2150
2151 if (font_info
2152 && font_info->default_ascent
2153 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vuse_default_ascent)
2154 && !NILP (Faref (Vuse_default_ascent,
2155 make_number (it->char_to_display))))
2156 highest = font_info->default_ascent + boff;
2157
2158 /* Draw the first glyph at the normal position. It may be
2159 shifted to right later if some other glyphs are drawn at
2160 the left. */
2161 cmp->offsets[0] = 0;
2162 cmp->offsets[1] = boff;
2163
2164 /* Set cmp->offsets for the remaining glyphs. */
2165 for (i = 1; i < cmp->glyph_len; i++)
2166 {
2167 int left, right, btm, top;
2168 int ch = COMPOSITION_GLYPH (cmp, i);
2169 int face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, ch);
2170
2171 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id);
2172 x_get_char_face_and_encoding (it->f, ch, face->id, &char2b,
2173 it->multibyte_p, 0);
2174 font = face->font;
2175 if (font == NULL)
2176 {
2177 font = FRAME_FONT (it->f);
2178 boff = it->f->output_data.x->baseline_offset;
2179 font_info = NULL;
2180 }
2181 else
2182 {
2183 font_info
2184 = FONT_INFO_FROM_ID (it->f, face->font_info_id);
2185 boff = font_info->baseline_offset;
2186 if (font_info->vertical_centering)
2187 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, it->f) - boff;
2188 }
2189
2190 if (font_info
2191 && (pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b)))
2192 {
2193 width = pcm->width;
2194 ascent = pcm->ascent;
2195 descent = pcm->descent;
2196 }
2197 else
2198 {
2199 width = FONT_WIDTH (font);
2200 ascent = 1;
2201 descent = 0;
2202 }
2203
2204 if (cmp->method != COMPOSITION_WITH_RULE_ALTCHARS)
2205 {
2206 /* Relative composition with or without
2207 alternate chars. */
2208 left = (leftmost + rightmost - width) / 2;
2209 btm = - descent + boff;
2210 if (font_info && font_info->relative_compose
2211 && (! CHAR_TABLE_P (Vignore_relative_composition)
2212 || NILP (Faref (Vignore_relative_composition,
2213 make_number (ch)))))
2214 {
2215
2216 if (- descent >= font_info->relative_compose)
2217 /* One extra pixel between two glyphs. */
2218 btm = highest + 1;
2219 else if (ascent <= 0)
2220 /* One extra pixel between two glyphs. */
2221 btm = lowest - 1 - ascent - descent;
2222 }
2223 }
2224 else
2225 {
2226 /* A composition rule is specified by an integer
2227 value that encodes global and new reference
2228 points (GREF and NREF). GREF and NREF are
2229 specified by numbers as below:
2230
2231 0---1---2 -- ascent
2232 | |
2233 | |
2234 | |
2235 9--10--11 -- center
2236 | |
2237 ---3---4---5--- baseline
2238 | |
2239 6---7---8 -- descent
2240 */
2241 int rule = COMPOSITION_RULE (cmp, i);
2242 int gref, nref, grefx, grefy, nrefx, nrefy;
2243
2244 COMPOSITION_DECODE_RULE (rule, gref, nref);
2245 grefx = gref % 3, nrefx = nref % 3;
2246 grefy = gref / 3, nrefy = nref / 3;
2247
2248 left = (leftmost
2249 + grefx * (rightmost - leftmost) / 2
2250 - nrefx * width / 2);
2251 btm = ((grefy == 0 ? highest
2252 : grefy == 1 ? 0
2253 : grefy == 2 ? lowest
2254 : (highest + lowest) / 2)
2255 - (nrefy == 0 ? ascent + descent
2256 : nrefy == 1 ? descent - boff
2257 : nrefy == 2 ? 0
2258 : (ascent + descent) / 2));
2259 }
2260
2261 cmp->offsets[i * 2] = left;
2262 cmp->offsets[i * 2 + 1] = btm + descent;
2263
2264 /* Update the bounding box of the overall glyphs. */
2265 right = left + width;
2266 top = btm + descent + ascent;
2267 if (left < leftmost)
2268 leftmost = left;
2269 if (right > rightmost)
2270 rightmost = right;
2271 if (top > highest)
2272 highest = top;
2273 if (btm < lowest)
2274 lowest = btm;
2275 }
2276
2277 /* If there are glyphs whose x-offsets are negative,
2278 shift all glyphs to the right and make all x-offsets
2279 non-negative. */
2280 if (leftmost < 0)
2281 {
2282 for (i = 0; i < cmp->glyph_len; i++)
2283 cmp->offsets[i * 2] -= leftmost;
2284 rightmost -= leftmost;
2285 }
2286
2287 cmp->pixel_width = rightmost;
2288 cmp->ascent = highest;
2289 cmp->descent = - lowest;
2290 if (cmp->ascent < font_ascent)
2291 cmp->ascent = font_ascent;
2292 if (cmp->descent < font_descent)
2293 cmp->descent = font_descent;
2294 }
2295
2296 it->pixel_width = cmp->pixel_width;
2297 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = cmp->ascent;
2298 it->descent = it->phys_descent = cmp->descent;
2299
2300 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2301 {
2302 int thick = face->box_line_width;
2303
2304 if (thick > 0)
2305 {
2306 it->ascent += thick;
2307 it->descent += thick;
2308 }
2309 else
2310 thick = - thick;
2311
2312 if (it->start_of_box_run_p)
2313 it->pixel_width += thick;
2314 if (it->end_of_box_run_p)
2315 it->pixel_width += thick;
2316 }
2317
2318 /* If face has an overline, add the height of the overline
2319 (1 pixel) and a 1 pixel margin to the character height. */
2320 if (face->overline_p)
2321 it->ascent += 2;
2322
2323 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
2324
2325 if (it->glyph_row)
2326 x_append_composite_glyph (it);
2327 }
2328 else if (it->what == IT_IMAGE)
2329 x_produce_image_glyph (it);
2330 else if (it->what == IT_STRETCH)
2331 x_produce_stretch_glyph (it);
2332
2333 /* Accumulate dimensions. Note: can't assume that it->descent > 0
2334 because this isn't true for images with `:ascent 100'. */
2335 xassert (it->ascent >= 0 && it->descent >= 0);
2336 if (it->area == TEXT_AREA)
2337 it->current_x += it->pixel_width;
2338
2339 it->descent += it->extra_line_spacing;
2340
2341 it->max_ascent = max (it->max_ascent, it->ascent);
2342 it->max_descent = max (it->max_descent, it->descent);
2343 it->max_phys_ascent = max (it->max_phys_ascent, it->phys_ascent);
2344 it->max_phys_descent = max (it->max_phys_descent, it->phys_descent);
2345 }
2346
2347
2348 /* Estimate the pixel height of the mode or top line on frame F.
2349 FACE_ID specifies what line's height to estimate. */
2350
2351 int
2352 x_estimate_mode_line_height (f, face_id)
2353 struct frame *f;
2354 enum face_id face_id;
2355 {
2356 int height = FONT_HEIGHT (FRAME_FONT (f));
2357
2358 /* This function is called so early when Emacs starts that the face
2359 cache and mode line face are not yet initialized. */
2360 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
2361 {
2362 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, face_id);
2363 if (face)
2364 {
2365 if (face->font)
2366 height = FONT_HEIGHT (face->font);
2367 if (face->box_line_width > 0)
2368 height += 2 * face->box_line_width;
2369 }
2370 }
2371
2372 return height;
2373 }
2374
2375 \f
2376 /***********************************************************************
2377 Glyph display
2378 ***********************************************************************/
2379
2380 /* A sequence of glyphs to be drawn in the same face.
2381
2382 This data structure is not really completely X specific, so it
2383 could possibly, at least partially, be useful for other systems. It
2384 is currently not part of the external redisplay interface because
2385 it's not clear what other systems will need. */
2386
2387 struct glyph_string
2388 {
2389 /* X-origin of the string. */
2390 int x;
2391
2392 /* Y-origin and y-position of the base line of this string. */
2393 int y, ybase;
2394
2395 /* The width of the string, not including a face extension. */
2396 int width;
2397
2398 /* The width of the string, including a face extension. */
2399 int background_width;
2400
2401 /* The height of this string. This is the height of the line this
2402 string is drawn in, and can be different from the height of the
2403 font the string is drawn in. */
2404 int height;
2405
2406 /* Number of pixels this string overwrites in front of its x-origin.
2407 This number is zero if the string has an lbearing >= 0; it is
2408 -lbearing, if the string has an lbearing < 0. */
2409 int left_overhang;
2410
2411 /* Number of pixels this string overwrites past its right-most
2412 nominal x-position, i.e. x + width. Zero if the string's
2413 rbearing is <= its nominal width, rbearing - width otherwise. */
2414 int right_overhang;
2415
2416 /* The frame on which the glyph string is drawn. */
2417 struct frame *f;
2418
2419 /* The window on which the glyph string is drawn. */
2420 struct window *w;
2421
2422 /* X display and window for convenience. */
2423 Display *display;
2424 Window window;
2425
2426 /* The glyph row for which this string was built. It determines the
2427 y-origin and height of the string. */
2428 struct glyph_row *row;
2429
2430 /* The area within row. */
2431 enum glyph_row_area area;
2432
2433 /* Characters to be drawn, and number of characters. */
2434 XChar2b *char2b;
2435 int nchars;
2436
2437 /* A face-override for drawing cursors, mouse face and similar. */
2438 enum draw_glyphs_face hl;
2439
2440 /* Face in which this string is to be drawn. */
2441 struct face *face;
2442
2443 /* Font in which this string is to be drawn. */
2444 XFontStruct *font;
2445
2446 /* Font info for this string. */
2447 struct font_info *font_info;
2448
2449 /* Non-null means this string describes (part of) a composition.
2450 All characters from char2b are drawn composed. */
2451 struct composition *cmp;
2452
2453 /* Index of this glyph string's first character in the glyph
2454 definition of CMP. If this is zero, this glyph string describes
2455 the first character of a composition. */
2456 int gidx;
2457
2458 /* 1 means this glyph strings face has to be drawn to the right end
2459 of the window's drawing area. */
2460 unsigned extends_to_end_of_line_p : 1;
2461
2462 /* 1 means the background of this string has been drawn. */
2463 unsigned background_filled_p : 1;
2464
2465 /* 1 means glyph string must be drawn with 16-bit functions. */
2466 unsigned two_byte_p : 1;
2467
2468 /* 1 means that the original font determined for drawing this glyph
2469 string could not be loaded. The member `font' has been set to
2470 the frame's default font in this case. */
2471 unsigned font_not_found_p : 1;
2472
2473 /* 1 means that the face in which this glyph string is drawn has a
2474 stipple pattern. */
2475 unsigned stippled_p : 1;
2476
2477 /* 1 means only the foreground of this glyph string must be drawn,
2478 and we should use the physical height of the line this glyph
2479 string appears in as clip rect. */
2480 unsigned for_overlaps_p : 1;
2481
2482 /* The GC to use for drawing this glyph string. */
2483 GC gc;
2484
2485 /* A pointer to the first glyph in the string. This glyph
2486 corresponds to char2b[0]. Needed to draw rectangles if
2487 font_not_found_p is 1. */
2488 struct glyph *first_glyph;
2489
2490 /* Image, if any. */
2491 struct image *img;
2492
2493 struct glyph_string *next, *prev;
2494 };
2495
2496
2497 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
2498
2499 static void
2500 x_dump_glyph_string (s)
2501 struct glyph_string *s;
2502 {
2503 fprintf (stderr, "glyph string\n");
2504 fprintf (stderr, " x, y, w, h = %d, %d, %d, %d\n",
2505 s->x, s->y, s->width, s->height);
2506 fprintf (stderr, " ybase = %d\n", s->ybase);
2507 fprintf (stderr, " hl = %d\n", s->hl);
2508 fprintf (stderr, " left overhang = %d, right = %d\n",
2509 s->left_overhang, s->right_overhang);
2510 fprintf (stderr, " nchars = %d\n", s->nchars);
2511 fprintf (stderr, " extends to end of line = %d\n",
2512 s->extends_to_end_of_line_p);
2513 fprintf (stderr, " font height = %d\n", FONT_HEIGHT (s->font));
2514 fprintf (stderr, " bg width = %d\n", s->background_width);
2515 }
2516
2517 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
2518
2519
2520
2521 static void x_append_glyph_string_lists P_ ((struct glyph_string **,
2522 struct glyph_string **,
2523 struct glyph_string *,
2524 struct glyph_string *));
2525 static void x_prepend_glyph_string_lists P_ ((struct glyph_string **,
2526 struct glyph_string **,
2527 struct glyph_string *,
2528 struct glyph_string *));
2529 static void x_append_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string **,
2530 struct glyph_string **,
2531 struct glyph_string *));
2532 static int x_left_overwritten P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2533 static int x_left_overwriting P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2534 static int x_right_overwritten P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2535 static int x_right_overwriting P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2536 static int x_fill_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int, int, int,
2537 int));
2538 static void x_init_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *,
2539 XChar2b *, struct window *,
2540 struct glyph_row *,
2541 enum glyph_row_area, int,
2542 enum draw_glyphs_face));
2543 static int x_draw_glyphs P_ ((struct window *, int , struct glyph_row *,
2544 enum glyph_row_area, int, int,
2545 enum draw_glyphs_face, int));
2546 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2547 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2548 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background P_ ((struct glyph_string *,
2549 int));
2550 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2551 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2552 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2553 static void x_draw_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2554 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2555 static void x_set_cursor_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2556 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2557 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2558 static void x_get_glyph_overhangs P_ ((struct glyph *, struct frame *,
2559 int *, int *));
2560 static void x_compute_overhangs_and_x P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int, int));
2561 static int x_alloc_lighter_color P_ ((struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
2562 unsigned long *, double, int));
2563 static void x_setup_relief_color P_ ((struct frame *, struct relief *,
2564 double, int, unsigned long));
2565 static void x_setup_relief_colors P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2566 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2567 static void x_draw_image_relief P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2568 static void x_draw_image_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2569 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 P_ ((struct glyph_string *, Pixmap));
2570 static void x_fill_image_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2571 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int,
2572 int, int, int));
2573 static void x_draw_relief_rect P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
2574 int, int, int, int, XRectangle *));
2575 static void x_draw_box_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
2576 int, int, int, XRectangle *));
2577 static void x_fix_overlapping_area P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *,
2578 enum glyph_row_area));
2579 static int x_fill_stretch_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *,
2580 struct glyph_row *,
2581 enum glyph_row_area, int, int));
2582
2583 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
2584 static void x_check_font P_ ((struct frame *, XFontStruct *));
2585 #endif
2586
2587
2588 /* Append the list of glyph strings with head H and tail T to the list
2589 with head *HEAD and tail *TAIL. Set *HEAD and *TAIL to the result. */
2590
2591 static INLINE void
2592 x_append_glyph_string_lists (head, tail, h, t)
2593 struct glyph_string **head, **tail;
2594 struct glyph_string *h, *t;
2595 {
2596 if (h)
2597 {
2598 if (*head)
2599 (*tail)->next = h;
2600 else
2601 *head = h;
2602 h->prev = *tail;
2603 *tail = t;
2604 }
2605 }
2606
2607
2608 /* Prepend the list of glyph strings with head H and tail T to the
2609 list with head *HEAD and tail *TAIL. Set *HEAD and *TAIL to the
2610 result. */
2611
2612 static INLINE void
2613 x_prepend_glyph_string_lists (head, tail, h, t)
2614 struct glyph_string **head, **tail;
2615 struct glyph_string *h, *t;
2616 {
2617 if (h)
2618 {
2619 if (*head)
2620 (*head)->prev = t;
2621 else
2622 *tail = t;
2623 t->next = *head;
2624 *head = h;
2625 }
2626 }
2627
2628
2629 /* Append glyph string S to the list with head *HEAD and tail *TAIL.
2630 Set *HEAD and *TAIL to the resulting list. */
2631
2632 static INLINE void
2633 x_append_glyph_string (head, tail, s)
2634 struct glyph_string **head, **tail;
2635 struct glyph_string *s;
2636 {
2637 s->next = s->prev = NULL;
2638 x_append_glyph_string_lists (head, tail, s, s);
2639 }
2640
2641
2642 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
2643 face. */
2644
2645 static void
2646 x_set_cursor_gc (s)
2647 struct glyph_string *s;
2648 {
2649 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
2650 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
2651 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
2652 && !s->cmp)
2653 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
2654 else
2655 {
2656 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
2657 XGCValues xgcv;
2658 unsigned long mask;
2659
2660 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
2661 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
2662
2663 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
2664 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
2665 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
2666 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
2667 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
2668 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
2669 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
2670
2671 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
2672 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
2673 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
2674 {
2675 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
2676 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
2677 }
2678
2679 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
2680 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
2681 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
2682 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
2683
2684 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
2685 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
2686 mask, &xgcv);
2687 else
2688 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
2689 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
2690
2691 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
2692 }
2693 }
2694
2695
2696 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
2697
2698 static void
2699 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s)
2700 struct glyph_string *s;
2701 {
2702 int face_id;
2703 struct face *face;
2704
2705 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
2706 face_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
2707 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
2708 if (face == NULL)
2709 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
2710
2711 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2712 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch);
2713 else
2714 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0);
2715 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
2716 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
2717
2718 /* If font in this face is same as S->font, use it. */
2719 if (s->font == s->face->font)
2720 s->gc = s->face->gc;
2721 else
2722 {
2723 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
2724 but font FONT. */
2725 XGCValues xgcv;
2726 unsigned long mask;
2727
2728 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
2729 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
2730 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
2731 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
2732 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
2733 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
2734
2735 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
2736 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
2737 mask, &xgcv);
2738 else
2739 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
2740 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
2741
2742 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
2743 }
2744
2745 xassert (s->gc != 0);
2746 }
2747
2748
2749 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
2750 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
2751 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
2752
2753 static INLINE void
2754 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s)
2755 struct glyph_string *s;
2756 {
2757 s->gc = s->face->gc;
2758 }
2759
2760
2761 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
2762 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
2763 pattern. */
2764
2765 static INLINE void
2766 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s)
2767 struct glyph_string *s;
2768 {
2769 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
2770
2771 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
2772 {
2773 s->gc = s->face->gc;
2774 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2775 }
2776 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
2777 {
2778 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
2779 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2780 }
2781 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2782 {
2783 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
2784 s->stippled_p = 0;
2785 }
2786 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
2787 {
2788 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2789 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2790 }
2791 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2792 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2793 {
2794 s->gc = s->face->gc;
2795 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2796 }
2797 else
2798 {
2799 s->gc = s->face->gc;
2800 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2801 }
2802
2803 /* GC must have been set. */
2804 xassert (s->gc != 0);
2805 }
2806
2807
2808 /* Return in *R the clipping rectangle for glyph string S. */
2809
2810 static void
2811 x_get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, r)
2812 struct glyph_string *s;
2813 XRectangle *r;
2814 {
2815 if (s->row->full_width_p)
2816 {
2817 /* Draw full-width. X coordinates are relative to S->w->left. */
2818 int canon_x = CANON_X_UNIT (s->f);
2819
2820 r->x = WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN (s->w) * canon_x;
2821 r->width = XFASTINT (s->w->width) * canon_x;
2822
2823 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (s->f))
2824 {
2825 int width = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (s->f) * canon_x;
2826 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS_ON_LEFT (s->f))
2827 r->x -= width;
2828 }
2829
2830 r->x += FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (s->f);
2831
2832 /* Unless displaying a mode or menu bar line, which are always
2833 fully visible, clip to the visible part of the row. */
2834 if (s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2835 r->height = s->row->visible_height;
2836 else
2837 r->height = s->height;
2838 }
2839 else
2840 {
2841 /* This is a text line that may be partially visible. */
2842 r->x = WINDOW_AREA_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (s->w, s->area, 0);
2843 r->width = window_box_width (s->w, s->area);
2844 r->height = s->row->visible_height;
2845 }
2846
2847 /* If S draws overlapping rows, it's sufficient to use the top and
2848 bottom of the window for clipping because this glyph string
2849 intentionally draws over other lines. */
2850 if (s->for_overlaps_p)
2851 {
2852 r->y = WINDOW_DISPLAY_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (s->w);
2853 r->height = window_text_bottom_y (s->w) - r->y;
2854 }
2855 else
2856 {
2857 /* Don't use S->y for clipping because it doesn't take partially
2858 visible lines into account. For example, it can be negative for
2859 partially visible lines at the top of a window. */
2860 if (!s->row->full_width_p
2861 && MATRIX_ROW_PARTIALLY_VISIBLE_AT_TOP_P (s->w, s->row))
2862 r->y = WINDOW_DISPLAY_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (s->w);
2863 else
2864 r->y = max (0, s->row->y);
2865
2866 /* If drawing a tool-bar window, draw it over the internal border
2867 at the top of the window. */
2868 if (s->w == XWINDOW (s->f->tool_bar_window))
2869 r->y -= s->f->output_data.x->internal_border_width;
2870 }
2871
2872 r->y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (s->w, r->y);
2873 }
2874
2875
2876 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
2877 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
2878
2879 static INLINE void
2880 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s)
2881 struct glyph_string *s;
2882 {
2883 XRectangle r;
2884 x_get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2885 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2886 }
2887
2888
2889 /* Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. If S is a glyph
2890 string for a composition, assume overhangs don't exist. */
2891
2892 static INLINE void
2893 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s)
2894 struct glyph_string *s;
2895 {
2896 if (s->cmp == NULL
2897 && s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2898 {
2899 XCharStruct cs;
2900 int direction, font_ascent, font_descent;
2901 XTextExtents16 (s->font, s->char2b, s->nchars, &direction,
2902 &font_ascent, &font_descent, &cs);
2903 s->right_overhang = cs.rbearing > cs.width ? cs.rbearing - cs.width : 0;
2904 s->left_overhang = cs.lbearing < 0 ? -cs.lbearing : 0;
2905 }
2906 }
2907
2908
2909 /* Compute overhangs and x-positions for glyph string S and its
2910 predecessors, or successors. X is the starting x-position for S.
2911 BACKWARD_P non-zero means process predecessors. */
2912
2913 static void
2914 x_compute_overhangs_and_x (s, x, backward_p)
2915 struct glyph_string *s;
2916 int x;
2917 int backward_p;
2918 {
2919 if (backward_p)
2920 {
2921 while (s)
2922 {
2923 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s);
2924 x -= s->width;
2925 s->x = x;
2926 s = s->prev;
2927 }
2928 }
2929 else
2930 {
2931 while (s)
2932 {
2933 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s);
2934 s->x = x;
2935 x += s->width;
2936 s = s->next;
2937 }
2938 }
2939 }
2940
2941
2942 /* Set *LEFT and *RIGHT to the left and right overhang of GLYPH on
2943 frame F. Overhangs of glyphs other than type CHAR_GLYPH are
2944 assumed to be zero. */
2945
2946 static void
2947 x_get_glyph_overhangs (glyph, f, left, right)
2948 struct glyph *glyph;
2949 struct frame *f;
2950 int *left, *right;
2951 {
2952 *left = *right = 0;
2953
2954 if (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2955 {
2956 XFontStruct *font;
2957 struct face *face;
2958 struct font_info *font_info;
2959 XChar2b char2b;
2960 XCharStruct *pcm;
2961
2962 face = x_get_glyph_face_and_encoding (f, glyph, &char2b, NULL);
2963 font = face->font;
2964 font_info = FONT_INFO_FROM_ID (f, face->font_info_id);
2965 if (font
2966 && (pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b)))
2967 {
2968 if (pcm->rbearing > pcm->width)
2969 *right = pcm->rbearing - pcm->width;
2970 if (pcm->lbearing < 0)
2971 *left = -pcm->lbearing;
2972 }
2973 }
2974 }
2975
2976
2977 /* Return the index of the first glyph preceding glyph string S that
2978 is overwritten by S because of S's left overhang. Value is -1
2979 if no glyphs are overwritten. */
2980
2981 static int
2982 x_left_overwritten (s)
2983 struct glyph_string *s;
2984 {
2985 int k;
2986
2987 if (s->left_overhang)
2988 {
2989 int x = 0, i;
2990 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
2991 int first = s->first_glyph - glyphs;
2992
2993 for (i = first - 1; i >= 0 && x > -s->left_overhang; --i)
2994 x -= glyphs[i].pixel_width;
2995
2996 k = i + 1;
2997 }
2998 else
2999 k = -1;
3000
3001 return k;
3002 }
3003
3004
3005 /* Return the index of the first glyph preceding glyph string S that
3006 is overwriting S because of its right overhang. Value is -1 if no
3007 glyph in front of S overwrites S. */
3008
3009 static int
3010 x_left_overwriting (s)
3011 struct glyph_string *s;
3012 {
3013 int i, k, x;
3014 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
3015 int first = s->first_glyph - glyphs;
3016
3017 k = -1;
3018 x = 0;
3019 for (i = first - 1; i >= 0; --i)
3020 {
3021 int left, right;
3022 x_get_glyph_overhangs (glyphs + i, s->f, &left, &right);
3023 if (x + right > 0)
3024 k = i;
3025 x -= glyphs[i].pixel_width;
3026 }
3027
3028 return k;
3029 }
3030
3031
3032 /* Return the index of the last glyph following glyph string S that is
3033 not overwritten by S because of S's right overhang. Value is -1 if
3034 no such glyph is found. */
3035
3036 static int
3037 x_right_overwritten (s)
3038 struct glyph_string *s;
3039 {
3040 int k = -1;
3041
3042 if (s->right_overhang)
3043 {
3044 int x = 0, i;
3045 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
3046 int first = (s->first_glyph - glyphs) + (s->cmp ? 1 : s->nchars);
3047 int end = s->row->used[s->area];
3048
3049 for (i = first; i < end && s->right_overhang > x; ++i)
3050 x += glyphs[i].pixel_width;
3051
3052 k = i;
3053 }
3054
3055 return k;
3056 }
3057
3058
3059 /* Return the index of the last glyph following glyph string S that
3060 overwrites S because of its left overhang. Value is negative
3061 if no such glyph is found. */
3062
3063 static int
3064 x_right_overwriting (s)
3065 struct glyph_string *s;
3066 {
3067 int i, k, x;
3068 int end = s->row->used[s->area];
3069 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
3070 int first = (s->first_glyph - glyphs) + (s->cmp ? 1 : s->nchars);
3071
3072 k = -1;
3073 x = 0;
3074 for (i = first; i < end; ++i)
3075 {
3076 int left, right;
3077 x_get_glyph_overhangs (glyphs + i, s->f, &left, &right);
3078 if (x - left < 0)
3079 k = i;
3080 x += glyphs[i].pixel_width;
3081 }
3082
3083 return k;
3084 }
3085
3086
3087 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
3088
3089 static INLINE void
3090 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
3091 struct glyph_string *s;
3092 int x, y, w, h;
3093 {
3094 XGCValues xgcv;
3095 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
3096 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
3097 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
3098 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
3099 }
3100
3101
3102 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
3103 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
3104 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
3105 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
3106 contains the first component of a composition. */
3107
3108 static void
3109 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, force_p)
3110 struct glyph_string *s;
3111 int force_p;
3112 {
3113 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
3114 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
3115 if (!s->background_filled_p)
3116 {
3117 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
3118
3119 if (s->stippled_p)
3120 {
3121 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
3122 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
3123 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
3124 s->y + box_line_width,
3125 s->background_width,
3126 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
3127 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
3128 s->background_filled_p = 1;
3129 }
3130 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
3131 || s->font_not_found_p
3132 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
3133 || force_p)
3134 {
3135 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
3136 s->background_width,
3137 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
3138 s->background_filled_p = 1;
3139 }
3140 }
3141 }
3142
3143
3144 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
3145
3146 static void
3147 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s)
3148 struct glyph_string *s;
3149 {
3150 int i, x;
3151
3152 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
3153 of S to the right of that box line. */
3154 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
3155 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
3156 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
3157 else
3158 x = s->x;
3159
3160 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
3161 loaded. */
3162 if (s->font_not_found_p)
3163 {
3164 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
3165 {
3166 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
3167 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
3168 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
3169 s->height - 1);
3170 x += g->pixel_width;
3171 }
3172 }
3173 else
3174 {
3175 char *char1b = (char *) s->char2b;
3176 int boff = s->font_info->baseline_offset;
3177
3178 if (s->font_info->vertical_centering)
3179 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (s->font, s->f) - boff;
3180
3181 /* If we can use 8-bit functions, condense S->char2b. */
3182 if (!s->two_byte_p)
3183 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
3184 char1b[i] = s->char2b[i].byte2;
3185
3186 /* Draw text with XDrawString if background has already been
3187 filled. Otherwise, use XDrawImageString. (Note that
3188 XDrawImageString is usually faster than XDrawString.) Always
3189 use XDrawImageString when drawing the cursor so that there is
3190 no chance that characters under a box cursor are invisible. */
3191 if (s->for_overlaps_p
3192 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
3193 {
3194 /* Draw characters with 16-bit or 8-bit functions. */
3195 if (s->two_byte_p)
3196 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
3197 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
3198 else
3199 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
3200 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
3201 }
3202 else
3203 {
3204 if (s->two_byte_p)
3205 XDrawImageString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
3206 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
3207 else
3208 XDrawImageString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
3209 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
3210 }
3211 }
3212 }
3213
3214 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
3215
3216 static void
3217 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s)
3218 struct glyph_string *s;
3219 {
3220 int i, x;
3221
3222 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
3223 of S to the right of that box line. */
3224 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
3225 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
3226 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
3227 else
3228 x = s->x;
3229
3230 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->gidx is the index of
3231 the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
3232 S->gidx == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
3233 this composition. */
3234
3235 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
3236 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
3237 if (s->font_not_found_p)
3238 {
3239 if (s->gidx == 0)
3240 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
3241 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
3242 }
3243 else
3244 {
3245 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, ++s->gidx)
3246 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
3247 x + s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2],
3248 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2 + 1],
3249 s->char2b + i, 1);
3250 }
3251 }
3252
3253
3254 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
3255
3256 static struct frame *x_frame_of_widget P_ ((Widget));
3257 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel P_ ((Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
3258 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *));
3259 static void cvt_pixel_dtor P_ ((XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
3260 XrmValue *, Cardinal *));
3261
3262
3263 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
3264 cannot be determined. */
3265
3266 static struct frame *
3267 x_frame_of_widget (widget)
3268 Widget widget;
3269 {
3270 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3271 Lisp_Object tail;
3272 struct frame *f;
3273
3274 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
3275
3276 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
3277 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
3278 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
3279 x_any_window_to_frame. */
3280 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
3281 widget = XtParent (widget);
3282
3283 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
3284 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
3285 for (tail = Vframe_list; GC_CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
3286 if (GC_FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
3287 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
3288 (f->output_data.nothing != 1
3289 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
3290 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
3291 return f;
3292
3293 abort ();
3294 }
3295
3296
3297 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on the screen and display of
3298 widget WIDGET in colormap CMAP. If an exact match cannot be
3299 allocated, try the nearest color available. Value is non-zero
3300 if successful. This is called from lwlib. */
3301
3302 int
3303 x_alloc_nearest_color_for_widget (widget, cmap, color)
3304 Widget widget;
3305 Colormap cmap;
3306 XColor *color;
3307 {
3308 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
3309 return x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color);
3310 }
3311
3312
3313 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
3314 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
3315 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
3316 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
3317 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
3318 Value is non-zero if successful. */
3319
3320 int
3321 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (widget, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
3322 Widget widget;
3323 Display *display;
3324 Colormap cmap;
3325 unsigned long *pixel;
3326 double factor;
3327 int delta;
3328 {
3329 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
3330 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
3331 }
3332
3333
3334 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
3335 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
3336
3337 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
3338 {
3339 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
3340 sizeof (Screen *)},
3341 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
3342 sizeof (Colormap)}
3343 };
3344
3345
3346 /* The address of this variable is returned by
3347 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
3348
3349 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
3350
3351
3352 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
3353
3354 DPY is the display we are working on.
3355
3356 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
3357 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
3358 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
3359 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
3360
3361 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
3362 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
3363
3364 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
3365 we allocated the color or not.
3366
3367 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
3368
3369 static Boolean
3370 cvt_string_to_pixel (dpy, args, nargs, from, to, closure_ret)
3371 Display *dpy;
3372 XrmValue *args;
3373 Cardinal *nargs;
3374 XrmValue *from, *to;
3375 XtPointer *closure_ret;
3376 {
3377 Screen *screen;
3378 Colormap cmap;
3379 Pixel pixel;
3380 String color_name;
3381 XColor color;
3382
3383 if (*nargs != 2)
3384 {
3385 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
3386 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
3387 "XtToolkitError",
3388 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
3389 return False;
3390 }
3391
3392 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
3393 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
3394 color_name = (String) from->addr;
3395
3396 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
3397 {
3398 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
3399 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
3400 }
3401 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
3402 {
3403 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
3404 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
3405 }
3406 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
3407 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
3408 {
3409 pixel = color.pixel;
3410 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
3411 }
3412 else
3413 {
3414 String params[1];
3415 Cardinal nparams = 1;
3416
3417 params[0] = color_name;
3418 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
3419 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
3420 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
3421 params, &nparams);
3422 return False;
3423 }
3424
3425 if (to->addr != NULL)
3426 {
3427 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
3428 {
3429 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
3430 return False;
3431 }
3432
3433 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
3434 }
3435 else
3436 {
3437 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
3438 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
3439 }
3440
3441 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
3442 return True;
3443 }
3444
3445
3446 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
3447 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
3448 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
3449
3450 APP is the application context in which we work.
3451
3452 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
3453 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
3454 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
3455
3456 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
3457
3458 static void
3459 cvt_pixel_dtor (app, to, closure, args, nargs)
3460 XtAppContext app;
3461 XrmValuePtr to;
3462 XtPointer closure;
3463 XrmValuePtr args;
3464 Cardinal *nargs;
3465 {
3466 if (*nargs != 2)
3467 {
3468 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
3469 "XtToolkitError",
3470 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
3471 NULL, NULL);
3472 }
3473 else if (closure != NULL)
3474 {
3475 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
3476 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
3477 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
3478 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
3479 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
3480 }
3481 }
3482
3483
3484 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3485
3486
3487 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
3488 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
3489 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
3490 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
3491
3492 static const XColor *
3493 x_color_cells (dpy, ncells)
3494 Display *dpy;
3495 int *ncells;
3496 {
3497 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
3498
3499 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
3500 {
3501 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
3502 int i;
3503
3504 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
3505 = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
3506 dpyinfo->color_cells
3507 = (XColor *) xmalloc (dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
3508 * sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
3509
3510 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells; ++i)
3511 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
3512
3513 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
3514 dpyinfo->color_cells, dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
3515 }
3516
3517 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
3518 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
3519 }
3520
3521
3522 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
3523 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
3524
3525 void
3526 x_query_colors (f, colors, ncolors)
3527 struct frame *f;
3528 XColor *colors;
3529 int ncolors;
3530 {
3531 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
3532
3533 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
3534 {
3535 int i;
3536 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
3537 {
3538 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
3539 xassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
3540 xassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
3541 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
3542 }
3543 }
3544 else
3545 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
3546 }
3547
3548
3549 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
3550 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
3551
3552 void
3553 x_query_color (f, color)
3554 struct frame *f;
3555 XColor *color;
3556 {
3557 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
3558 }
3559
3560
3561 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
3562 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
3563 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
3564 allocated. */
3565
3566 static int
3567 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, color)
3568 Display *dpy;
3569 Colormap cmap;
3570 XColor *color;
3571 {
3572 int rc;
3573
3574 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
3575 if (rc == 0)
3576 {
3577 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
3578 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
3579 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
3580 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
3581 int nearest, i;
3582 unsigned long nearest_delta = ~0;
3583 int ncells;
3584 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
3585
3586 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
3587 {
3588 long dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
3589 long dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
3590 long dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
3591 unsigned long delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
3592
3593 if (delta < nearest_delta)
3594 {
3595 nearest = i;
3596 nearest_delta = delta;
3597 }
3598 }
3599
3600 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
3601 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
3602 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
3603 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
3604 }
3605 else
3606 {
3607 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
3608 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
3609 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
3610 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
3611 XColor *cached_color;
3612
3613 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
3614 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
3615 (cached_color->red != color->red
3616 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
3617 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
3618 {
3619 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
3620 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
3621 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
3622 }
3623 }
3624
3625 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
3626 if (rc)
3627 register_color (color->pixel);
3628 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
3629
3630 return rc;
3631 }
3632
3633
3634 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
3635 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
3636 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
3637 allocated. */
3638
3639 int
3640 x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color)
3641 struct frame *f;
3642 Colormap cmap;
3643 XColor *color;
3644 {
3645 gamma_correct (f, color);
3646 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
3647 }
3648
3649
3650 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
3651 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
3652 get color reference counts right. */
3653
3654 unsigned long
3655 x_copy_color (f, pixel)
3656 struct frame *f;
3657 unsigned long pixel;
3658 {
3659 XColor color;
3660
3661 color.pixel = pixel;
3662 BLOCK_INPUT;
3663 x_query_color (f, &color);
3664 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
3665 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3666 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
3667 register_color (pixel);
3668 #endif
3669 return color.pixel;
3670 }
3671
3672
3673 /* Allocate color PIXEL on display DPY. PIXEL must already be allocated.
3674 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
3675 get color reference counts right. */
3676
3677 unsigned long
3678 x_copy_dpy_color (dpy, cmap, pixel)
3679 Display *dpy;
3680 Colormap cmap;
3681 unsigned long pixel;
3682 {
3683 XColor color;
3684
3685 color.pixel = pixel;
3686 BLOCK_INPUT;
3687 XQueryColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
3688 XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
3689 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3690 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
3691 register_color (pixel);
3692 #endif
3693 return color.pixel;
3694 }
3695
3696
3697 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
3698 boosted.
3699
3700 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
3701 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
3702 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
3703 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
3704 use an additional additive factor.
3705
3706 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
3707 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
3708 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
3709
3710
3711 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
3712 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
3713 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
3714 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
3715 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
3716 Value is non-zero if successful. */
3717
3718 static int
3719 x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
3720 struct frame *f;
3721 Display *display;
3722 Colormap cmap;
3723 unsigned long *pixel;
3724 double factor;
3725 int delta;
3726 {
3727 XColor color, new;
3728 long bright;
3729 int success_p;
3730
3731 /* Get RGB color values. */
3732 color.pixel = *pixel;
3733 x_query_color (f, &color);
3734
3735 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
3736 xassert (factor >= 0);
3737 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
3738 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
3739 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
3740
3741 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
3742 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
3743
3744 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
3745 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
3746 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
3747 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
3748 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
3749 {
3750 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
3751 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
3752 /* The additive adjustment. */
3753 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
3754
3755 if (factor < 1)
3756 {
3757 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
3758 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
3759 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
3760 }
3761 else
3762 {
3763 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
3764 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
3765 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
3766 }
3767 }
3768
3769 /* Try to allocate the color. */
3770 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
3771 if (success_p)
3772 {
3773 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
3774 {
3775 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
3776 delta to the RGB values. */
3777 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
3778
3779 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
3780 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
3781 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
3782 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
3783 }
3784 else
3785 success_p = 1;
3786 *pixel = new.pixel;
3787 }
3788
3789 return success_p;
3790 }
3791
3792
3793 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
3794 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
3795 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
3796 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
3797 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
3798 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
3799
3800 static void
3801 x_setup_relief_color (f, relief, factor, delta, default_pixel)
3802 struct frame *f;
3803 struct relief *relief;
3804 double factor;
3805 int delta;
3806 unsigned long default_pixel;
3807 {
3808 XGCValues xgcv;
3809 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
3810 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
3811 unsigned long pixel;
3812 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
3813 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
3814 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
3815 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
3816
3817 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
3818 xgcv.line_width = 1;
3819
3820 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
3821 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
3822 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
3823 if (relief->gc
3824 && relief->allocated_p)
3825 {
3826 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
3827 relief->allocated_p = 0;
3828 }
3829
3830 /* Allocate new color. */
3831 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
3832 pixel = background;
3833 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
3834 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
3835 {
3836 relief->allocated_p = 1;
3837 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
3838 }
3839
3840 if (relief->gc == 0)
3841 {
3842 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
3843 mask |= GCStipple;
3844 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
3845 }
3846 else
3847 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
3848 }
3849
3850
3851 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
3852
3853 static void
3854 x_setup_relief_colors (s)
3855 struct glyph_string *s;
3856 {
3857 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
3858 unsigned long color;
3859
3860 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
3861 color = s->face->box_color;
3862 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
3863 && s->img->pixmap
3864 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
3865 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
3866 else
3867 {
3868 XGCValues xgcv;
3869
3870 /* Get the background color of the face. */
3871 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
3872 color = xgcv.background;
3873 }
3874
3875 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
3876 || color != di->relief_background)
3877 {
3878 di->relief_background = color;
3879 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
3880 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
3881 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
3882 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
3883 }
3884 }
3885
3886
3887 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
3888 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
3889 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
3890 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
3891 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
3892 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
3893 when drawing. */
3894
3895 static void
3896 x_draw_relief_rect (f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
3897 raised_p, left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
3898 struct frame *f;
3899 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, left_p, right_p, raised_p;
3900 XRectangle *clip_rect;
3901 {
3902 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
3903 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
3904 int i;
3905 GC gc;
3906
3907 if (raised_p)
3908 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
3909 else
3910 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
3911 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
3912
3913 /* Top. */
3914 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
3915 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
3916 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
3917 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
3918
3919 /* Left. */
3920 if (left_p)
3921 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
3922 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
3923 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
3924
3925 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
3926 if (raised_p)
3927 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
3928 else
3929 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
3930 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
3931
3932 /* Bottom. */
3933 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
3934 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
3935 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
3936 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
3937
3938 /* Right. */
3939 if (right_p)
3940 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
3941 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
3942 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
3943
3944 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
3945 }
3946
3947
3948 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
3949 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
3950 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
3951 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
3952 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
3953 rectangle to use when drawing. */
3954
3955 static void
3956 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
3957 left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
3958 struct glyph_string *s;
3959 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, left_p, right_p;
3960 XRectangle *clip_rect;
3961 {
3962 XGCValues xgcv;
3963
3964 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
3965 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
3966 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
3967
3968 /* Top. */
3969 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
3970 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
3971
3972 /* Left. */
3973 if (left_p)
3974 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
3975 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
3976
3977 /* Bottom. */
3978 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
3979 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
3980
3981 /* Right. */
3982 if (right_p)
3983 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
3984 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
3985
3986 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
3987 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
3988 }
3989
3990
3991 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
3992
3993 static void
3994 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s)
3995 struct glyph_string *s;
3996 {
3997 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
3998 int left_p, right_p;
3999 struct glyph *last_glyph;
4000 XRectangle clip_rect;
4001
4002 last_x = window_box_right (s->w, s->area);
4003 if (s->row->full_width_p
4004 && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
4005 {
4006 last_x += FRAME_X_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (s->f);
4007 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS_ON_RIGHT (s->f))
4008 last_x += FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (s->f) * CANON_X_UNIT (s->f);
4009 }
4010
4011 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
4012 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
4013 ? s->first_glyph
4014 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
4015
4016 width = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
4017 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
4018 left_x = s->x;
4019 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
4020 ? last_x - 1
4021 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
4022 top_y = s->y;
4023 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
4024
4025 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
4026 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
4027 && (s->prev == NULL
4028 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
4029 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
4030 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
4031 && (s->next == NULL
4032 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
4033
4034 x_get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
4035
4036 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
4037 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
4038 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
4039 else
4040 {
4041 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
4042 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
4043 width, raised_p, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
4044 }
4045 }
4046
4047
4048 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
4049
4050 static void
4051 x_draw_image_foreground (s)
4052 struct glyph_string *s;
4053 {
4054 int x;
4055 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face);
4056
4057 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
4058 right of that line. */
4059 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
4060 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
4061 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
4062 else
4063 x = s->x;
4064
4065 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
4066 by that margin. */
4067 x += s->img->hmargin;
4068 y += s->img->vmargin;
4069
4070 if (s->img->pixmap)
4071 {
4072 if (s->img->mask)
4073 {
4074 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
4075 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
4076 trust on the shape extension to be available
4077 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
4078 manually. */
4079 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
4080 | GCFunction);
4081 XGCValues xgcv;
4082 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
4083
4084 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
4085 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
4086 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
4087 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
4088 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
4089
4090 x_get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
4091 image_rect.x = x;
4092 image_rect.y = y;
4093 image_rect.width = s->img->width;
4094 image_rect.height = s->img->height;
4095 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
4096 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
4097 r.x - x, r.y - y, r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
4098 }
4099 else
4100 {
4101 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
4102
4103 x_get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
4104 image_rect.x = x;
4105 image_rect.y = y;
4106 image_rect.width = s->img->width;
4107 image_rect.height = s->img->height;
4108 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
4109 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
4110 r.x - x, r.y - y, r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
4111
4112 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
4113 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
4114 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
4115 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
4116 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
4117 nothing here for mouse-face. */
4118 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
4119 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
4120 s->img->width - 1, s->img->height - 1);
4121 }
4122 }
4123 else
4124 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
4125 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
4126 s->img->width - 1, s->img->height - 1);
4127 }
4128
4129
4130 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
4131
4132 static void
4133 x_draw_image_relief (s)
4134 struct glyph_string *s;
4135 {
4136 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p;
4137 XRectangle r;
4138 int x;
4139 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face);
4140
4141 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
4142 right of that line. */
4143 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
4144 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
4145 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
4146 else
4147 x = s->x;
4148
4149 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
4150 by that margin. */
4151 x += s->img->hmargin;
4152 y += s->img->vmargin;
4153
4154 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
4155 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
4156 {
4157 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
4158 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
4159 }
4160 else
4161 {
4162 thick = abs (s->img->relief);
4163 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
4164 }
4165
4166 x0 = x - thick;
4167 y0 = y - thick;
4168 x1 = x + s->img->width + thick - 1;
4169 y1 = y + s->img->height + thick - 1;
4170
4171 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
4172 x_get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
4173 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p, 1, 1, &r);
4174 }
4175
4176
4177 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
4178
4179 static void
4180 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap)
4181 struct glyph_string *s;
4182 Pixmap pixmap;
4183 {
4184 int x;
4185 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face);
4186
4187 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
4188 right of that line. */
4189 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
4190 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
4191 x = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
4192 else
4193 x = 0;
4194
4195 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
4196 by that margin. */
4197 x += s->img->hmargin;
4198 y += s->img->vmargin;
4199
4200 if (s->img->pixmap)
4201 {
4202 if (s->img->mask)
4203 {
4204 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
4205 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
4206 trust on the shape extension to be available
4207 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
4208 manually. */
4209 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
4210 | GCFunction);
4211 XGCValues xgcv;
4212
4213 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
4214 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
4215 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
4216 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
4217 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
4218
4219 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
4220 0, 0, s->img->width, s->img->height, x, y);
4221 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
4222 }
4223 else
4224 {
4225 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
4226 0, 0, s->img->width, s->img->height, x, y);
4227
4228 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
4229 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
4230 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
4231 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
4232 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
4233 nothing here for mouse-face. */
4234 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
4235 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
4236 s->img->width - 1, s->img->height - 1);
4237 }
4238 }
4239 else
4240 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
4241 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
4242 s->img->width - 1, s->img->height - 1);
4243 }
4244
4245
4246 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
4247 give the rectangle to draw. */
4248
4249 static void
4250 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
4251 struct glyph_string *s;
4252 int x, y, w, h;
4253 {
4254 if (s->stippled_p)
4255 {
4256 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
4257 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
4258 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
4259 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
4260 }
4261 else
4262 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
4263 }
4264
4265
4266 /* Draw image glyph string S.
4267
4268 s->y
4269 s->x +-------------------------
4270 | s->face->box
4271 |
4272 | +-------------------------
4273 | | s->img->margin
4274 | |
4275 | | +-------------------
4276 | | | the image
4277
4278 */
4279
4280 static void
4281 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s)
4282 struct glyph_string *s;
4283 {
4284 int x, y;
4285 int box_line_hwidth = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
4286 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
4287 int height;
4288 Pixmap pixmap = None;
4289
4290 height = s->height - 2 * box_line_vwidth;
4291
4292 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
4293 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
4294 flickering. */
4295 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
4296 if (height > s->img->height
4297 || s->img->hmargin
4298 || s->img->vmargin
4299 || s->img->mask
4300 || s->img->pixmap == 0
4301 || s->width != s->background_width)
4302 {
4303 if (box_line_hwidth && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
4304 x = s->x + box_line_hwidth;
4305 else
4306 x = s->x;
4307
4308 y = s->y + box_line_vwidth;
4309
4310 if (s->img->mask)
4311 {
4312 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
4313 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
4314 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
4315 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
4316 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
4317
4318 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
4319 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
4320 s->background_width,
4321 s->height, depth);
4322
4323 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
4324 pixmap. */
4325 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
4326
4327 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
4328 if (s->stippled_p)
4329 {
4330 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
4331 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
4332 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
4333 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
4334 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
4335 }
4336 else
4337 {
4338 XGCValues xgcv;
4339 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
4340 &xgcv);
4341 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
4342 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
4343 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
4344 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
4345 }
4346 }
4347 else
4348 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
4349
4350 s->background_filled_p = 1;
4351 }
4352
4353 /* Draw the foreground. */
4354 if (pixmap != None)
4355 {
4356 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
4357 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
4358 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
4359 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
4360 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
4361 }
4362 else
4363 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
4364
4365 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
4366 if (s->img->relief
4367 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
4368 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
4369 x_draw_image_relief (s);
4370 }
4371
4372
4373 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
4374
4375 static void
4376 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s)
4377 struct glyph_string *s;
4378 {
4379 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
4380 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
4381
4382 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
4383 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
4384 {
4385 /* If `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor
4386 as wide as the stretch glyph. */
4387 int width = min (CANON_X_UNIT (s->f), s->background_width);
4388
4389 /* Draw cursor. */
4390 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, s->x, s->y, width, s->height);
4391
4392 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
4393 if (width < s->background_width)
4394 {
4395 int x = s->x + width, y = s->y;
4396 int w = s->background_width - width, h = s->height;
4397 XRectangle r;
4398 GC gc;
4399
4400 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
4401 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
4402 {
4403 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
4404 gc = s->gc;
4405 }
4406 else
4407 gc = s->face->gc;
4408
4409 x_get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
4410 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
4411
4412 if (s->face->stipple)
4413 {
4414 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
4415 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
4416 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
4417 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
4418 }
4419 else
4420 {
4421 XGCValues xgcv;
4422 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
4423 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
4424 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
4425 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
4426 }
4427 }
4428 }
4429 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
4430 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, s->x, s->y, s->background_width,
4431 s->height);
4432
4433 s->background_filled_p = 1;
4434 }
4435
4436
4437 /* Draw glyph string S. */
4438
4439 static void
4440 x_draw_glyph_string (s)
4441 struct glyph_string *s;
4442 {
4443 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
4444
4445 /* If S draws into the background of its successor, draw the
4446 background of the successor first so that S can draw into it.
4447 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
4448 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps_p)
4449 {
4450 xassert (s->next->img == NULL);
4451 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s->next);
4452 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s->next);
4453 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s->next, 1);
4454 }
4455
4456 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
4457 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
4458
4459 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
4460 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
4461 if (!s->for_overlaps_p
4462 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
4463 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
4464 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
4465
4466 {
4467 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
4468 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
4469 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
4470 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
4471 relief_drawn_p = 1;
4472 }
4473 else
4474 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
4475
4476 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
4477 {
4478 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
4479 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
4480 break;
4481
4482 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
4483 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
4484 break;
4485
4486 case CHAR_GLYPH:
4487 if (s->for_overlaps_p)
4488 s->background_filled_p = 1;
4489 else
4490 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
4491 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
4492 break;
4493
4494 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
4495 if (s->for_overlaps_p || s->gidx > 0)
4496 s->background_filled_p = 1;
4497 else
4498 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
4499 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
4500 break;
4501
4502 default:
4503 abort ();
4504 }
4505
4506 if (!s->for_overlaps_p)
4507 {
4508 /* Draw underline. */
4509 if (s->face->underline_p)
4510 {
4511 unsigned long tem, h;
4512 int y;
4513
4514 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
4515 if (!XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_THICKNESS, &h))
4516 h = 1;
4517
4518 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
4519 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
4520 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
4521 specs, and its default is
4522
4523 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
4524 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
4525
4526 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
4527 && XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_POSITION, &tem))
4528 y = s->ybase + (long) tem;
4529 else if (s->face->font)
4530 y = s->ybase + (s->face->font->max_bounds.descent + 1) / 2;
4531 else
4532 y = s->y + s->height - h;
4533
4534 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
4535 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
4536 s->x, y, s->width, h);
4537 else
4538 {
4539 XGCValues xgcv;
4540 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
4541 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
4542 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
4543 s->x, y, s->width, h);
4544 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
4545 }
4546 }
4547
4548 /* Draw overline. */
4549 if (s->face->overline_p)
4550 {
4551 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
4552
4553 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
4554 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
4555 s->width, h);
4556 else
4557 {
4558 XGCValues xgcv;
4559 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
4560 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
4561 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
4562 s->width, h);
4563 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
4564 }
4565 }
4566
4567 /* Draw strike-through. */
4568 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
4569 {
4570 unsigned long h = 1;
4571 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
4572
4573 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
4574 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
4575 s->width, h);
4576 else
4577 {
4578 XGCValues xgcv;
4579 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
4580 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
4581 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
4582 s->width, h);
4583 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
4584 }
4585 }
4586
4587 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
4588 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
4589 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
4590 }
4591
4592 /* Reset clipping. */
4593 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
4594 }
4595
4596
4597 static int x_fill_composite_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *,
4598 struct face **, int));
4599
4600
4601 /* Fill glyph string S with composition components specified by S->cmp.
4602
4603 FACES is an array of faces for all components of this composition.
4604 S->gidx is the index of the first component for S.
4605 OVERLAPS_P non-zero means S should draw the foreground only, and
4606 use its physical height for clipping.
4607
4608 Value is the index of a component not in S. */
4609
4610 static int
4611 x_fill_composite_glyph_string (s, faces, overlaps_p)
4612 struct glyph_string *s;
4613 struct face **faces;
4614 int overlaps_p;
4615 {
4616 int i;
4617
4618 xassert (s);
4619
4620 s->for_overlaps_p = overlaps_p;
4621
4622 s->face = faces[s->gidx];
4623 s->font = s->face->font;
4624 s->font_info = FONT_INFO_FROM_ID (s->f, s->face->font_info_id);
4625
4626 /* For all glyphs of this composition, starting at the offset
4627 S->gidx, until we reach the end of the definition or encounter a
4628 glyph that requires the different face, add it to S. */
4629 ++s->nchars;
4630 for (i = s->gidx + 1; i < s->cmp->glyph_len && faces[i] == s->face; ++i)
4631 ++s->nchars;
4632
4633 /* All glyph strings for the same composition has the same width,
4634 i.e. the width set for the first component of the composition. */
4635
4636 s->width = s->first_glyph->pixel_width;
4637
4638 /* If the specified font could not be loaded, use the frame's
4639 default font, but record the fact that we couldn't load it in
4640 the glyph string so that we can draw rectangles for the
4641 characters of the glyph string. */
4642 if (s->font == NULL)
4643 {
4644 s->font_not_found_p = 1;
4645 s->font = FRAME_FONT (s->f);
4646 }
4647
4648 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
4649 s->ybase += s->first_glyph->voffset;
4650
4651 xassert (s->face && s->face->gc);
4652
4653 /* This glyph string must always be drawn with 16-bit functions. */
4654 s->two_byte_p = 1;
4655
4656 return s->gidx + s->nchars;
4657 }
4658
4659
4660 /* Fill glyph string S from a sequence of character glyphs.
4661
4662 FACE_ID is the face id of the string. START is the index of the
4663 first glyph to consider, END is the index of the last + 1.
4664 OVERLAPS_P non-zero means S should draw the foreground only, and
4665 use its physical height for clipping.
4666
4667 Value is the index of the first glyph not in S. */
4668
4669 static int
4670 x_fill_glyph_string (s, face_id, start, end, overlaps_p)
4671 struct glyph_string *s;
4672 int face_id;
4673 int start, end, overlaps_p;
4674 {
4675 struct glyph *glyph, *last;
4676 int voffset;
4677 int glyph_not_available_p;
4678
4679 xassert (s->f == XFRAME (s->w->frame));
4680 xassert (s->nchars == 0);
4681 xassert (start >= 0 && end > start);
4682
4683 s->for_overlaps_p = overlaps_p,
4684 glyph = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + start;
4685 last = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + end;
4686 voffset = glyph->voffset;
4687
4688 glyph_not_available_p = glyph->glyph_not_available_p;
4689
4690 while (glyph < last
4691 && glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
4692 && glyph->voffset == voffset
4693 /* Same face id implies same font, nowadays. */
4694 && glyph->face_id == face_id
4695 && glyph->glyph_not_available_p == glyph_not_available_p)
4696 {
4697 int two_byte_p;
4698
4699 s->face = x_get_glyph_face_and_encoding (s->f, glyph,
4700 s->char2b + s->nchars,
4701 &two_byte_p);
4702 s->two_byte_p = two_byte_p;
4703 ++s->nchars;
4704 xassert (s->nchars <= end - start);
4705 s->width += glyph->pixel_width;
4706 ++glyph;
4707 }
4708
4709 s->font = s->face->font;
4710 s->font_info = FONT_INFO_FROM_ID (s->f, s->face->font_info_id);
4711
4712 /* If the specified font could not be loaded, use the frame's font,
4713 but record the fact that we couldn't load it in
4714 S->font_not_found_p so that we can draw rectangles for the
4715 characters of the glyph string. */
4716 if (s->font == NULL || glyph_not_available_p)
4717 {
4718 s->font_not_found_p = 1;
4719 s->font = FRAME_FONT (s->f);
4720 }
4721
4722 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
4723 s->ybase += voffset;
4724
4725 xassert (s->face && s->face->gc);
4726 return glyph - s->row->glyphs[s->area];
4727 }
4728
4729
4730 /* Fill glyph string S from image glyph S->first_glyph. */
4731
4732 static void
4733 x_fill_image_glyph_string (s)
4734 struct glyph_string *s;
4735 {
4736 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH);
4737 s->img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (s->f, s->first_glyph->u.img_id);
4738 xassert (s->img);
4739 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, s->first_glyph->face_id);
4740 s->font = s->face->font;
4741 s->width = s->first_glyph->pixel_width;
4742
4743 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
4744 s->ybase += s->first_glyph->voffset;
4745 }
4746
4747
4748 /* Fill glyph string S from a sequence of stretch glyphs.
4749
4750 ROW is the glyph row in which the glyphs are found, AREA is the
4751 area within the row. START is the index of the first glyph to
4752 consider, END is the index of the last + 1.
4753
4754 Value is the index of the first glyph not in S. */
4755
4756 static int
4757 x_fill_stretch_glyph_string (s, row, area, start, end)
4758 struct glyph_string *s;
4759 struct glyph_row *row;
4760 enum glyph_row_area area;
4761 int start, end;
4762 {
4763 struct glyph *glyph, *last;
4764 int voffset, face_id;
4765
4766 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
4767
4768 glyph = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + start;
4769 last = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + end;
4770 face_id = glyph->face_id;
4771 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
4772 s->font = s->face->font;
4773 s->font_info = FONT_INFO_FROM_ID (s->f, s->face->font_info_id);
4774 s->width = glyph->pixel_width;
4775 voffset = glyph->voffset;
4776
4777 for (++glyph;
4778 (glyph < last
4779 && glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
4780 && glyph->voffset == voffset
4781 && glyph->face_id == face_id);
4782 ++glyph)
4783 s->width += glyph->pixel_width;
4784
4785 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
4786 s->ybase += voffset;
4787
4788 /* The case that face->gc == 0 is handled when drawing the glyph
4789 string by calling PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY. */
4790 xassert (s->face);
4791 return glyph - s->row->glyphs[s->area];
4792 }
4793
4794
4795 /* Initialize glyph string S. CHAR2B is a suitably allocated vector
4796 of XChar2b structures for S; it can't be allocated in
4797 x_init_glyph_string because it must be allocated via `alloca'. W
4798 is the window on which S is drawn. ROW and AREA are the glyph row
4799 and area within the row from which S is constructed. START is the
4800 index of the first glyph structure covered by S. HL is a
4801 face-override for drawing S. */
4802
4803 static void
4804 x_init_glyph_string (s, char2b, w, row, area, start, hl)
4805 struct glyph_string *s;
4806 XChar2b *char2b;
4807 struct window *w;
4808 struct glyph_row *row;
4809 enum glyph_row_area area;
4810 int start;
4811 enum draw_glyphs_face hl;
4812 {
4813 bzero (s, sizeof *s);
4814 s->w = w;
4815 s->f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4816 s->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (s->f);
4817 s->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (s->f);
4818 s->char2b = char2b;
4819 s->hl = hl;
4820 s->row = row;
4821 s->area = area;
4822 s->first_glyph = row->glyphs[area] + start;
4823 s->height = row->height;
4824 s->y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
4825
4826 /* Display the internal border below the tool-bar window. */
4827 if (s->w == XWINDOW (s->f->tool_bar_window))
4828 s->y -= s->f->output_data.x->internal_border_width;
4829
4830 s->ybase = s->y + row->ascent;
4831 }
4832
4833
4834 /* Set background width of glyph string S. START is the index of the
4835 first glyph following S. LAST_X is the right-most x-position + 1
4836 in the drawing area. */
4837
4838 static INLINE void
4839 x_set_glyph_string_background_width (s, start, last_x)
4840 struct glyph_string *s;
4841 int start;
4842 int last_x;
4843 {
4844 /* If the face of this glyph string has to be drawn to the end of
4845 the drawing area, set S->extends_to_end_of_line_p. */
4846 struct face *default_face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
4847
4848 if (start == s->row->used[s->area]
4849 && s->area == TEXT_AREA
4850 && ((s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT
4851 && (s->row->fill_line_p
4852 || s->face->background != default_face->background
4853 || s->face->stipple != default_face->stipple
4854 || s->row->mouse_face_p))
4855 || s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
4856 || ((s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
4857 && s->row->fill_line_p)))
4858 s->extends_to_end_of_line_p = 1;
4859
4860 /* If S extends its face to the end of the line, set its
4861 background_width to the distance to the right edge of the drawing
4862 area. */
4863 if (s->extends_to_end_of_line_p)
4864 s->background_width = last_x - s->x + 1;
4865 else
4866 s->background_width = s->width;
4867 }
4868
4869
4870 /* Add a glyph string for a stretch glyph to the list of strings
4871 between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the stretch glyph in
4872 row area AREA of glyph row ROW. END is the index of the last glyph
4873 in that glyph row area. X is the current output position assigned
4874 to the new glyph string constructed. HL overrides that face of the
4875 glyph; e.g. it is DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X
4876 is the right-most x-position of the drawing area. */
4877
4878 /* SunOS 4 bundled cc, barfed on continuations in the arg lists here
4879 and below -- keep them on one line. */
4880 #define BUILD_STRETCH_GLYPH_STRING(W, ROW, AREA, START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
4881 do \
4882 { \
4883 s = (struct glyph_string *) alloca (sizeof *s); \
4884 x_init_glyph_string (s, NULL, W, ROW, AREA, START, HL); \
4885 START = x_fill_stretch_glyph_string (s, ROW, AREA, START, END); \
4886 x_append_glyph_string (&HEAD, &TAIL, s); \
4887 s->x = (X); \
4888 } \
4889 while (0)
4890
4891
4892 /* Add a glyph string for an image glyph to the list of strings
4893 between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the image glyph in
4894 row area AREA of glyph row ROW. END is the index of the last glyph
4895 in that glyph row area. X is the current output position assigned
4896 to the new glyph string constructed. HL overrides that face of the
4897 glyph; e.g. it is DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X
4898 is the right-most x-position of the drawing area. */
4899
4900 #define BUILD_IMAGE_GLYPH_STRING(W, ROW, AREA, START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
4901 do \
4902 { \
4903 s = (struct glyph_string *) alloca (sizeof *s); \
4904 x_init_glyph_string (s, NULL, W, ROW, AREA, START, HL); \
4905 x_fill_image_glyph_string (s); \
4906 x_append_glyph_string (&HEAD, &TAIL, s); \
4907 ++START; \
4908 s->x = (X); \
4909 } \
4910 while (0)
4911
4912
4913 /* Add a glyph string for a sequence of character glyphs to the list
4914 of strings between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the first
4915 glyph in row area AREA of glyph row ROW that is part of the new
4916 glyph string. END is the index of the last glyph in that glyph row
4917 area. X is the current output position assigned to the new glyph
4918 string constructed. HL overrides that face of the glyph; e.g. it
4919 is DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X is the
4920 right-most x-position of the drawing area. */
4921
4922 #define BUILD_CHAR_GLYPH_STRINGS(W, ROW, AREA, START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X, OVERLAPS_P) \
4923 do \
4924 { \
4925 int c, face_id; \
4926 XChar2b *char2b; \
4927 \
4928 c = (ROW)->glyphs[AREA][START].u.ch; \
4929 face_id = (ROW)->glyphs[AREA][START].face_id; \
4930 \
4931 s = (struct glyph_string *) alloca (sizeof *s); \
4932 char2b = (XChar2b *) alloca ((END - START) * sizeof *char2b); \
4933 x_init_glyph_string (s, char2b, W, ROW, AREA, START, HL); \
4934 x_append_glyph_string (&HEAD, &TAIL, s); \
4935 s->x = (X); \
4936 START = x_fill_glyph_string (s, face_id, START, END, \
4937 OVERLAPS_P); \
4938 } \
4939 while (0)
4940
4941
4942 /* Add a glyph string for a composite sequence to the list of strings
4943 between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the first glyph in
4944 row area AREA of glyph row ROW that is part of the new glyph
4945 string. END is the index of the last glyph in that glyph row area.
4946 X is the current output position assigned to the new glyph string
4947 constructed. HL overrides that face of the glyph; e.g. it is
4948 DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X is the right-most
4949 x-position of the drawing area. */
4950
4951 #define BUILD_COMPOSITE_GLYPH_STRING(W, ROW, AREA, START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X, OVERLAPS_P) \
4952 do { \
4953 int cmp_id = (ROW)->glyphs[AREA][START].u.cmp_id; \
4954 int face_id = (ROW)->glyphs[AREA][START].face_id; \
4955 struct face *base_face = FACE_FROM_ID (XFRAME (w->frame), face_id); \
4956 struct composition *cmp = composition_table[cmp_id]; \
4957 int glyph_len = cmp->glyph_len; \
4958 XChar2b *char2b; \
4959 struct face **faces; \
4960 struct glyph_string *first_s = NULL; \
4961 int n; \
4962 \
4963 base_face = base_face->ascii_face; \
4964 char2b = (XChar2b *) alloca ((sizeof *char2b) * glyph_len); \
4965 faces = (struct face **) alloca ((sizeof *faces) * glyph_len); \
4966 /* At first, fill in `char2b' and `faces'. */ \
4967 for (n = 0; n < glyph_len; n++) \
4968 { \
4969 int c = COMPOSITION_GLYPH (cmp, n); \
4970 int this_face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (XFRAME (w->frame), base_face, c); \
4971 faces[n] = FACE_FROM_ID (XFRAME (w->frame), this_face_id); \
4972 x_get_char_face_and_encoding (XFRAME (w->frame), c, \
4973 this_face_id, char2b + n, 1, 1); \
4974 } \
4975 \
4976 /* Make glyph_strings for each glyph sequence that is drawable by \
4977 the same face, and append them to HEAD/TAIL. */ \
4978 for (n = 0; n < cmp->glyph_len;) \
4979 { \
4980 s = (struct glyph_string *) alloca (sizeof *s); \
4981 x_init_glyph_string (s, char2b + n, W, ROW, AREA, START, HL); \
4982 x_append_glyph_string (&(HEAD), &(TAIL), s); \
4983 s->cmp = cmp; \
4984 s->gidx = n; \
4985 s->x = (X); \
4986 \
4987 if (n == 0) \
4988 first_s = s; \
4989 \
4990 n = x_fill_composite_glyph_string (s, faces, OVERLAPS_P); \
4991 } \
4992 \
4993 ++START; \
4994 s = first_s; \
4995 } while (0)
4996
4997
4998 /* Build a list of glyph strings between HEAD and TAIL for the glyphs
4999 of AREA of glyph row ROW on window W between indices START and END.
5000 HL overrides the face for drawing glyph strings, e.g. it is
5001 DRAW_CURSOR to draw a cursor. X and LAST_X are start and end
5002 x-positions of the drawing area.
5003
5004 This is an ugly monster macro construct because we must use alloca
5005 to allocate glyph strings (because x_draw_glyphs can be called
5006 asynchronously). */
5007
5008 #define BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS(W, ROW, AREA, START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X, OVERLAPS_P) \
5009 do \
5010 { \
5011 HEAD = TAIL = NULL; \
5012 while (START < END) \
5013 { \
5014 struct glyph *first_glyph = (ROW)->glyphs[AREA] + START; \
5015 switch (first_glyph->type) \
5016 { \
5017 case CHAR_GLYPH: \
5018 BUILD_CHAR_GLYPH_STRINGS (W, ROW, AREA, START, END, HEAD, \
5019 TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X, \
5020 OVERLAPS_P); \
5021 break; \
5022 \
5023 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH: \
5024 BUILD_COMPOSITE_GLYPH_STRING (W, ROW, AREA, START, END, \
5025 HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X,\
5026 OVERLAPS_P); \
5027 break; \
5028 \
5029 case STRETCH_GLYPH: \
5030 BUILD_STRETCH_GLYPH_STRING (W, ROW, AREA, START, END, \
5031 HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X); \
5032 break; \
5033 \
5034 case IMAGE_GLYPH: \
5035 BUILD_IMAGE_GLYPH_STRING (W, ROW, AREA, START, END, HEAD, \
5036 TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X); \
5037 break; \
5038 \
5039 default: \
5040 abort (); \
5041 } \
5042 \
5043 x_set_glyph_string_background_width (s, START, LAST_X); \
5044 (X) += s->width; \
5045 } \
5046 } \
5047 while (0)
5048
5049
5050 /* Draw glyphs between START and END in AREA of ROW on window W,
5051 starting at x-position X. X is relative to AREA in W. HL is a
5052 face-override with the following meaning:
5053
5054 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT draw normally
5055 DRAW_CURSOR draw in cursor face
5056 DRAW_MOUSE_FACE draw in mouse face.
5057 DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO draw in mode line face
5058 DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN draw an image with a sunken relief around it
5059 DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED draw an image with a raised relief around it
5060
5061 If OVERLAPS_P is non-zero, draw only the foreground of characters
5062 and clip to the physical height of ROW.
5063
5064 Value is the x-position reached, relative to AREA of W. */
5065
5066 static int
5067 x_draw_glyphs (w, x, row, area, start, end, hl, overlaps_p)
5068 struct window *w;
5069 int x;
5070 struct glyph_row *row;
5071 enum glyph_row_area area;
5072 int start, end;
5073 enum draw_glyphs_face hl;
5074 int overlaps_p;
5075 {
5076 struct glyph_string *head, *tail;
5077 struct glyph_string *s;
5078 int last_x, area_width;
5079 int x_reached;
5080 int i, j;
5081
5082 /* Let's rather be paranoid than getting a SEGV. */
5083 end = min (end, row->used[area]);
5084 start = max (0, start);
5085 start = min (end, start);
5086
5087 /* Translate X to frame coordinates. Set last_x to the right
5088 end of the drawing area. */
5089 if (row->full_width_p)
5090 {
5091 /* X is relative to the left edge of W, without scroll bars
5092 or fringes. */
5093 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5094 int window_left_x = WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN (w) * CANON_X_UNIT (f);
5095
5096 x += window_left_x;
5097 area_width = XFASTINT (w->width) * CANON_X_UNIT (f);
5098 last_x = window_left_x + area_width;
5099
5100 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5101 {
5102 int width = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) * CANON_X_UNIT (f);
5103 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS_ON_RIGHT (f))
5104 last_x += width;
5105 else
5106 x -= width;
5107 }
5108
5109 x += FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
5110 last_x += FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
5111 }
5112 else
5113 {
5114 x = WINDOW_AREA_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, area, x);
5115 area_width = window_box_width (w, area);
5116 last_x = WINDOW_AREA_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, area, area_width);
5117 }
5118
5119 /* Build a doubly-linked list of glyph_string structures between
5120 head and tail from what we have to draw. Note that the macro
5121 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS will modify its start parameter. That's
5122 the reason we use a separate variable `i'. */
5123 i = start;
5124 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (w, row, area, i, end, head, tail, hl, x, last_x,
5125 overlaps_p);
5126 if (tail)
5127 x_reached = tail->x + tail->background_width;
5128 else
5129 x_reached = x;
5130
5131 /* If there are any glyphs with lbearing < 0 or rbearing > width in
5132 the row, redraw some glyphs in front or following the glyph
5133 strings built above. */
5134 if (head && !overlaps_p && row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p)
5135 {
5136 int dummy_x = 0;
5137 struct glyph_string *h, *t;
5138
5139 /* Compute overhangs for all glyph strings. */
5140 for (s = head; s; s = s->next)
5141 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s);
5142
5143 /* Prepend glyph strings for glyphs in front of the first glyph
5144 string that are overwritten because of the first glyph
5145 string's left overhang. The background of all strings
5146 prepended must be drawn because the first glyph string
5147 draws over it. */
5148 i = x_left_overwritten (head);
5149 if (i >= 0)
5150 {
5151 j = i;
5152 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (w, row, area, j, start, h, t,
5153 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, dummy_x, last_x,
5154 overlaps_p);
5155 start = i;
5156 x_compute_overhangs_and_x (t, head->x, 1);
5157 x_prepend_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
5158 }
5159
5160 /* Prepend glyph strings for glyphs in front of the first glyph
5161 string that overwrite that glyph string because of their
5162 right overhang. For these strings, only the foreground must
5163 be drawn, because it draws over the glyph string at `head'.
5164 The background must not be drawn because this would overwrite
5165 right overhangs of preceding glyphs for which no glyph
5166 strings exist. */
5167 i = x_left_overwriting (head);
5168 if (i >= 0)
5169 {
5170 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (w, row, area, i, start, h, t,
5171 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, dummy_x, last_x,
5172 overlaps_p);
5173 for (s = h; s; s = s->next)
5174 s->background_filled_p = 1;
5175 x_compute_overhangs_and_x (t, head->x, 1);
5176 x_prepend_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
5177 }
5178
5179 /* Append glyphs strings for glyphs following the last glyph
5180 string tail that are overwritten by tail. The background of
5181 these strings has to be drawn because tail's foreground draws
5182 over it. */
5183 i = x_right_overwritten (tail);
5184 if (i >= 0)
5185 {
5186 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (w, row, area, end, i, h, t,
5187 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, x, last_x,
5188 overlaps_p);
5189 x_compute_overhangs_and_x (h, tail->x + tail->width, 0);
5190 x_append_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
5191 }
5192
5193 /* Append glyph strings for glyphs following the last glyph
5194 string tail that overwrite tail. The foreground of such
5195 glyphs has to be drawn because it writes into the background
5196 of tail. The background must not be drawn because it could
5197 paint over the foreground of following glyphs. */
5198 i = x_right_overwriting (tail);
5199 if (i >= 0)
5200 {
5201 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (w, row, area, end, i, h, t,
5202 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, x, last_x,
5203 overlaps_p);
5204 for (s = h; s; s = s->next)
5205 s->background_filled_p = 1;
5206 x_compute_overhangs_and_x (h, tail->x + tail->width, 0);
5207 x_append_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
5208 }
5209 }
5210
5211 /* Draw all strings. */
5212 for (s = head; s; s = s->next)
5213 x_draw_glyph_string (s);
5214
5215 if (area == TEXT_AREA
5216 && !row->full_width_p
5217 /* When drawing overlapping rows, only the glyph strings'
5218 foreground is drawn, which doesn't erase a cursor
5219 completely. */
5220 && !overlaps_p)
5221 {
5222 int x0 = head ? head->x : x;
5223 int x1 = tail ? tail->x + tail->background_width : x;
5224
5225 x0 = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_X (w, x0);
5226 x1 = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_X (w, x1);
5227
5228 if (XFASTINT (w->left_margin_width) != 0)
5229 {
5230 int left_area_width = window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA);
5231 x0 -= left_area_width;
5232 x1 -= left_area_width;
5233 }
5234
5235 notice_overwritten_cursor (w, area, x0, x1,
5236 row->y, MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row));
5237 }
5238
5239 /* Value is the x-position up to which drawn, relative to AREA of W.
5240 This doesn't include parts drawn because of overhangs. */
5241 x_reached = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_X (w, x_reached);
5242 if (!row->full_width_p)
5243 {
5244 if (area > LEFT_MARGIN_AREA && XFASTINT (w->left_margin_width) != 0)
5245 x_reached -= window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA);
5246 if (area > TEXT_AREA)
5247 x_reached -= window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA);
5248 }
5249
5250 return x_reached;
5251 }
5252
5253
5254 /* Fix the display of area AREA of overlapping row ROW in window W. */
5255
5256 static void
5257 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row, area)
5258 struct window *w;
5259 struct glyph_row *row;
5260 enum glyph_row_area area;
5261 {
5262 int i, x;
5263
5264 BLOCK_INPUT;
5265
5266 if (area == LEFT_MARGIN_AREA)
5267 x = 0;
5268 else if (area == TEXT_AREA)
5269 x = row->x + window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA);
5270 else
5271 x = (window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA)
5272 + window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA));
5273
5274 for (i = 0; i < row->used[area];)
5275 {
5276 if (row->glyphs[area][i].overlaps_vertically_p)
5277 {
5278 int start = i, start_x = x;
5279
5280 do
5281 {
5282 x += row->glyphs[area][i].pixel_width;
5283 ++i;
5284 }
5285 while (i < row->used[area]
5286 && row->glyphs[area][i].overlaps_vertically_p);
5287
5288 x_draw_glyphs (w, start_x, row, area, start, i,
5289 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 1);
5290 }
5291 else
5292 {
5293 x += row->glyphs[area][i].pixel_width;
5294 ++i;
5295 }
5296 }
5297
5298 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5299 }
5300
5301
5302 /* Output LEN glyphs starting at START at the nominal cursor position.
5303 Advance the nominal cursor over the text. The global variable
5304 updated_window contains the window being updated, updated_row is
5305 the glyph row being updated, and updated_area is the area of that
5306 row being updated. */
5307
5308 static void
5309 x_write_glyphs (start, len)
5310 struct glyph *start;
5311 int len;
5312 {
5313 int x, hpos;
5314
5315 xassert (updated_window && updated_row);
5316 BLOCK_INPUT;
5317
5318 /* Write glyphs. */
5319
5320 hpos = start - updated_row->glyphs[updated_area];
5321 x = x_draw_glyphs (updated_window, output_cursor.x,
5322 updated_row, updated_area,
5323 hpos, hpos + len,
5324 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
5325
5326 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5327
5328 /* Advance the output cursor. */
5329 output_cursor.hpos += len;
5330 output_cursor.x = x;
5331 }
5332
5333
5334 /* Insert LEN glyphs from START at the nominal cursor position. */
5335
5336 static void
5337 x_insert_glyphs (start, len)
5338 struct glyph *start;
5339 register int len;
5340 {
5341 struct frame *f;
5342 struct window *w;
5343 int line_height, shift_by_width, shifted_region_width;
5344 struct glyph_row *row;
5345 struct glyph *glyph;
5346 int frame_x, frame_y, hpos;
5347
5348 xassert (updated_window && updated_row);
5349 BLOCK_INPUT;
5350 w = updated_window;
5351 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
5352
5353 /* Get the height of the line we are in. */
5354 row = updated_row;
5355 line_height = row->height;
5356
5357 /* Get the width of the glyphs to insert. */
5358 shift_by_width = 0;
5359 for (glyph = start; glyph < start + len; ++glyph)
5360 shift_by_width += glyph->pixel_width;
5361
5362 /* Get the width of the region to shift right. */
5363 shifted_region_width = (window_box_width (w, updated_area)
5364 - output_cursor.x
5365 - shift_by_width);
5366
5367 /* Shift right. */
5368 frame_x = window_box_left (w, updated_area) + output_cursor.x;
5369 frame_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, output_cursor.y);
5370 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5371 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
5372 frame_x, frame_y,
5373 shifted_region_width, line_height,
5374 frame_x + shift_by_width, frame_y);
5375
5376 /* Write the glyphs. */
5377 hpos = start - row->glyphs[updated_area];
5378 x_draw_glyphs (w, output_cursor.x, row, updated_area, hpos, hpos + len,
5379 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
5380
5381 /* Advance the output cursor. */
5382 output_cursor.hpos += len;
5383 output_cursor.x += shift_by_width;
5384 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5385 }
5386
5387
5388 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
5389 for X frames. */
5390
5391 static void
5392 x_delete_glyphs (n)
5393 register int n;
5394 {
5395 abort ();
5396 }
5397
5398
5399 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
5400 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
5401
5402 void
5403 x_clear_area (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures)
5404 Display *dpy;
5405 Window window;
5406 int x, y;
5407 int width, height;
5408 int exposures;
5409 {
5410 xassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
5411 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
5412 }
5413
5414
5415 /* Erase the current text line from the nominal cursor position
5416 (inclusive) to pixel column TO_X (exclusive). The idea is that
5417 everything from TO_X onward is already erased.
5418
5419 TO_X is a pixel position relative to updated_area of
5420 updated_window. TO_X == -1 means clear to the end of this area. */
5421
5422 static void
5423 x_clear_end_of_line (to_x)
5424 int to_x;
5425 {
5426 struct frame *f;
5427 struct window *w = updated_window;
5428 int max_x, min_y, max_y;
5429 int from_x, from_y, to_y;
5430
5431 xassert (updated_window && updated_row);
5432 f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5433
5434 if (updated_row->full_width_p)
5435 {
5436 max_x = XFASTINT (w->width) * CANON_X_UNIT (f);
5437 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
5438 && !w->pseudo_window_p)
5439 max_x += FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) * CANON_X_UNIT (f);
5440 }
5441 else
5442 max_x = window_box_width (w, updated_area);
5443 max_y = window_text_bottom_y (w);
5444
5445 /* TO_X == 0 means don't do anything. TO_X < 0 means clear to end
5446 of window. For TO_X > 0, truncate to end of drawing area. */
5447 if (to_x == 0)
5448 return;
5449 else if (to_x < 0)
5450 to_x = max_x;
5451 else
5452 to_x = min (to_x, max_x);
5453
5454 to_y = min (max_y, output_cursor.y + updated_row->height);
5455
5456 /* Notice if the cursor will be cleared by this operation. */
5457 if (!updated_row->full_width_p)
5458 notice_overwritten_cursor (w, updated_area,
5459 output_cursor.x, -1,
5460 updated_row->y,
5461 MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (updated_row));
5462
5463 from_x = output_cursor.x;
5464
5465 /* Translate to frame coordinates. */
5466 if (updated_row->full_width_p)
5467 {
5468 from_x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, from_x);
5469 to_x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, to_x);
5470 }
5471 else
5472 {
5473 from_x = WINDOW_AREA_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, updated_area, from_x);
5474 to_x = WINDOW_AREA_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, updated_area, to_x);
5475 }
5476
5477 min_y = WINDOW_DISPLAY_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
5478 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (min_y, output_cursor.y));
5479 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, to_y);
5480
5481 /* Prevent inadvertently clearing to end of the X window. */
5482 if (to_x > from_x && to_y > from_y)
5483 {
5484 BLOCK_INPUT;
5485 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5486 from_x, from_y, to_x - from_x, to_y - from_y,
5487 False);
5488 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5489 }
5490 }
5491
5492
5493 /* Clear entire frame. If updating_frame is non-null, clear that
5494 frame. Otherwise clear the selected frame. */
5495
5496 static void
5497 x_clear_frame ()
5498 {
5499 struct frame *f;
5500
5501 if (updating_frame)
5502 f = updating_frame;
5503 else
5504 f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
5505
5506 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
5507 longer visible. */
5508 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
5509 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
5510 output_cursor.x = -1;
5511
5512 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
5513 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
5514 BLOCK_INPUT;
5515 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
5516
5517 /* We have to clear the scroll bars, too. If we have changed
5518 colors or something like that, then they should be notified. */
5519 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
5520
5521 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
5522 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5523 }
5524
5525
5526 \f
5527 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
5528
5529 /* We use the select system call to do the waiting, so we have to make
5530 sure it's available. If it isn't, we just won't do visual bells. */
5531
5532 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
5533
5534
5535 /* Subtract the `struct timeval' values X and Y, storing the result in
5536 *RESULT. Return 1 if the difference is negative, otherwise 0. */
5537
5538 static int
5539 timeval_subtract (result, x, y)
5540 struct timeval *result, x, y;
5541 {
5542 /* Perform the carry for the later subtraction by updating y. This
5543 is safer because on some systems the tv_sec member is unsigned. */
5544 if (x.tv_usec < y.tv_usec)
5545 {
5546 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000 + 1;
5547 y.tv_usec -= 1000000 * nsec;
5548 y.tv_sec += nsec;
5549 }
5550
5551 if (x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec > 1000000)
5552 {
5553 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000;
5554 y.tv_usec += 1000000 * nsec;
5555 y.tv_sec -= nsec;
5556 }
5557
5558 /* Compute the time remaining to wait. tv_usec is certainly
5559 positive. */
5560 result->tv_sec = x.tv_sec - y.tv_sec;
5561 result->tv_usec = x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec;
5562
5563 /* Return indication of whether the result should be considered
5564 negative. */
5565 return x.tv_sec < y.tv_sec;
5566 }
5567
5568 void
5569 XTflash (f)
5570 struct frame *f;
5571 {
5572 BLOCK_INPUT;
5573
5574 {
5575 GC gc;
5576
5577 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
5578 pixels into background pixels. */
5579 {
5580 XGCValues values;
5581
5582 values.function = GXxor;
5583 values.foreground = (f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel
5584 ^ f->output_data.x->background_pixel);
5585
5586 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5587 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
5588 }
5589
5590 {
5591 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
5592 int height = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_HEIGHT (f));
5593 /* Height of each line to flash. */
5594 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
5595 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
5596 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
5597 int flash_right = PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
5598
5599 int width;
5600
5601 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
5602 edge it is next to. */
5603 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
5604 {
5605 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
5606 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5607 break;
5608
5609 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
5610 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5611 break;
5612
5613 default:
5614 break;
5615 }
5616
5617 width = flash_right - flash_left;
5618
5619 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
5620 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
5621 {
5622 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
5623 flash_left,
5624 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
5625 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * CANON_Y_UNIT (f)),
5626 width, flash_height);
5627 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
5628 flash_left,
5629 (height - flash_height
5630 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
5631 width, flash_height);
5632 }
5633 else
5634 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
5635 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
5636 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
5637 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
5638
5639 x_flush (f);
5640
5641 {
5642 struct timeval wakeup;
5643
5644 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup);
5645
5646 /* Compute time to wait until, propagating carry from usecs. */
5647 wakeup.tv_usec += 150000;
5648 wakeup.tv_sec += (wakeup.tv_usec / 1000000);
5649 wakeup.tv_usec %= 1000000;
5650
5651 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
5652 available. */
5653 while (! detect_input_pending ())
5654 {
5655 struct timeval current;
5656 struct timeval timeout;
5657
5658 EMACS_GET_TIME (current);
5659
5660 /* Break if result would be negative. */
5661 if (timeval_subtract (&current, wakeup, current))
5662 break;
5663
5664 /* How long `select' should wait. */
5665 timeout.tv_sec = 0;
5666 timeout.tv_usec = 10000;
5667
5668 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
5669 select (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout);
5670 }
5671 }
5672
5673 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
5674 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
5675 {
5676 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
5677 flash_left,
5678 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
5679 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * CANON_Y_UNIT (f)),
5680 width, flash_height);
5681 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
5682 flash_left,
5683 (height - flash_height
5684 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
5685 width, flash_height);
5686 }
5687 else
5688 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
5689 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
5690 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
5691 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
5692
5693 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
5694 x_flush (f);
5695 }
5696 }
5697
5698 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5699 }
5700
5701 #endif /* defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT) */
5702
5703
5704 /* Make audible bell. */
5705
5706 void
5707 XTring_bell ()
5708 {
5709 struct frame *f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
5710
5711 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
5712 {
5713 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
5714 if (visible_bell)
5715 XTflash (f);
5716 else
5717 #endif
5718 {
5719 BLOCK_INPUT;
5720 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
5721 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
5722 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5723 }
5724 }
5725 }
5726
5727 \f
5728 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
5729 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
5730 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
5731 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
5732
5733 static void
5734 XTset_terminal_window (n)
5735 register int n;
5736 {
5737 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
5738 }
5739
5740
5741 \f
5742 /***********************************************************************
5743 Line Dance
5744 ***********************************************************************/
5745
5746 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
5747 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
5748
5749 static void
5750 x_ins_del_lines (vpos, n)
5751 int vpos, n;
5752 {
5753 abort ();
5754 }
5755
5756
5757 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
5758
5759 static void
5760 x_scroll_run (w, run)
5761 struct window *w;
5762 struct run *run;
5763 {
5764 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5765 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
5766
5767 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
5768 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
5769 fringe of W. */
5770 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
5771 width += FRAME_X_FRINGE_WIDTH (f);
5772 x -= FRAME_X_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f);
5773
5774 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
5775 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
5776 bottom_y = y + height;
5777
5778 if (to_y < from_y)
5779 {
5780 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
5781 line at the bottom. */
5782 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
5783 height = bottom_y - from_y;
5784 else
5785 height = run->height;
5786 }
5787 else
5788 {
5789 /* Scolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
5790 at the bottom. */
5791 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
5792 height = bottom_y - to_y;
5793 else
5794 height = run->height;
5795 }
5796
5797 BLOCK_INPUT;
5798
5799 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
5800 updated_window = w;
5801 x_clear_cursor (w);
5802
5803 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5804 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5805 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
5806 x, from_y,
5807 width, height,
5808 x, to_y);
5809
5810 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5811 }
5812
5813
5814 \f
5815 /***********************************************************************
5816 Exposure Events
5817 ***********************************************************************/
5818
5819 /* Redisplay an exposed area of frame F. X and Y are the upper-left
5820 corner of the exposed rectangle. W and H are width and height of
5821 the exposed area. All are pixel values. W or H zero means redraw
5822 the entire frame. */
5823
5824 static void
5825 expose_frame (f, x, y, w, h)
5826 struct frame *f;
5827 int x, y, w, h;
5828 {
5829 XRectangle r;
5830 int mouse_face_overwritten_p = 0;
5831
5832 TRACE ((stderr, "expose_frame "));
5833
5834 /* No need to redraw if frame will be redrawn soon. */
5835 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
5836 {
5837 TRACE ((stderr, " garbaged\n"));
5838 return;
5839 }
5840
5841 /* If basic faces haven't been realized yet, there is no point in
5842 trying to redraw anything. This can happen when we get an expose
5843 event while Emacs is starting, e.g. by moving another window. */
5844 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f) == NULL
5845 || FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f)->used < BASIC_FACE_ID_SENTINEL)
5846 {
5847 TRACE ((stderr, " no faces\n"));
5848 return;
5849 }
5850
5851 if (w == 0 || h == 0)
5852 {
5853 r.x = r.y = 0;
5854 r.width = CANON_X_UNIT (f) * f->width;
5855 r.height = CANON_Y_UNIT (f) * f->height;
5856 }
5857 else
5858 {
5859 r.x = x;
5860 r.y = y;
5861 r.width = w;
5862 r.height = h;
5863 }
5864
5865 TRACE ((stderr, "(%d, %d, %d, %d)\n", r.x, r.y, r.width, r.height));
5866 mouse_face_overwritten_p = expose_window_tree (XWINDOW (f->root_window), &r);
5867
5868 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window))
5869 mouse_face_overwritten_p
5870 |= expose_window (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window), &r);
5871
5872 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5873 if (WINDOWP (f->menu_bar_window))
5874 mouse_face_overwritten_p
5875 |= expose_window (XWINDOW (f->menu_bar_window), &r);
5876 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5877
5878 /* Some window managers support a focus-follows-mouse style with
5879 delayed raising of frames. Imagine a partially obscured frame,
5880 and moving the mouse into partially obscured mouse-face on that
5881 frame. The visible part of the mouse-face will be highlighted,
5882 then the WM raises the obscured frame. With at least one WM, KDE
5883 2.1, Emacs is not getting any event for the raising of the frame
5884 (even tried with SubstructureRedirectMask), only Expose events.
5885 These expose events will draw text normally, i.e. not
5886 highlighted. Which means we must redo the highlight here.
5887 Subsume it under ``we love X''. --gerd 2001-08-15 */
5888 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p && !FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
5889 {
5890 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
5891 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
5892 {
5893 int x = dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x;
5894 int y = dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y;
5895 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
5896 note_mouse_highlight (f, x, y);
5897 }
5898 }
5899 }
5900
5901
5902 /* Redraw (parts) of all windows in the window tree rooted at W that
5903 intersect R. R contains frame pixel coordinates. Value is
5904 non-zero if the exposure overwrites mouse-face. */
5905
5906 static int
5907 expose_window_tree (w, r)
5908 struct window *w;
5909 XRectangle *r;
5910 {
5911 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5912 int mouse_face_overwritten_p = 0;
5913
5914 while (w && !FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
5915 {
5916 if (!NILP (w->hchild))
5917 mouse_face_overwritten_p
5918 |= expose_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->hchild), r);
5919 else if (!NILP (w->vchild))
5920 mouse_face_overwritten_p
5921 |= expose_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->vchild), r);
5922 else
5923 mouse_face_overwritten_p |= expose_window (w, r);
5924
5925 w = NILP (w->next) ? NULL : XWINDOW (w->next);
5926 }
5927
5928 return mouse_face_overwritten_p;
5929 }
5930
5931
5932 /* Redraw the part of glyph row area AREA of glyph row ROW on window W
5933 which intersects rectangle R. R is in window-relative coordinates. */
5934
5935 static void
5936 expose_area (w, row, r, area)
5937 struct window *w;
5938 struct glyph_row *row;
5939 XRectangle *r;
5940 enum glyph_row_area area;
5941 {
5942 struct glyph *first = row->glyphs[area];
5943 struct glyph *end = row->glyphs[area] + row->used[area];
5944 struct glyph *last;
5945 int first_x, start_x, x;
5946
5947 if (area == TEXT_AREA && row->fill_line_p)
5948 /* If row extends face to end of line write the whole line. */
5949 x_draw_glyphs (w, 0, row, area, 0, row->used[area],
5950 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
5951 else
5952 {
5953 /* Set START_X to the window-relative start position for drawing glyphs of
5954 AREA. The first glyph of the text area can be partially visible.
5955 The first glyphs of other areas cannot. */
5956 if (area == LEFT_MARGIN_AREA)
5957 start_x = 0;
5958 else if (area == TEXT_AREA)
5959 start_x = row->x + window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA);
5960 else
5961 start_x = (window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA)
5962 + window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA));
5963 x = start_x;
5964
5965 /* Find the first glyph that must be redrawn. */
5966 while (first < end
5967 && x + first->pixel_width < r->x)
5968 {
5969 x += first->pixel_width;
5970 ++first;
5971 }
5972
5973 /* Find the last one. */
5974 last = first;
5975 first_x = x;
5976 while (last < end
5977 && x < r->x + r->width)
5978 {
5979 x += last->pixel_width;
5980 ++last;
5981 }
5982
5983 /* Repaint. */
5984 if (last > first)
5985 x_draw_glyphs (w, first_x - start_x, row, area,
5986 first - row->glyphs[area],
5987 last - row->glyphs[area],
5988 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
5989 }
5990 }
5991
5992
5993 /* Redraw the parts of the glyph row ROW on window W intersecting
5994 rectangle R. R is in window-relative coordinates. Value is
5995 non-zero if mouse-face was overwritten. */
5996
5997 static int
5998 expose_line (w, row, r)
5999 struct window *w;
6000 struct glyph_row *row;
6001 XRectangle *r;
6002 {
6003 xassert (row->enabled_p);
6004
6005 if (row->mode_line_p || w->pseudo_window_p)
6006 x_draw_glyphs (w, 0, row, TEXT_AREA, 0, row->used[TEXT_AREA],
6007 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
6008 else
6009 {
6010 if (row->used[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA])
6011 expose_area (w, row, r, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA);
6012 if (row->used[TEXT_AREA])
6013 expose_area (w, row, r, TEXT_AREA);
6014 if (row->used[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA])
6015 expose_area (w, row, r, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA);
6016 x_draw_row_fringe_bitmaps (w, row);
6017 }
6018
6019 return row->mouse_face_p;
6020 }
6021
6022
6023 /* Return non-zero if W's cursor intersects rectangle R. */
6024
6025 static int
6026 x_phys_cursor_in_rect_p (w, r)
6027 struct window *w;
6028 XRectangle *r;
6029 {
6030 XRectangle cr, result;
6031 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
6032
6033 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
6034 if (cursor_glyph)
6035 {
6036 cr.x = w->phys_cursor.x;
6037 cr.y = w->phys_cursor.y;
6038 cr.width = cursor_glyph->pixel_width;
6039 cr.height = w->phys_cursor_height;
6040 return x_intersect_rectangles (&cr, r, &result);
6041 }
6042 else
6043 return 0;
6044 }
6045
6046
6047 /* Redraw the part of window W intersection rectangle FR. Pixel
6048 coordinates in FR are frame-relative. Call this function with
6049 input blocked. Value is non-zero if the exposure overwrites
6050 mouse-face. */
6051
6052 static int
6053 expose_window (w, fr)
6054 struct window *w;
6055 XRectangle *fr;
6056 {
6057 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
6058 XRectangle wr, r;
6059 int mouse_face_overwritten_p = 0;
6060
6061 /* If window is not yet fully initialized, do nothing. This can
6062 happen when toolkit scroll bars are used and a window is split.
6063 Reconfiguring the scroll bar will generate an expose for a newly
6064 created window. */
6065 if (w->current_matrix == NULL)
6066 return 0;
6067
6068 /* When we're currently updating the window, display and current
6069 matrix usually don't agree. Arrange for a thorough display
6070 later. */
6071 if (w == updated_window)
6072 {
6073 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6074 return 0;
6075 }
6076
6077 /* Frame-relative pixel rectangle of W. */
6078 wr.x = XFASTINT (w->left) * CANON_X_UNIT (f);
6079 wr.y = XFASTINT (w->top) * CANON_Y_UNIT (f);
6080 wr.width = XFASTINT (w->width) * CANON_X_UNIT (f);
6081 wr.height = XFASTINT (w->height) * CANON_Y_UNIT (f);
6082
6083 if (x_intersect_rectangles (fr, &wr, &r))
6084 {
6085 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
6086 struct glyph_row *row;
6087 int cursor_cleared_p;
6088
6089 TRACE ((stderr, "expose_window (%d, %d, %d, %d)\n",
6090 r.x, r.y, r.width, r.height));
6091
6092 /* Convert to window coordinates. */
6093 r.x = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_X (w, r.x);
6094 r.y = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_Y (w, r.y);
6095
6096 /* Turn off the cursor. */
6097 if (!w->pseudo_window_p
6098 && x_phys_cursor_in_rect_p (w, &r))
6099 {
6100 x_clear_cursor (w);
6101 cursor_cleared_p = 1;
6102 }
6103 else
6104 cursor_cleared_p = 0;
6105
6106 /* Find the first row intersecting the rectangle R. */
6107 for (row = w->current_matrix->rows;
6108 row->enabled_p;
6109 ++row)
6110 {
6111 int y0 = row->y;
6112 int y1 = MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row);
6113
6114 if ((y0 >= r.y && y0 < r.y + r.height)
6115 || (y1 > r.y && y1 < r.y + r.height)
6116 || (r.y >= y0 && r.y < y1)
6117 || (r.y + r.height > y0 && r.y + r.height < y1))
6118 {
6119 if (expose_line (w, row, &r))
6120 mouse_face_overwritten_p = 1;
6121 }
6122
6123 if (y1 >= yb)
6124 break;
6125 }
6126
6127 /* Display the mode line if there is one. */
6128 if (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w)
6129 && (row = MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix),
6130 row->enabled_p)
6131 && row->y < r.y + r.height)
6132 {
6133 if (expose_line (w, row, &r))
6134 mouse_face_overwritten_p = 1;
6135 }
6136
6137 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
6138 {
6139 /* Draw border between windows. */
6140 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
6141
6142 /* Turn the cursor on again. */
6143 if (cursor_cleared_p)
6144 x_update_window_cursor (w, 1);
6145 }
6146 }
6147
6148 return mouse_face_overwritten_p;
6149 }
6150
6151
6152 /* Determine the intersection of two rectangles R1 and R2. Return
6153 the intersection in *RESULT. Value is non-zero if RESULT is not
6154 empty. */
6155
6156 static int
6157 x_intersect_rectangles (r1, r2, result)
6158 XRectangle *r1, *r2, *result;
6159 {
6160 XRectangle *left, *right;
6161 XRectangle *upper, *lower;
6162 int intersection_p = 0;
6163
6164 /* Rearrange so that R1 is the left-most rectangle. */
6165 if (r1->x < r2->x)
6166 left = r1, right = r2;
6167 else
6168 left = r2, right = r1;
6169
6170 /* X0 of the intersection is right.x0, if this is inside R1,
6171 otherwise there is no intersection. */
6172 if (right->x <= left->x + left->width)
6173 {
6174 result->x = right->x;
6175
6176 /* The right end of the intersection is the minimum of the
6177 the right ends of left and right. */
6178 result->width = (min (left->x + left->width, right->x + right->width)
6179 - result->x);
6180
6181 /* Same game for Y. */
6182 if (r1->y < r2->y)
6183 upper = r1, lower = r2;
6184 else
6185 upper = r2, lower = r1;
6186
6187 /* The upper end of the intersection is lower.y0, if this is inside
6188 of upper. Otherwise, there is no intersection. */
6189 if (lower->y <= upper->y + upper->height)
6190 {
6191 result->y = lower->y;
6192
6193 /* The lower end of the intersection is the minimum of the lower
6194 ends of upper and lower. */
6195 result->height = (min (lower->y + lower->height,
6196 upper->y + upper->height)
6197 - result->y);
6198 intersection_p = 1;
6199 }
6200 }
6201
6202 return intersection_p;
6203 }
6204
6205
6206
6207
6208 \f
6209 static void
6210 frame_highlight (f)
6211 struct frame *f;
6212 {
6213 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
6214 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
6215 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
6216 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
6217 BLOCK_INPUT;
6218 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
6219 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
6220 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
6221 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
6222 }
6223
6224 static void
6225 frame_unhighlight (f)
6226 struct frame *f;
6227 {
6228 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
6229 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
6230 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
6231 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
6232 BLOCK_INPUT;
6233 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
6234 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
6235 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
6236 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
6237 }
6238
6239 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
6240 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
6241 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
6242 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
6243 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
6244
6245 static void
6246 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame)
6247 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6248 struct frame *frame;
6249 {
6250 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
6251
6252 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6253 {
6254 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
6255 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
6256 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
6257
6258 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
6259 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
6260
6261 #if 0
6262 selected_frame = frame;
6263 XSETFRAME (XWINDOW (selected_frame->selected_window)->frame,
6264 selected_frame);
6265 Fselect_window (selected_frame->selected_window);
6266 choose_minibuf_frame ();
6267 #endif /* ! 0 */
6268
6269 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
6270 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
6271 else
6272 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
6273 }
6274
6275 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
6276 }
6277
6278 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
6279
6280 void
6281 x_mouse_leave (dpyinfo)
6282 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6283 {
6284 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
6285 }
6286
6287 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
6288 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
6289 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
6290
6291 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
6292 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
6293 the appropriate X display info. */
6294
6295 static void
6296 XTframe_rehighlight (frame)
6297 struct frame *frame;
6298 {
6299 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
6300 }
6301
6302 static void
6303 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo)
6304 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6305 {
6306 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
6307
6308 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6309 {
6310 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
6311 = ((GC_FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
6312 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
6313 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
6314 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
6315 {
6316 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame) = Qnil;
6317 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
6318 }
6319 }
6320 else
6321 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
6322
6323 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
6324 {
6325 if (old_highlight)
6326 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
6327 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
6328 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
6329 }
6330 }
6331
6332
6333 \f
6334 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
6335
6336 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
6337 static void
6338 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo)
6339 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6340 {
6341 int min_code, max_code;
6342 KeySym *syms;
6343 int syms_per_code;
6344 XModifierKeymap *mods;
6345
6346 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
6347 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
6348 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
6349 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
6350 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
6351
6352 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
6353 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
6354 #else
6355 min_code = dpyinfo->display->min_keycode;
6356 max_code = dpyinfo->display->max_keycode;
6357 #endif
6358
6359 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
6360 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
6361 &syms_per_code);
6362 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
6363
6364 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
6365 Alt keysyms are on. */
6366 {
6367 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
6368
6369 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
6370 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
6371 {
6372 KeyCode code
6373 = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
6374
6375 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
6376 if (code == 0)
6377 continue;
6378
6379 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
6380 {
6381 int code_col;
6382
6383 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
6384 {
6385 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
6386
6387 switch (sym)
6388 {
6389 case XK_Meta_L:
6390 case XK_Meta_R:
6391 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
6392 break;
6393
6394 case XK_Alt_L:
6395 case XK_Alt_R:
6396 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
6397 break;
6398
6399 case XK_Hyper_L:
6400 case XK_Hyper_R:
6401 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
6402 break;
6403
6404 case XK_Super_L:
6405 case XK_Super_R:
6406 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
6407 break;
6408
6409 case XK_Shift_Lock:
6410 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
6411 if ((1 << row) == LockMask)
6412 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
6413 break;
6414 }
6415 }
6416 }
6417 }
6418 }
6419
6420 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
6421 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6422 {
6423 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
6424 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
6425 }
6426
6427 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
6428 make them just meta, not alt. */
6429 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6430 {
6431 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
6432 }
6433
6434 XFree ((char *) syms);
6435 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
6436 }
6437
6438 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
6439 Emacs uses. */
6440
6441 static unsigned int
6442 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
6443 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6444 unsigned int state;
6445 {
6446 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
6447 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
6448 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
6449 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
6450 Lisp_Object tem;
6451
6452 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
6453 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
6454 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
6455 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
6456 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
6457 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
6458 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
6459 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
6460
6461
6462 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
6463 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
6464 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
6465 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
6466 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
6467 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
6468 }
6469
6470 static unsigned int
6471 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
6472 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6473 unsigned int state;
6474 {
6475 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
6476 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
6477 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
6478 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
6479
6480 Lisp_Object tem;
6481
6482 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
6483 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
6484 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
6485 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
6486 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
6487 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
6488 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
6489 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
6490
6491
6492 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
6493 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
6494 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
6495 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
6496 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
6497 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
6498 }
6499
6500 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
6501
6502 char *
6503 x_get_keysym_name (keysym)
6504 KeySym keysym;
6505 {
6506 char *value;
6507
6508 BLOCK_INPUT;
6509 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
6510 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
6511
6512 return value;
6513 }
6514
6515
6516 \f
6517 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
6518
6519 /* Given a pixel position (PIX_X, PIX_Y) on frame F, return glyph
6520 co-ordinates in (*X, *Y). Set *BOUNDS to the rectangle that the
6521 glyph at X, Y occupies, if BOUNDS != 0. If NOCLIP is non-zero, do
6522 not force the value into range. */
6523
6524 void
6525 pixel_to_glyph_coords (f, pix_x, pix_y, x, y, bounds, noclip)
6526 FRAME_PTR f;
6527 register int pix_x, pix_y;
6528 register int *x, *y;
6529 XRectangle *bounds;
6530 int noclip;
6531 {
6532 /* Arrange for the division in PIXEL_TO_CHAR_COL etc. to round down
6533 even for negative values. */
6534 if (pix_x < 0)
6535 pix_x -= FONT_WIDTH ((f)->output_data.x->font) - 1;
6536 if (pix_y < 0)
6537 pix_y -= (f)->output_data.x->line_height - 1;
6538
6539 pix_x = PIXEL_TO_CHAR_COL (f, pix_x);
6540 pix_y = PIXEL_TO_CHAR_ROW (f, pix_y);
6541
6542 if (bounds)
6543 {
6544 bounds->width = FONT_WIDTH (f->output_data.x->font);
6545 bounds->height = f->output_data.x->line_height;
6546 bounds->x = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_COL (f, pix_x);
6547 bounds->y = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_ROW (f, pix_y);
6548 }
6549
6550 if (!noclip)
6551 {
6552 if (pix_x < 0)
6553 pix_x = 0;
6554 else if (pix_x > FRAME_WINDOW_WIDTH (f))
6555 pix_x = FRAME_WINDOW_WIDTH (f);
6556
6557 if (pix_y < 0)
6558 pix_y = 0;
6559 else if (pix_y > f->height)
6560 pix_y = f->height;
6561 }
6562
6563 *x = pix_x;
6564 *y = pix_y;
6565 }
6566
6567
6568 /* Given HPOS/VPOS in the current matrix of W, return corresponding
6569 frame-relative pixel positions in *FRAME_X and *FRAME_Y. If we
6570 can't tell the positions because W's display is not up to date,
6571 return 0. */
6572
6573 int
6574 glyph_to_pixel_coords (w, hpos, vpos, frame_x, frame_y)
6575 struct window *w;
6576 int hpos, vpos;
6577 int *frame_x, *frame_y;
6578 {
6579 int success_p;
6580
6581 xassert (hpos >= 0 && hpos < w->current_matrix->matrix_w);
6582 xassert (vpos >= 0 && vpos < w->current_matrix->matrix_h);
6583
6584 if (display_completed)
6585 {
6586 struct glyph_row *row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
6587 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
6588 struct glyph *end = glyph + min (hpos, row->used[TEXT_AREA]);
6589
6590 *frame_y = row->y;
6591 *frame_x = row->x;
6592 while (glyph < end)
6593 {
6594 *frame_x += glyph->pixel_width;
6595 ++glyph;
6596 }
6597
6598 success_p = 1;
6599 }
6600 else
6601 {
6602 *frame_y = *frame_x = 0;
6603 success_p = 0;
6604 }
6605
6606 *frame_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, *frame_y);
6607 *frame_x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, *frame_x);
6608 return success_p;
6609 }
6610
6611
6612 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
6613
6614 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
6615 the mouse. */
6616
6617 static Lisp_Object
6618 construct_mouse_click (result, event, f)
6619 struct input_event *result;
6620 XButtonEvent *event;
6621 struct frame *f;
6622 {
6623 /* Make the event type no_event; we'll change that when we decide
6624 otherwise. */
6625 result->kind = mouse_click;
6626 result->code = event->button - Button1;
6627 result->timestamp = event->time;
6628 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6629 event->state)
6630 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
6631 ? up_modifier
6632 : down_modifier));
6633
6634 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
6635 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
6636 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
6637 result->arg = Qnil;
6638 return Qnil;
6639 }
6640
6641 \f
6642 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
6643 The input handler calls this.
6644
6645 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
6646 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
6647 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
6648 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
6649
6650 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
6651 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
6652
6653 static void
6654 note_mouse_movement (frame, event)
6655 FRAME_PTR frame;
6656 XMotionEvent *event;
6657 {
6658 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
6659 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
6660 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
6661
6662 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
6663 {
6664 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
6665 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
6666 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
6667 }
6668
6669 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
6670 else if (event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
6671 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
6672 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
6673 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
6674 {
6675 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
6676 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
6677 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
6678 }
6679 }
6680
6681 \f
6682 /************************************************************************
6683 Mouse Face
6684 ************************************************************************/
6685
6686 /* Find the glyph under window-relative coordinates X/Y in window W.
6687 Consider only glyphs from buffer text, i.e. no glyphs from overlay
6688 strings. Return in *HPOS and *VPOS the row and column number of
6689 the glyph found. Return in *AREA the glyph area containing X.
6690 Value is a pointer to the glyph found or null if X/Y is not on
6691 text, or we can't tell because W's current matrix is not up to
6692 date. */
6693
6694 static struct glyph *
6695 x_y_to_hpos_vpos (w, x, y, hpos, vpos, area, buffer_only_p)
6696 struct window *w;
6697 int x, y;
6698 int *hpos, *vpos, *area;
6699 int buffer_only_p;
6700 {
6701 struct glyph *glyph, *end;
6702 struct glyph_row *row = NULL;
6703 int x0, i, left_area_width;
6704
6705 /* Find row containing Y. Give up if some row is not enabled. */
6706 for (i = 0; i < w->current_matrix->nrows; ++i)
6707 {
6708 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, i);
6709 if (!row->enabled_p)
6710 return NULL;
6711 if (y >= row->y && y < MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row))
6712 break;
6713 }
6714
6715 *vpos = i;
6716 *hpos = 0;
6717
6718 /* Give up if Y is not in the window. */
6719 if (i == w->current_matrix->nrows)
6720 return NULL;
6721
6722 /* Get the glyph area containing X. */
6723 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
6724 {
6725 *area = TEXT_AREA;
6726 x0 = 0;
6727 }
6728 else
6729 {
6730 left_area_width = window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA);
6731 if (x < left_area_width)
6732 {
6733 *area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA;
6734 x0 = 0;
6735 }
6736 else if (x < left_area_width + window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA))
6737 {
6738 *area = TEXT_AREA;
6739 x0 = row->x + left_area_width;
6740 }
6741 else
6742 {
6743 *area = RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA;
6744 x0 = left_area_width + window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA);
6745 }
6746 }
6747
6748 /* Find glyph containing X. */
6749 glyph = row->glyphs[*area];
6750 end = glyph + row->used[*area];
6751 while (glyph < end)
6752 {
6753 if (x < x0 + glyph->pixel_width)
6754 {
6755 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
6756 break;
6757 else if (!buffer_only_p || BUFFERP (glyph->object))
6758 break;
6759 }
6760
6761 x0 += glyph->pixel_width;
6762 ++glyph;
6763 }
6764
6765 if (glyph == end)
6766 return NULL;
6767
6768 *hpos = glyph - row->glyphs[*area];
6769 return glyph;
6770 }
6771
6772
6773 /* Convert frame-relative x/y to coordinates relative to window W.
6774 Takes pseudo-windows into account. */
6775
6776 static void
6777 frame_to_window_pixel_xy (w, x, y)
6778 struct window *w;
6779 int *x, *y;
6780 {
6781 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
6782 {
6783 /* A pseudo-window is always full-width, and starts at the
6784 left edge of the frame, plus a frame border. */
6785 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
6786 *x -= FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH_SAFE (f);
6787 *y = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_Y (w, *y);
6788 }
6789 else
6790 {
6791 *x = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_X (w, *x);
6792 *y = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_Y (w, *y);
6793 }
6794 }
6795
6796
6797 /* Take proper action when mouse has moved to the mode or header line
6798 or marginal area of window W, x-position X and y-position Y. Area
6799 is 1, 3, 6 or 7 for the mode line, header line, left and right
6800 marginal area respectively. X is relative to the start of the text
6801 display area of W, so the width of bitmap areas and scroll bars
6802 must be subtracted to get a position relative to the start of the
6803 mode line. */
6804
6805 static void
6806 note_mode_line_or_margin_highlight (w, x, y, portion)
6807 struct window *w;
6808 int x, y, portion;
6809 {
6810 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
6811 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
6812 Cursor cursor = dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
6813 int charpos;
6814 Lisp_Object string, help, map, pos;
6815
6816 if (portion == 1 || portion == 3)
6817 string = mode_line_string (w, x, y, portion == 1, &charpos);
6818 else
6819 string = marginal_area_string (w, x, y, portion, &charpos);
6820
6821 if (STRINGP (string))
6822 {
6823 pos = make_number (charpos);
6824
6825 /* If we're on a string with `help-echo' text property, arrange
6826 for the help to be displayed. This is done by setting the
6827 global variable help_echo to the help string. */
6828 help = Fget_text_property (pos, Qhelp_echo, string);
6829 if (!NILP (help))
6830 {
6831 help_echo = help;
6832 XSETWINDOW (help_echo_window, w);
6833 help_echo_object = string;
6834 help_echo_pos = charpos;
6835 }
6836
6837 /* Change the mouse pointer according to what is under X/Y. */
6838 map = Fget_text_property (pos, Qlocal_map, string);
6839 if (!KEYMAPP (map))
6840 map = Fget_text_property (pos, Qkeymap, string);
6841 if (KEYMAPP (map))
6842 cursor = f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor;
6843 }
6844
6845 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
6846 }
6847
6848
6849 /* Take proper action when the mouse has moved to position X, Y on
6850 frame F as regards highlighting characters that have mouse-face
6851 properties. Also de-highlighting chars where the mouse was before.
6852 X and Y can be negative or out of range. */
6853
6854 static void
6855 note_mouse_highlight (f, x, y)
6856 struct frame *f;
6857 int x, y;
6858 {
6859 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
6860 int portion;
6861 Lisp_Object window;
6862 struct window *w;
6863 Cursor cursor = None;
6864 struct buffer *b;
6865
6866 /* When a menu is active, don't highlight because this looks odd. */
6867 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6868 if (popup_activated ())
6869 return;
6870 #endif
6871
6872 if (NILP (Vmouse_highlight)
6873 || !f->glyphs_initialized_p)
6874 return;
6875
6876 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = x;
6877 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = y;
6878 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = f;
6879
6880 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_defer)
6881 return;
6882
6883 if (gc_in_progress)
6884 {
6885 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 1;
6886 return;
6887 }
6888
6889 /* Which window is that in? */
6890 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, &portion, 1);
6891
6892 /* If we were displaying active text in another window, clear that. */
6893 if (! EQ (window, dpyinfo->mouse_face_window))
6894 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6895
6896 /* Not on a window -> return. */
6897 if (!WINDOWP (window))
6898 return;
6899
6900 /* Convert to window-relative pixel coordinates. */
6901 w = XWINDOW (window);
6902 frame_to_window_pixel_xy (w, &x, &y);
6903
6904 /* Handle tool-bar window differently since it doesn't display a
6905 buffer. */
6906 if (EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window))
6907 {
6908 note_tool_bar_highlight (f, x, y);
6909 return;
6910 }
6911
6912 /* Mouse is on the mode, header line or margin? */
6913 if (portion == 1 || portion == 3 || portion == 6 || portion == 7)
6914 {
6915 note_mode_line_or_margin_highlight (w, x, y, portion);
6916 return;
6917 }
6918
6919 if (portion == 2)
6920 cursor = f->output_data.x->horizontal_drag_cursor;
6921 else
6922 cursor = f->output_data.x->text_cursor;
6923
6924 /* Are we in a window whose display is up to date?
6925 And verify the buffer's text has not changed. */
6926 b = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
6927 if (/* Within text portion of the window. */
6928 portion == 0
6929 && EQ (w->window_end_valid, w->buffer)
6930 && XFASTINT (w->last_modified) == BUF_MODIFF (b)
6931 && XFASTINT (w->last_overlay_modified) == BUF_OVERLAY_MODIFF (b))
6932 {
6933 int hpos, vpos, pos, i, area;
6934 struct glyph *glyph;
6935 Lisp_Object object;
6936 Lisp_Object mouse_face = Qnil, overlay = Qnil, position;
6937 Lisp_Object *overlay_vec = NULL;
6938 int len, noverlays;
6939 struct buffer *obuf;
6940 int obegv, ozv, same_region;
6941
6942 /* Find the glyph under X/Y. */
6943 glyph = x_y_to_hpos_vpos (w, x, y, &hpos, &vpos, &area, 0);
6944
6945 /* Clear mouse face if X/Y not over text. */
6946 if (glyph == NULL
6947 || area != TEXT_AREA
6948 || !MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos)->displays_text_p)
6949 {
6950 if (clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo))
6951 cursor = None;
6952 goto set_cursor;
6953 }
6954
6955 pos = glyph->charpos;
6956 object = glyph->object;
6957 if (!STRINGP (object) && !BUFFERP (object))
6958 goto set_cursor;
6959
6960 /* If we get an out-of-range value, return now; avoid an error. */
6961 if (BUFFERP (object) && pos > BUF_Z (b))
6962 goto set_cursor;
6963
6964 /* Make the window's buffer temporarily current for
6965 overlays_at and compute_char_face. */
6966 obuf = current_buffer;
6967 current_buffer = b;
6968 obegv = BEGV;
6969 ozv = ZV;
6970 BEGV = BEG;
6971 ZV = Z;
6972
6973 /* Is this char mouse-active or does it have help-echo? */
6974 position = make_number (pos);
6975
6976 if (BUFFERP (object))
6977 {
6978 /* Put all the overlays we want in a vector in overlay_vec.
6979 Store the length in len. If there are more than 10, make
6980 enough space for all, and try again. */
6981 len = 10;
6982 overlay_vec = (Lisp_Object *) alloca (len * sizeof (Lisp_Object));
6983 noverlays = overlays_at (pos, 0, &overlay_vec, &len, NULL, NULL, 0);
6984 if (noverlays > len)
6985 {
6986 len = noverlays;
6987 overlay_vec = (Lisp_Object *) alloca (len * sizeof (Lisp_Object));
6988 noverlays = overlays_at (pos, 0, &overlay_vec, &len, NULL, NULL,0);
6989 }
6990
6991 /* Sort overlays into increasing priority order. */
6992 noverlays = sort_overlays (overlay_vec, noverlays, w);
6993 }
6994 else
6995 noverlays = 0;
6996
6997 same_region = (EQ (window, dpyinfo->mouse_face_window)
6998 && vpos >= dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
6999 && vpos <= dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
7000 && (vpos > dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
7001 || hpos >= dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col)
7002 && (vpos < dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
7003 || hpos < dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col
7004 || dpyinfo->mouse_face_past_end));
7005
7006 if (same_region)
7007 cursor = None;
7008
7009 /* Check mouse-face highlighting. */
7010 if (! same_region
7011 /* If there exists an overlay with mouse-face overlapping
7012 the one we are currently highlighting, we have to
7013 check if we enter the overlapping overlay, and then
7014 highlight only that. */
7015 || (OVERLAYP (dpyinfo->mouse_face_overlay)
7016 && mouse_face_overlay_overlaps (dpyinfo->mouse_face_overlay)))
7017 {
7018 /* Find the highest priority overlay that has a mouse-face
7019 property. */
7020 overlay = Qnil;
7021 for (i = noverlays - 1; i >= 0 && NILP (overlay); --i)
7022 {
7023 mouse_face = Foverlay_get (overlay_vec[i], Qmouse_face);
7024 if (!NILP (mouse_face))
7025 overlay = overlay_vec[i];
7026 }
7027
7028 /* If we're actually highlighting the same overlay as
7029 before, there's no need to do that again. */
7030 if (!NILP (overlay)
7031 && EQ (overlay, dpyinfo->mouse_face_overlay))
7032 goto check_help_echo;
7033
7034 dpyinfo->mouse_face_overlay = overlay;
7035
7036 /* Clear the display of the old active region, if any. */
7037 if (clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo))
7038 cursor = None;
7039
7040 /* If no overlay applies, get a text property. */
7041 if (NILP (overlay))
7042 mouse_face = Fget_text_property (position, Qmouse_face, object);
7043
7044 /* Handle the overlay case. */
7045 if (!NILP (overlay))
7046 {
7047 /* Find the range of text around this char that
7048 should be active. */
7049 Lisp_Object before, after;
7050 int ignore;
7051
7052 before = Foverlay_start (overlay);
7053 after = Foverlay_end (overlay);
7054 /* Record this as the current active region. */
7055 fast_find_position (w, XFASTINT (before),
7056 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col,
7057 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row,
7058 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_x,
7059 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_y, Qnil);
7060
7061 dpyinfo->mouse_face_past_end
7062 = !fast_find_position (w, XFASTINT (after),
7063 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col,
7064 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row,
7065 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_x,
7066 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_y, Qnil);
7067 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
7068 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id
7069 = face_at_buffer_position (w, pos, 0, 0,
7070 &ignore, pos + 1, 1);
7071
7072 /* Display it as active. */
7073 show_mouse_face (dpyinfo, DRAW_MOUSE_FACE);
7074 cursor = None;
7075 }
7076 /* Handle the text property case. */
7077 else if (!NILP (mouse_face) && BUFFERP (object))
7078 {
7079 /* Find the range of text around this char that
7080 should be active. */
7081 Lisp_Object before, after, beginning, end;
7082 int ignore;
7083
7084 beginning = Fmarker_position (w->start);
7085 end = make_number (BUF_Z (XBUFFER (object))
7086 - XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos));
7087 before
7088 = Fprevious_single_property_change (make_number (pos + 1),
7089 Qmouse_face,
7090 object, beginning);
7091 after
7092 = Fnext_single_property_change (position, Qmouse_face,
7093 object, end);
7094
7095 /* Record this as the current active region. */
7096 fast_find_position (w, XFASTINT (before),
7097 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col,
7098 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row,
7099 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_x,
7100 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_y, Qnil);
7101 dpyinfo->mouse_face_past_end
7102 = !fast_find_position (w, XFASTINT (after),
7103 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col,
7104 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row,
7105 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_x,
7106 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_y, Qnil);
7107 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
7108
7109 if (BUFFERP (object))
7110 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id
7111 = face_at_buffer_position (w, pos, 0, 0,
7112 &ignore, pos + 1, 1);
7113
7114 /* Display it as active. */
7115 show_mouse_face (dpyinfo, DRAW_MOUSE_FACE);
7116 cursor = None;
7117 }
7118 else if (!NILP (mouse_face) && STRINGP (object))
7119 {
7120 Lisp_Object b, e;
7121 int ignore;
7122
7123 b = Fprevious_single_property_change (make_number (pos + 1),
7124 Qmouse_face,
7125 object, Qnil);
7126 e = Fnext_single_property_change (position, Qmouse_face,
7127 object, Qnil);
7128 if (NILP (b))
7129 b = make_number (0);
7130 if (NILP (e))
7131 e = make_number (XSTRING (object)->size - 1);
7132 fast_find_string_pos (w, XINT (b), object,
7133 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col,
7134 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row,
7135 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_x,
7136 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_y, 0);
7137 fast_find_string_pos (w, XINT (e), object,
7138 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col,
7139 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row,
7140 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_x,
7141 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_y, 1);
7142 dpyinfo->mouse_face_past_end = 0;
7143 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
7144 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id
7145 = face_at_string_position (w, object, pos, 0, 0, 0, &ignore,
7146 glyph->face_id, 1);
7147 show_mouse_face (dpyinfo, DRAW_MOUSE_FACE);
7148 cursor = None;
7149 }
7150 else if (STRINGP (object) && NILP (mouse_face))
7151 {
7152 /* A string which doesn't have mouse-face, but
7153 the text ``under'' it might have. */
7154 struct glyph_row *r = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
7155 int start = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (r);
7156
7157 pos = string_buffer_position (w, object, start);
7158 if (pos > 0)
7159 mouse_face = get_char_property_and_overlay (make_number (pos),
7160 Qmouse_face,
7161 w->buffer,
7162 &overlay);
7163 if (!NILP (mouse_face) && !NILP (overlay))
7164 {
7165 Lisp_Object before = Foverlay_start (overlay);
7166 Lisp_Object after = Foverlay_end (overlay);
7167 int ignore;
7168
7169 /* Note that we might not be able to find position
7170 BEFORE in the glyph matrix if the overlay is
7171 entirely covered by a `display' property. In
7172 this case, we overshoot. So let's stop in
7173 the glyph matrix before glyphs for OBJECT. */
7174 fast_find_position (w, XFASTINT (before),
7175 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col,
7176 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row,
7177 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_x,
7178 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_y,
7179 object);
7180
7181 dpyinfo->mouse_face_past_end
7182 = !fast_find_position (w, XFASTINT (after),
7183 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col,
7184 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row,
7185 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_x,
7186 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_y,
7187 Qnil);
7188 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
7189 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id
7190 = face_at_buffer_position (w, pos, 0, 0,
7191 &ignore, pos + 1, 1);
7192
7193 /* Display it as active. */
7194 show_mouse_face (dpyinfo, DRAW_MOUSE_FACE);
7195 cursor = None;
7196 }
7197 }
7198 }
7199
7200 check_help_echo:
7201
7202 /* Look for a `help-echo' property. */
7203 {
7204 Lisp_Object help, overlay;
7205
7206 /* Check overlays first. */
7207 help = overlay = Qnil;
7208 for (i = noverlays - 1; i >= 0 && NILP (help); --i)
7209 {
7210 overlay = overlay_vec[i];
7211 help = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qhelp_echo);
7212 }
7213
7214 if (!NILP (help))
7215 {
7216 help_echo = help;
7217 help_echo_window = window;
7218 help_echo_object = overlay;
7219 help_echo_pos = pos;
7220 }
7221 else
7222 {
7223 Lisp_Object object = glyph->object;
7224 int charpos = glyph->charpos;
7225
7226 /* Try text properties. */
7227 if (STRINGP (object)
7228 && charpos >= 0
7229 && charpos < XSTRING (object)->size)
7230 {
7231 help = Fget_text_property (make_number (charpos),
7232 Qhelp_echo, object);
7233 if (NILP (help))
7234 {
7235 /* If the string itself doesn't specify a help-echo,
7236 see if the buffer text ``under'' it does. */
7237 struct glyph_row *r
7238 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
7239 int start = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (r);
7240 int pos = string_buffer_position (w, object, start);
7241 if (pos > 0)
7242 {
7243 help = Fget_char_property (make_number (pos),
7244 Qhelp_echo, w->buffer);
7245 if (!NILP (help))
7246 {
7247 charpos = pos;
7248 object = w->buffer;
7249 }
7250 }
7251 }
7252 }
7253 else if (BUFFERP (object)
7254 && charpos >= BEGV
7255 && charpos < ZV)
7256 help = Fget_text_property (make_number (charpos), Qhelp_echo,
7257 object);
7258
7259 if (!NILP (help))
7260 {
7261 help_echo = help;
7262 help_echo_window = window;
7263 help_echo_object = object;
7264 help_echo_pos = charpos;
7265 }
7266 }
7267 }
7268
7269 BEGV = obegv;
7270 ZV = ozv;
7271 current_buffer = obuf;
7272 }
7273
7274 set_cursor:
7275
7276 if (cursor != None)
7277 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7278 }
7279
7280 static void
7281 redo_mouse_highlight ()
7282 {
7283 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
7284 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
7285 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
7286 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
7287 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
7288 }
7289
7290
7291 \f
7292 /***********************************************************************
7293 Tool-bars
7294 ***********************************************************************/
7295
7296 static int x_tool_bar_item P_ ((struct frame *, int, int,
7297 struct glyph **, int *, int *, int *));
7298
7299 /* Tool-bar item index of the item on which a mouse button was pressed
7300 or -1. */
7301
7302 static int last_tool_bar_item;
7303
7304
7305 /* Get information about the tool-bar item at position X/Y on frame F.
7306 Return in *GLYPH a pointer to the glyph of the tool-bar item in
7307 the current matrix of the tool-bar window of F, or NULL if not
7308 on a tool-bar item. Return in *PROP_IDX the index of the tool-bar
7309 item in F->tool_bar_items. Value is
7310
7311 -1 if X/Y is not on a tool-bar item
7312 0 if X/Y is on the same item that was highlighted before.
7313 1 otherwise. */
7314
7315 static int
7316 x_tool_bar_item (f, x, y, glyph, hpos, vpos, prop_idx)
7317 struct frame *f;
7318 int x, y;
7319 struct glyph **glyph;
7320 int *hpos, *vpos, *prop_idx;
7321 {
7322 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7323 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window);
7324 int area;
7325
7326 /* Find the glyph under X/Y. */
7327 *glyph = x_y_to_hpos_vpos (w, x, y, hpos, vpos, &area, 0);
7328 if (*glyph == NULL)
7329 return -1;
7330
7331 /* Get the start of this tool-bar item's properties in
7332 f->tool_bar_items. */
7333 if (!tool_bar_item_info (f, *glyph, prop_idx))
7334 return -1;
7335
7336 /* Is mouse on the highlighted item? */
7337 if (EQ (f->tool_bar_window, dpyinfo->mouse_face_window)
7338 && *vpos >= dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
7339 && *vpos <= dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
7340 && (*vpos > dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
7341 || *hpos >= dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col)
7342 && (*vpos < dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
7343 || *hpos < dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col
7344 || dpyinfo->mouse_face_past_end))
7345 return 0;
7346
7347 return 1;
7348 }
7349
7350
7351 /* Handle mouse button event on the tool-bar of frame F, at
7352 frame-relative coordinates X/Y. EVENT_TYPE is either ButtonPress
7353 or ButtonRelase. */
7354
7355 static void
7356 x_handle_tool_bar_click (f, button_event)
7357 struct frame *f;
7358 XButtonEvent *button_event;
7359 {
7360 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7361 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window);
7362 int hpos, vpos, prop_idx;
7363 struct glyph *glyph;
7364 Lisp_Object enabled_p;
7365 int x = button_event->x;
7366 int y = button_event->y;
7367
7368 /* If not on the highlighted tool-bar item, return. */
7369 frame_to_window_pixel_xy (w, &x, &y);
7370 if (x_tool_bar_item (f, x, y, &glyph, &hpos, &vpos, &prop_idx) != 0)
7371 return;
7372
7373 /* If item is disabled, do nothing. */
7374 enabled_p = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_ENABLED_P);
7375 if (NILP (enabled_p))
7376 return;
7377
7378 if (button_event->type == ButtonPress)
7379 {
7380 /* Show item in pressed state. */
7381 show_mouse_face (dpyinfo, DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN);
7382 dpyinfo->mouse_face_image_state = DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN;
7383 last_tool_bar_item = prop_idx;
7384 }
7385 else
7386 {
7387 Lisp_Object key, frame;
7388 struct input_event event;
7389
7390 /* Show item in released state. */
7391 show_mouse_face (dpyinfo, DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED);
7392 dpyinfo->mouse_face_image_state = DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
7393
7394 key = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_KEY);
7395
7396 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
7397 event.kind = TOOL_BAR_EVENT;
7398 event.frame_or_window = frame;
7399 event.arg = frame;
7400 kbd_buffer_store_event (&event);
7401
7402 event.kind = TOOL_BAR_EVENT;
7403 event.frame_or_window = frame;
7404 event.arg = key;
7405 event.modifiers = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
7406 button_event->state);
7407 kbd_buffer_store_event (&event);
7408 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
7409 }
7410 }
7411
7412
7413 /* Possibly highlight a tool-bar item on frame F when mouse moves to
7414 tool-bar window-relative coordinates X/Y. Called from
7415 note_mouse_highlight. */
7416
7417 static void
7418 note_tool_bar_highlight (f, x, y)
7419 struct frame *f;
7420 int x, y;
7421 {
7422 Lisp_Object window = f->tool_bar_window;
7423 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
7424 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7425 int hpos, vpos;
7426 struct glyph *glyph;
7427 struct glyph_row *row;
7428 int i;
7429 Lisp_Object enabled_p;
7430 int prop_idx;
7431 enum draw_glyphs_face draw;
7432 int mouse_down_p, rc;
7433
7434 /* Function note_mouse_highlight is called with negative x(y
7435 values when mouse moves outside of the frame. */
7436 if (x <= 0 || y <= 0)
7437 {
7438 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
7439 return;
7440 }
7441
7442 rc = x_tool_bar_item (f, x, y, &glyph, &hpos, &vpos, &prop_idx);
7443 if (rc < 0)
7444 {
7445 /* Not on tool-bar item. */
7446 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
7447 return;
7448 }
7449 else if (rc == 0)
7450 goto set_help_echo;
7451
7452 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
7453
7454 /* Mouse is down, but on different tool-bar item? */
7455 mouse_down_p = (dpyinfo->grabbed
7456 && f == last_mouse_frame
7457 && FRAME_LIVE_P (f));
7458 if (mouse_down_p
7459 && last_tool_bar_item != prop_idx)
7460 return;
7461
7462 dpyinfo->mouse_face_image_state = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
7463 draw = mouse_down_p ? DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN : DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
7464
7465 /* If tool-bar item is not enabled, don't highlight it. */
7466 enabled_p = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_ENABLED_P);
7467 if (!NILP (enabled_p))
7468 {
7469 /* Compute the x-position of the glyph. In front and past the
7470 image is a space. We include this is the highlighted area. */
7471 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
7472 for (i = x = 0; i < hpos; ++i)
7473 x += row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][i].pixel_width;
7474
7475 /* Record this as the current active region. */
7476 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = hpos;
7477 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = vpos;
7478 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = x;
7479 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_y = row->y;
7480 dpyinfo->mouse_face_past_end = 0;
7481
7482 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = hpos + 1;
7483 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = vpos;
7484 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_x = x + glyph->pixel_width;
7485 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_y = row->y;
7486 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
7487 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id = TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID;
7488
7489 /* Display it as active. */
7490 show_mouse_face (dpyinfo, draw);
7491 dpyinfo->mouse_face_image_state = draw;
7492 }
7493
7494 set_help_echo:
7495
7496 /* Set help_echo to a help string to display for this tool-bar item.
7497 XTread_socket does the rest. */
7498 help_echo_object = help_echo_window = Qnil;
7499 help_echo_pos = -1;
7500 help_echo = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_HELP);
7501 if (NILP (help_echo))
7502 help_echo = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_CAPTION);
7503 }
7504
7505
7506 \f
7507 /* Find the glyph matrix position of buffer position CHARPOS in window
7508 *W. HPOS, *VPOS, *X, and *Y are set to the positions found. W's
7509 current glyphs must be up to date. If CHARPOS is above window
7510 start return (0, 0, 0, 0). If CHARPOS is after end of W, return end
7511 of last line in W. In the row containing CHARPOS, stop before glyphs
7512 having STOP as object. */
7513
7514 #if 0 /* This is a version of fast_find_position that's more correct
7515 in the presence of hscrolling, for example. I didn't install
7516 it right away because the problem fixed is minor, it failed
7517 in 20.x as well, and I think it's too risky to install
7518 so near the release of 21.1. 2001-09-25 gerd. */
7519
7520 static int
7521 fast_find_position (w, charpos, hpos, vpos, x, y, stop)
7522 struct window *w;
7523 int charpos;
7524 int *hpos, *vpos, *x, *y;
7525 Lisp_Object stop;
7526 {
7527 struct glyph_row *row, *first;
7528 struct glyph *glyph, *end;
7529 int i, past_end = 0;
7530
7531 first = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
7532 row = row_containing_pos (w, charpos, first, NULL, 0);
7533 if (row == NULL)
7534 {
7535 if (charpos < MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (first))
7536 {
7537 *x = *y = *hpos = *vpos = 0;
7538 return 0;
7539 }
7540 else
7541 {
7542 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos));
7543 past_end = 1;
7544 }
7545 }
7546
7547 *x = row->x;
7548 *y = row->y;
7549 *vpos = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (row, w->current_matrix);
7550
7551 glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
7552 end = glyph + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
7553
7554 /* Skip over glyphs not having an object at the start of the row.
7555 These are special glyphs like truncation marks on terminal
7556 frames. */
7557 if (row->displays_text_p)
7558 while (glyph < end
7559 && INTEGERP (glyph->object)
7560 && !EQ (stop, glyph->object)
7561 && glyph->charpos < 0)
7562 {
7563 *x += glyph->pixel_width;
7564 ++glyph;
7565 }
7566
7567 while (glyph < end
7568 && !INTEGERP (glyph->object)
7569 && !EQ (stop, glyph->object)
7570 && (!BUFFERP (glyph->object)
7571 || glyph->charpos < charpos))
7572 {
7573 *x += glyph->pixel_width;
7574 ++glyph;
7575 }
7576
7577 *hpos = glyph - row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
7578 return past_end;
7579 }
7580
7581 #else /* not 0 */
7582
7583 static int
7584 fast_find_position (w, pos, hpos, vpos, x, y, stop)
7585 struct window *w;
7586 int pos;
7587 int *hpos, *vpos, *x, *y;
7588 Lisp_Object stop;
7589 {
7590 int i;
7591 int lastcol;
7592 int maybe_next_line_p = 0;
7593 int line_start_position;
7594 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
7595 struct glyph_row *row, *best_row;
7596 int row_vpos, best_row_vpos;
7597 int current_x;
7598
7599 row = best_row = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
7600 row_vpos = best_row_vpos = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (row, w->current_matrix);
7601
7602 while (row->y < yb)
7603 {
7604 if (row->used[TEXT_AREA])
7605 line_start_position = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]->charpos;
7606 else
7607 line_start_position = 0;
7608
7609 if (line_start_position > pos)
7610 break;
7611 /* If the position sought is the end of the buffer,
7612 don't include the blank lines at the bottom of the window. */
7613 else if (line_start_position == pos
7614 && pos == BUF_ZV (XBUFFER (w->buffer)))
7615 {
7616 maybe_next_line_p = 1;
7617 break;
7618 }
7619 else if (line_start_position > 0)
7620 {
7621 best_row = row;
7622 best_row_vpos = row_vpos;
7623 }
7624
7625 if (row->y + row->height >= yb)
7626 break;
7627
7628 ++row;
7629 ++row_vpos;
7630 }
7631
7632 /* Find the right column within BEST_ROW. */
7633 lastcol = 0;
7634 current_x = best_row->x;
7635 for (i = 0; i < best_row->used[TEXT_AREA]; i++)
7636 {
7637 struct glyph *glyph = best_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + i;
7638 int charpos = glyph->charpos;
7639
7640 if (BUFFERP (glyph->object))
7641 {
7642 if (charpos == pos)
7643 {
7644 *hpos = i;
7645 *vpos = best_row_vpos;
7646 *x = current_x;
7647 *y = best_row->y;
7648 return 1;
7649 }
7650 else if (charpos > pos)
7651 break;
7652 }
7653 else if (EQ (glyph->object, stop))
7654 break;
7655
7656 if (charpos > 0)
7657 lastcol = i;
7658 current_x += glyph->pixel_width;
7659 }
7660
7661 /* If we're looking for the end of the buffer,
7662 and we didn't find it in the line we scanned,
7663 use the start of the following line. */
7664 if (maybe_next_line_p)
7665 {
7666 ++best_row;
7667 ++best_row_vpos;
7668 lastcol = 0;
7669 current_x = best_row->x;
7670 }
7671
7672 *vpos = best_row_vpos;
7673 *hpos = lastcol + 1;
7674 *x = current_x;
7675 *y = best_row->y;
7676 return 0;
7677 }
7678
7679 #endif /* not 0 */
7680
7681
7682 /* Find the position of the glyph for position POS in OBJECT in
7683 window W's current matrix, and return in *X, *Y the pixel
7684 coordinates, and return in *HPOS, *VPOS the column/row of the glyph.
7685
7686 RIGHT_P non-zero means return the position of the right edge of the
7687 glyph, RIGHT_P zero means return the left edge position.
7688
7689 If no glyph for POS exists in the matrix, return the position of
7690 the glyph with the next smaller position that is in the matrix, if
7691 RIGHT_P is zero. If RIGHT_P is non-zero, and no glyph for POS
7692 exists in the matrix, return the position of the glyph with the
7693 next larger position in OBJECT.
7694
7695 Value is non-zero if a glyph was found. */
7696
7697 static int
7698 fast_find_string_pos (w, pos, object, hpos, vpos, x, y, right_p)
7699 struct window *w;
7700 int pos;
7701 Lisp_Object object;
7702 int *hpos, *vpos, *x, *y;
7703 int right_p;
7704 {
7705 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
7706 struct glyph_row *r;
7707 struct glyph *best_glyph = NULL;
7708 struct glyph_row *best_row = NULL;
7709 int best_x = 0;
7710
7711 for (r = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
7712 r->enabled_p && r->y < yb;
7713 ++r)
7714 {
7715 struct glyph *g = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
7716 struct glyph *e = g + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
7717 int gx;
7718
7719 for (gx = r->x; g < e; gx += g->pixel_width, ++g)
7720 if (EQ (g->object, object))
7721 {
7722 if (g->charpos == pos)
7723 {
7724 best_glyph = g;
7725 best_x = gx;
7726 best_row = r;
7727 goto found;
7728 }
7729 else if (best_glyph == NULL
7730 || ((abs (g->charpos - pos)
7731 < abs (best_glyph->charpos - pos))
7732 && (right_p
7733 ? g->charpos < pos
7734 : g->charpos > pos)))
7735 {
7736 best_glyph = g;
7737 best_x = gx;
7738 best_row = r;
7739 }
7740 }
7741 }
7742
7743 found:
7744
7745 if (best_glyph)
7746 {
7747 *x = best_x;
7748 *hpos = best_glyph - best_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
7749
7750 if (right_p)
7751 {
7752 *x += best_glyph->pixel_width;
7753 ++*hpos;
7754 }
7755
7756 *y = best_row->y;
7757 *vpos = best_row - w->current_matrix->rows;
7758 }
7759
7760 return best_glyph != NULL;
7761 }
7762
7763
7764 /* Display the active region described by mouse_face_*
7765 in its mouse-face if HL > 0, in its normal face if HL = 0. */
7766
7767 static void
7768 show_mouse_face (dpyinfo, draw)
7769 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7770 enum draw_glyphs_face draw;
7771 {
7772 struct window *w = XWINDOW (dpyinfo->mouse_face_window);
7773 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7774
7775 if (/* If window is in the process of being destroyed, don't bother
7776 to do anything. */
7777 w->current_matrix != NULL
7778 /* Don't update mouse highlight if hidden */
7779 && (draw != DRAW_MOUSE_FACE || !dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
7780 /* Recognize when we are called to operate on rows that don't exist
7781 anymore. This can happen when a window is split. */
7782 && dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row < w->current_matrix->nrows)
7783 {
7784 int phys_cursor_on_p = w->phys_cursor_on_p;
7785 struct glyph_row *row, *first, *last;
7786
7787 first = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row);
7788 last = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row);
7789
7790 for (row = first; row <= last && row->enabled_p; ++row)
7791 {
7792 int start_hpos, end_hpos, start_x;
7793
7794 /* For all but the first row, the highlight starts at column 0. */
7795 if (row == first)
7796 {
7797 start_hpos = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col;
7798 start_x = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_x;
7799 }
7800 else
7801 {
7802 start_hpos = 0;
7803 start_x = 0;
7804 }
7805
7806 if (row == last)
7807 end_hpos = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col;
7808 else
7809 end_hpos = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
7810
7811 if (end_hpos > start_hpos)
7812 {
7813 x_draw_glyphs (w, start_x, row, TEXT_AREA,
7814 start_hpos, end_hpos, draw, 0);
7815
7816 row->mouse_face_p
7817 = draw == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE || draw == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
7818 }
7819 }
7820
7821 /* When we've written over the cursor, arrange for it to
7822 be displayed again. */
7823 if (phys_cursor_on_p && !w->phys_cursor_on_p)
7824 x_display_cursor (w, 1,
7825 w->phys_cursor.hpos, w->phys_cursor.vpos,
7826 w->phys_cursor.x, w->phys_cursor.y);
7827 }
7828
7829 /* Change the mouse cursor. */
7830 if (draw == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
7831 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7832 f->output_data.x->text_cursor);
7833 else if (draw == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
7834 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7835 f->output_data.x->cross_cursor);
7836 else
7837 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7838 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
7839 }
7840
7841 /* Clear out the mouse-highlighted active region.
7842 Redraw it un-highlighted first. Value is non-zero if mouse
7843 face was actually drawn unhighlighted. */
7844
7845 static int
7846 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo)
7847 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7848 {
7849 int cleared = 0;
7850
7851 if (!NILP (dpyinfo->mouse_face_window))
7852 {
7853 show_mouse_face (dpyinfo, DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT);
7854 cleared = 1;
7855 }
7856
7857 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
7858 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
7859 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
7860 dpyinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
7861 return cleared;
7862 }
7863
7864
7865 /* Clear any mouse-face on window W. This function is part of the
7866 redisplay interface, and is called from try_window_id and similar
7867 functions to ensure the mouse-highlight is off. */
7868
7869 static void
7870 x_clear_mouse_face (w)
7871 struct window *w;
7872 {
7873 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
7874 Lisp_Object window;
7875
7876 BLOCK_INPUT;
7877 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
7878 if (EQ (window, dpyinfo->mouse_face_window))
7879 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
7880 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7881 }
7882
7883
7884 /* Just discard the mouse face information for frame F, if any.
7885 This is used when the size of F is changed. */
7886
7887 void
7888 cancel_mouse_face (f)
7889 FRAME_PTR f;
7890 {
7891 Lisp_Object window;
7892 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7893
7894 window = dpyinfo->mouse_face_window;
7895 if (! NILP (window) && XFRAME (XWINDOW (window)->frame) == f)
7896 {
7897 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
7898 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
7899 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
7900 }
7901 }
7902
7903 \f
7904 static int glyph_rect P_ ((struct frame *f, int, int, XRectangle *));
7905
7906
7907 /* Try to determine frame pixel position and size of the glyph under
7908 frame pixel coordinates X/Y on frame F . Return the position and
7909 size in *RECT. Value is non-zero if we could compute these
7910 values. */
7911
7912 static int
7913 glyph_rect (f, x, y, rect)
7914 struct frame *f;
7915 int x, y;
7916 XRectangle *rect;
7917 {
7918 Lisp_Object window;
7919 int part, found = 0;
7920
7921 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, &part, 0);
7922 if (!NILP (window))
7923 {
7924 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
7925 struct glyph_row *r = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
7926 struct glyph_row *end = r + w->current_matrix->nrows - 1;
7927
7928 frame_to_window_pixel_xy (w, &x, &y);
7929
7930 for (; !found && r < end && r->enabled_p; ++r)
7931 if (r->y >= y)
7932 {
7933 struct glyph *g = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
7934 struct glyph *end = g + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
7935 int gx;
7936
7937 for (gx = r->x; !found && g < end; gx += g->pixel_width, ++g)
7938 if (gx >= x)
7939 {
7940 rect->width = g->pixel_width;
7941 rect->height = r->height;
7942 rect->x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, gx);
7943 rect->y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, r->y);
7944 found = 1;
7945 }
7946 }
7947 }
7948
7949 return found;
7950 }
7951
7952
7953 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
7954 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
7955
7956 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
7957 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
7958 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
7959 position on the scroll bar.
7960
7961 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
7962 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
7963 the mouse is over.
7964
7965 Set *TIME to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
7966 was at this position.
7967
7968 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
7969
7970 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
7971 movement. */
7972
7973 static void
7974 XTmouse_position (fp, insist, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
7975 FRAME_PTR *fp;
7976 int insist;
7977 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
7978 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
7979 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
7980 unsigned long *time;
7981 {
7982 FRAME_PTR f1;
7983
7984 BLOCK_INPUT;
7985
7986 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
7987 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time);
7988 else
7989 {
7990 Window root;
7991 int root_x, root_y;
7992
7993 Window dummy_window;
7994 int dummy;
7995
7996 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7997
7998 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
7999 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8000 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
8001 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
8002
8003 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
8004
8005 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
8006 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
8007 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
8008
8009 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
8010 &root,
8011
8012 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
8013 a different screen. */
8014 &dummy_window,
8015
8016 /* The position on that root window. */
8017 &root_x, &root_y,
8018
8019 /* More trash we can't trust. */
8020 &dummy, &dummy,
8021
8022 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
8023 we don't care. */
8024 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
8025
8026 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
8027 containing the pointer. */
8028 {
8029 Window win, child;
8030 int win_x, win_y;
8031 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
8032 int count;
8033
8034 win = root;
8035
8036 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
8037 structure is changing at the same time this function
8038 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
8039
8040 count = x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
8041
8042 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
8043 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
8044 {
8045 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
8046 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
8047 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
8048
8049 /* From-window, to-window. */
8050 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
8051
8052 /* From-position, to-position. */
8053 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
8054
8055 /* Child of win. */
8056 &child);
8057 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
8058 }
8059 else
8060 {
8061 while (1)
8062 {
8063 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
8064
8065 /* From-window, to-window. */
8066 root, win,
8067
8068 /* From-position, to-position. */
8069 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
8070
8071 /* Child of win. */
8072 &child);
8073
8074 if (child == None || child == win)
8075 break;
8076
8077 win = child;
8078 parent_x = win_x;
8079 parent_y = win_y;
8080 }
8081
8082 /* Now we know that:
8083 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
8084 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
8085 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
8086 (XTC did this the last time through), and
8087 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
8088 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
8089 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
8090 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
8091 never use them in that case.) */
8092
8093 /* Is win one of our frames? */
8094 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
8095
8096 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8097 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
8098 on the frame. */
8099 if (f1 != NULL
8100 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
8101 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
8102 f1 = NULL;
8103 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8104 }
8105
8106 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
8107 f1 = 0;
8108
8109 x_uncatch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), count);
8110
8111 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
8112 if (! f1)
8113 {
8114 struct scroll_bar *bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (win);
8115
8116 if (bar)
8117 {
8118 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
8119 win_x = parent_x;
8120 win_y = parent_y;
8121 }
8122 }
8123
8124 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
8125 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
8126
8127 if (f1)
8128 {
8129 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
8130 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
8131 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
8132 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
8133 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
8134 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
8135 the frame are divided into. */
8136
8137 int width, height, gx, gy;
8138 XRectangle rect;
8139
8140 if (glyph_rect (f1, win_x, win_y, &rect))
8141 last_mouse_glyph = rect;
8142 else
8143 {
8144 width = FRAME_SMALLEST_CHAR_WIDTH (f1);
8145 height = FRAME_SMALLEST_FONT_HEIGHT (f1);
8146 gx = win_x;
8147 gy = win_y;
8148
8149 /* Arrange for the division in PIXEL_TO_CHAR_COL etc. to
8150 round down even for negative values. */
8151 if (gx < 0)
8152 gx -= width - 1;
8153 if (gy < 0)
8154 gy -= height - 1;
8155 gx = (gx + width - 1) / width * width;
8156 gy = (gy + height - 1) / height * height;
8157
8158 last_mouse_glyph.width = width;
8159 last_mouse_glyph.height = height;
8160 last_mouse_glyph.x = gx;
8161 last_mouse_glyph.y = gy;
8162 }
8163
8164 *bar_window = Qnil;
8165 *part = 0;
8166 *fp = f1;
8167 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
8168 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
8169 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
8170 }
8171 }
8172 }
8173
8174 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8175 }
8176
8177
8178 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8179
8180 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
8181 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
8182 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
8183 that slows us down. */
8184
8185 static void
8186 x_process_timeouts (timer)
8187 struct atimer *timer;
8188 {
8189 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated_flag)
8190 {
8191 BLOCK_INPUT;
8192 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
8193 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
8194 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8195 }
8196 }
8197
8198 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8199
8200 \f
8201 /* Scroll bar support. */
8202
8203 /* Given an X window ID, find the struct scroll_bar which manages it.
8204 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
8205 bits. */
8206
8207 static struct scroll_bar *
8208 x_window_to_scroll_bar (window_id)
8209 Window window_id;
8210 {
8211 Lisp_Object tail;
8212
8213 for (tail = Vframe_list;
8214 XGCTYPE (tail) == Lisp_Cons;
8215 tail = XCDR (tail))
8216 {
8217 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
8218
8219 frame = XCAR (tail);
8220 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
8221 if (! GC_FRAMEP (frame))
8222 abort ();
8223
8224 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
8225 right window ID. */
8226 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
8227 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
8228 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
8229 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
8230 ! GC_NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
8231 condemned = Qnil,
8232 ! GC_NILP (bar));
8233 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
8234 if (SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)) == window_id)
8235 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
8236 }
8237
8238 return 0;
8239 }
8240
8241
8242 #if defined USE_LUCID
8243
8244 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
8245 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
8246
8247 static Widget
8248 x_window_to_menu_bar (window)
8249 Window window;
8250 {
8251 Lisp_Object tail;
8252
8253 for (tail = Vframe_list;
8254 XGCTYPE (tail) == Lisp_Cons;
8255 tail = XCDR (tail))
8256 {
8257 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
8258 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
8259
8260 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
8261 return menu_bar;
8262 }
8263
8264 return NULL;
8265 }
8266
8267 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
8268
8269 \f
8270 /************************************************************************
8271 Toolkit scroll bars
8272 ************************************************************************/
8273
8274 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
8275
8276 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event P_ ((XEvent *, struct input_event *));
8277 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event P_ ((Lisp_Object, int, int, int));
8278 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar P_ ((struct frame *,
8279 struct scroll_bar *));
8280 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb P_ ((struct scroll_bar *,
8281 int, int, int));
8282
8283
8284 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
8285
8286 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
8287
8288 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
8289 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
8290
8291 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
8292
8293 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
8294
8295 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
8296
8297 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
8298 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
8299
8300 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
8301
8302 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
8303 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
8304 to avoid jerkyness. */
8305
8306 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
8307
8308
8309 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
8310 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
8311 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
8312 a `end-scroll' scroll_bar_click' event if so. */
8313
8314 static void
8315 xt_action_hook (widget, client_data, action_name, event, params,
8316 num_params)
8317 Widget widget;
8318 XtPointer client_data;
8319 String action_name;
8320 XEvent *event;
8321 String *params;
8322 Cardinal *num_params;
8323 {
8324 int scroll_bar_p;
8325 char *end_action;
8326
8327 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
8328 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
8329 end_action = "Release";
8330 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
8331 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
8332 end_action = "EndScroll";
8333 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
8334
8335 if (scroll_bar_p
8336 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
8337 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
8338 {
8339 struct window *w;
8340
8341 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
8342 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
8343 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
8344 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
8345 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
8346 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
8347
8348 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
8349 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
8350 }
8351 }
8352
8353 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
8354 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
8355
8356 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
8357 static int scroll_bar_windows_size;
8358
8359
8360 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
8361 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
8362 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
8363 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
8364
8365 static void
8366 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window, part, portion, whole)
8367 Lisp_Object window;
8368 int part, portion, whole;
8369 {
8370 XEvent event;
8371 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
8372 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
8373 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
8374 int i;
8375
8376 BLOCK_INPUT;
8377
8378 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
8379 ev->type = ClientMessage;
8380 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
8381 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8382 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
8383 ev->format = 32;
8384
8385 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
8386 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
8387 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
8388 into that array in the event. */
8389 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
8390 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
8391 break;
8392
8393 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
8394 {
8395 int new_size = max (10, 2 * scroll_bar_windows_size);
8396 size_t nbytes = new_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
8397 size_t old_nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
8398
8399 scroll_bar_windows = (struct window **) xrealloc (scroll_bar_windows,
8400 nbytes);
8401 bzero (&scroll_bar_windows[i], nbytes - old_nbytes);
8402 scroll_bar_windows_size = new_size;
8403 }
8404
8405 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
8406 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
8407 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
8408 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
8409 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
8410 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
8411
8412 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
8413 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
8414
8415 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
8416 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
8417 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
8418 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
8419 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8420 }
8421
8422
8423 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
8424 in *IEVENT. */
8425
8426 static void
8427 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (event, ievent)
8428 XEvent *event;
8429 struct input_event *ievent;
8430 {
8431 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
8432 Lisp_Object window;
8433 struct frame *f;
8434 struct window *w;
8435
8436 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
8437 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
8438
8439 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
8440 f = XFRAME (w->frame);
8441
8442 ievent->kind = scroll_bar_click;
8443 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
8444 ievent->arg = Qnil;
8445 ievent->timestamp = XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8446 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
8447 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
8448 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
8449 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
8450 ievent->modifiers = 0;
8451 }
8452
8453
8454 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
8455
8456 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
8457
8458 #define XM_SB_MIN 1
8459 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
8460 #define XM_SB_RANGE (XM_SB_MAX - XM_SB_MIN)
8461
8462
8463 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
8464 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
8465 CALL_DATA is a pointer a a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
8466
8467 static void
8468 xm_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
8469 Widget widget;
8470 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
8471 {
8472 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
8473 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
8474 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
8475
8476 switch (cs->reason)
8477 {
8478 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
8479 bar->dragging = Qnil;
8480 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
8481 break;
8482
8483 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
8484 bar->dragging = Qnil;
8485 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
8486 break;
8487
8488 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
8489 bar->dragging = Qnil;
8490 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
8491 break;
8492
8493 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
8494 bar->dragging = Qnil;
8495 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
8496 break;
8497
8498 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
8499 bar->dragging = Qnil;
8500 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
8501 break;
8502
8503 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
8504 bar->dragging = Qnil;
8505 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
8506 break;
8507
8508 case XmCR_DRAG:
8509 {
8510 int slider_size;
8511 int dragging_down_p = (INTEGERP (bar->dragging)
8512 && XINT (bar->dragging) <= cs->value);
8513
8514 /* Get the slider size. */
8515 BLOCK_INPUT;
8516 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
8517 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8518
8519 whole = XM_SB_RANGE - slider_size;
8520 portion = min (cs->value - XM_SB_MIN, whole);
8521 part = scroll_bar_handle;
8522 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
8523 }
8524 break;
8525
8526 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
8527 break;
8528 };
8529
8530 if (part >= 0)
8531 {
8532 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
8533 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
8534 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
8535 }
8536 }
8537
8538
8539 #else /* !USE_MOTIF, i.e. Xaw. */
8540
8541
8542 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
8543 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
8544 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
8545 the thumb is. */
8546
8547 static void
8548 xaw_jump_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
8549 Widget widget;
8550 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
8551 {
8552 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
8553 float top = *(float *) call_data;
8554 float shown;
8555 int whole, portion, height;
8556 int part;
8557
8558 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
8559 BLOCK_INPUT;
8560 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8561 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8562
8563 whole = 10000000;
8564 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
8565
8566 if (shown < 1 && (abs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0/height))
8567 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
8568 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
8569 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
8570 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
8571 bottom). */
8572 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
8573 else
8574 part = scroll_bar_handle;
8575
8576 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
8577 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
8578 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
8579 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
8580 }
8581
8582
8583 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
8584 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
8585 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
8586 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
8587 has taken place. It's magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
8588 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
8589 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
8590
8591 static void
8592 xaw_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
8593 Widget widget;
8594 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
8595 {
8596 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
8597 int position = (int) call_data;
8598 Dimension height;
8599 int part;
8600
8601 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
8602 BLOCK_INPUT;
8603 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8604 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8605
8606 if (abs (position) >= height)
8607 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
8608
8609 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
8610 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
8611 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && abs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
8612 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
8613 else
8614 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
8615
8616 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
8617 bar->dragging = Qnil;
8618 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
8619 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
8620 }
8621
8622
8623 #endif /* not USE_MOTIF */
8624
8625
8626 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
8627 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
8628
8629 static void
8630 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
8631 struct frame *f;
8632 struct scroll_bar *bar;
8633 {
8634 Window xwindow;
8635 Widget widget;
8636 Arg av[20];
8637 int ac = 0;
8638 char *scroll_bar_name = "verticalScrollBar";
8639 unsigned long pixel;
8640
8641 BLOCK_INPUT;
8642
8643 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
8644 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
8645 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
8646 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, XM_SB_MIN); ++ac;
8647 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
8648 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
8649 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
8650 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
8651 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
8652
8653 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
8654 if (pixel != -1)
8655 {
8656 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
8657 ++ac;
8658 }
8659
8660 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
8661 if (pixel != -1)
8662 {
8663 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
8664 ++ac;
8665 }
8666
8667 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
8668 scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
8669
8670 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
8671 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
8672 (XtPointer) bar);
8673 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
8674 (XtPointer) bar);
8675 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
8676 (XtPointer) bar);
8677 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
8678 (XtPointer) bar);
8679 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
8680 (XtPointer) bar);
8681 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
8682 (XtPointer) bar);
8683 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
8684 (XtPointer) bar);
8685
8686 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
8687 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
8688
8689 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
8690 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
8691 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
8692 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
8693
8694 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
8695
8696 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
8697 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
8698 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
8699 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
8700 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
8701 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
8702 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
8703 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
8704
8705 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
8706 if (pixel != -1)
8707 {
8708 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
8709 ++ac;
8710 }
8711
8712 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
8713 if (pixel != -1)
8714 {
8715 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
8716 ++ac;
8717 }
8718
8719 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
8720
8721 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
8722 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
8723 {
8724 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
8725 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
8726 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
8727 pixel = -1;
8728 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
8729 }
8730 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
8731 {
8732 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
8733 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
8734 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
8735 pixel = -1;
8736 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
8737 }
8738
8739 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
8740 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
8741 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
8742 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
8743 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
8744 {
8745 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, True);
8746 ++ac;
8747 }
8748 else
8749 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
8750 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
8751 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
8752 {
8753 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
8754 the shadows. */
8755 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
8756 ++ac;
8757
8758 /* Specify the colors. */
8759 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
8760 if (pixel != -1)
8761 {
8762 XtSetArg (av[ac], "topShadowPixel", pixel);
8763 ++ac;
8764 }
8765 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
8766 if (pixel != -1)
8767 {
8768 XtSetArg (av[ac], "bottomShadowPixel", pixel);
8769 ++ac;
8770 }
8771 }
8772
8773 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
8774 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
8775
8776 {
8777 char *initial = "";
8778 char *val = initial;
8779 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
8780 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
8781 if (val == initial)
8782 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
8783 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
8784 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? -sm */
8785 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
8786 }
8787 }
8788
8789 /* Define callbacks. */
8790 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
8791 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
8792 (XtPointer) bar);
8793
8794 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
8795 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
8796
8797 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
8798
8799 /* Install an action hook that let's us detect when the user
8800 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
8801 if (action_hook_id == 0)
8802 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
8803
8804 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
8805 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
8806 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
8807 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar, xwindow);
8808
8809 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8810 }
8811
8812
8813 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
8814 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
8815
8816 static void
8817 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
8818 struct scroll_bar *bar;
8819 int portion, position, whole;
8820 {
8821 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
8822 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
8823 float top, shown;
8824
8825 BLOCK_INPUT;
8826
8827 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
8828
8829 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
8830 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
8831 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
8832 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
8833 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
8834 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
8835 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
8836 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
8837 its size, the update will often happen too late.
8838 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
8839 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
8840 portion = XFASTINT (XWINDOW (bar->window)->height) * 30;
8841 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
8842 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
8843 whole += portion;
8844
8845 if (whole <= 0)
8846 top = 0, shown = 1;
8847 else
8848 {
8849 top = (float) position / whole;
8850 shown = (float) portion / whole;
8851 }
8852
8853 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
8854 {
8855 int size, value;
8856
8857 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
8858 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
8859 value. */
8860 size = shown * XM_SB_RANGE;
8861 size = min (size, XM_SB_RANGE);
8862 size = max (size, 1);
8863
8864 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
8865 value = top * XM_SB_RANGE;
8866 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
8867 value = max (value, XM_SB_MIN);
8868
8869 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
8870 }
8871 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
8872
8873 if (whole == 0)
8874 top = 0, shown = 1;
8875 else
8876 {
8877 top = (float) position / whole;
8878 shown = (float) portion / whole;
8879 }
8880
8881 {
8882 float old_top, old_shown;
8883 Dimension height;
8884 XtVaGetValues (widget,
8885 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
8886 XtNshown, &old_shown,
8887 XtNheight, &height,
8888 NULL);
8889
8890 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
8891 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
8892 top = max (0, min (1, top));
8893 else
8894 top = old_top;
8895 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
8896 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0 / height), shown));
8897
8898 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
8899 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
8900 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
8901 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
8902 {
8903 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
8904 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
8905 else
8906 {
8907 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
8908 ScrollbarWidget sb = (ScrollbarWidget) widget;
8909 int scroll_mode = 0;
8910
8911 /* `scroll_mode' only exists with Xaw3d + ARROW_SCROLLBAR. */
8912 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll)
8913 {
8914 /* Xaw3d stupidly ignores resize requests while dragging
8915 so we have to make it believe it's not in dragging mode. */
8916 scroll_mode = sb->scrollbar.scroll_mode;
8917 if (scroll_mode == 2)
8918 sb->scrollbar.scroll_mode = 0;
8919 }
8920 #endif
8921 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
8922 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
8923 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
8924
8925 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
8926
8927 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
8928 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && scroll_mode == 2)
8929 sb->scrollbar.scroll_mode = scroll_mode;
8930 #endif
8931 }
8932 }
8933 }
8934 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
8935
8936 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8937 }
8938
8939 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
8940
8941
8942 \f
8943 /************************************************************************
8944 Scroll bars, general
8945 ************************************************************************/
8946
8947 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
8948 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
8949 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
8950 scroll bar. */
8951
8952 static struct scroll_bar *
8953 x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, left, width, height)
8954 struct window *w;
8955 int top, left, width, height;
8956 {
8957 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
8958 struct scroll_bar *bar
8959 = XSCROLL_BAR (Fmake_vector (make_number (SCROLL_BAR_VEC_SIZE), Qnil));
8960
8961 BLOCK_INPUT;
8962
8963 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
8964 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
8965 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
8966 {
8967 XSetWindowAttributes a;
8968 unsigned long mask;
8969 Window window;
8970
8971 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
8972 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
8973 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->background_pixel;
8974
8975 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
8976 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
8977 | ExposureMask);
8978 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
8979
8980 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
8981
8982 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
8983 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
8984 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
8985 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
8986 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8987 left, top, width,
8988 window_box_height (w), False);
8989
8990 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8991 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
8992 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
8993 top,
8994 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
8995 height,
8996 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
8997 0,
8998 CopyFromParent,
8999 CopyFromParent,
9000 CopyFromParent,
9001 /* Attributes. */
9002 mask, &a);
9003 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar, window);
9004 }
9005 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9006
9007 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
9008 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
9009 XSETINT (bar->left, left);
9010 XSETINT (bar->width, width);
9011 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
9012 XSETINT (bar->start, 0);
9013 XSETINT (bar->end, 0);
9014 bar->dragging = Qnil;
9015
9016 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
9017 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
9018 bar->prev = Qnil;
9019 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
9020 if (!NILP (bar->next))
9021 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
9022
9023 /* Map the window/widget. */
9024 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9025 {
9026 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
9027 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
9028 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
9029 top,
9030 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
9031 max (height, 1), 0);
9032 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
9033 }
9034 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9035 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
9036 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9037
9038 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9039 return bar;
9040 }
9041
9042
9043 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
9044
9045 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
9046 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
9047 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
9048 events.)
9049
9050 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
9051 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
9052 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
9053 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
9054 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
9055
9056 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9057
9058 static void
9059 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, rebuild)
9060 struct scroll_bar *bar;
9061 int start, end;
9062 int rebuild;
9063 {
9064 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
9065 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
9066 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
9067 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
9068
9069 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
9070 if (! rebuild
9071 && start == XINT (bar->start)
9072 && end == XINT (bar->end))
9073 return;
9074
9075 BLOCK_INPUT;
9076
9077 {
9078 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, XINT (bar->width));
9079 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
9080 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
9081
9082 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
9083 the distance between start and end. */
9084 {
9085 int length = end - start;
9086
9087 if (start < 0)
9088 start = 0;
9089 else if (start > top_range)
9090 start = top_range;
9091 end = start + length;
9092
9093 if (end < start)
9094 end = start;
9095 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
9096 end = top_range;
9097 }
9098
9099 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
9100 XSETINT (bar->start, start);
9101 XSETINT (bar->end, end);
9102
9103 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
9104 if (end > top_range)
9105 end = top_range;
9106
9107 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
9108 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
9109 that many pixels tall. */
9110 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
9111
9112 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
9113 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
9114 if (0 < start)
9115 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
9116 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
9117 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
9118 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
9119 inside_width, start,
9120 False);
9121
9122 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
9123 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9124 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
9125 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
9126
9127 /* Draw the handle itself. */
9128 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
9129 /* x, y, width, height */
9130 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
9131 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
9132 inside_width, end - start);
9133
9134 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
9135 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9136 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
9137 f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
9138
9139 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
9140 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
9141 if (end < inside_height)
9142 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
9143 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
9144 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
9145 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
9146 inside_width, inside_height - end,
9147 False);
9148
9149 }
9150
9151 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9152 }
9153
9154 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9155
9156 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
9157 nil. */
9158
9159 static void
9160 x_scroll_bar_remove (bar)
9161 struct scroll_bar *bar;
9162 {
9163 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
9164 BLOCK_INPUT;
9165
9166 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9167 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
9168 #else
9169 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
9170 #endif
9171
9172 /* Disassociate this scroll bar from its window. */
9173 XWINDOW (bar->window)->vertical_scroll_bar = Qnil;
9174
9175 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9176 }
9177
9178
9179 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
9180 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
9181 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
9182 create one. */
9183
9184 static void
9185 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (w, portion, whole, position)
9186 struct window *w;
9187 int portion, whole, position;
9188 {
9189 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
9190 struct scroll_bar *bar;
9191 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
9192 int window_x, window_y, window_width, window_height;
9193
9194 /* Get window dimensions. */
9195 window_box (w, -1, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, &window_height);
9196 top = window_y;
9197 width = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * CANON_X_UNIT (f);
9198 height = window_height;
9199
9200 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
9201 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS_ON_RIGHT (f))
9202 left = XINT (w->left) + XINT (w->width) - FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f);
9203 else
9204 left = XFASTINT (w->left);
9205 left *= CANON_X_UNIT (f);
9206 left += FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
9207
9208 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
9209 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
9210 if (FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) > 0)
9211 sb_width = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9212 else
9213 sb_width = width;
9214
9215 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
9216 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9217 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS_ON_RIGHT (f))
9218 sb_left = left + width - sb_width - (width - sb_width) / 2;
9219 else
9220 sb_left = left + (width - sb_width) / 2;
9221 #else
9222 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS_ON_RIGHT (f))
9223 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
9224 else
9225 sb_left = left;
9226 #endif
9227
9228 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
9229 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
9230 {
9231 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
9232 {
9233 BLOCK_INPUT;
9234 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
9235 left, top, width, height, False);
9236 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9237 }
9238
9239 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
9240 }
9241 else
9242 {
9243 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
9244 unsigned int mask = 0;
9245
9246 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
9247
9248 BLOCK_INPUT;
9249
9250 if (sb_left != XINT (bar->left))
9251 mask |= CWX;
9252 if (top != XINT (bar->top))
9253 mask |= CWY;
9254 if (sb_width != XINT (bar->width))
9255 mask |= CWWidth;
9256 if (height != XINT (bar->height))
9257 mask |= CWHeight;
9258
9259 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9260
9261 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
9262 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
9263 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
9264 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
9265 left, top, width, height, False);
9266
9267 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
9268 if (mask)
9269 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
9270 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
9271 top,
9272 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
9273 max (height, 1), 0);
9274
9275 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9276
9277 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
9278 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
9279 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
9280 {
9281 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
9282 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
9283 height, False);
9284 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
9285 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
9286 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
9287 height, False);
9288 }
9289
9290 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
9291 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
9292 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
9293 example. */
9294 {
9295 int area_width = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * CANON_X_UNIT (f);
9296 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
9297 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
9298 {
9299 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS_ON_LEFT (f))
9300 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
9301 left + area_width - rest, top,
9302 rest, height, False);
9303 else
9304 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
9305 left, top, rest, height, False);
9306 }
9307 }
9308
9309 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
9310 if (mask)
9311 {
9312 XWindowChanges wc;
9313
9314 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
9315 wc.y = top;
9316 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
9317 wc.height = height;
9318 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
9319 mask, &wc);
9320 }
9321
9322 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9323
9324 /* Remember new settings. */
9325 XSETINT (bar->left, sb_left);
9326 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
9327 XSETINT (bar->width, sb_width);
9328 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
9329
9330 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9331 }
9332
9333 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9334 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
9335 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9336 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
9337 dragged. */
9338 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
9339 {
9340 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
9341
9342 if (whole == 0)
9343 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
9344 else
9345 {
9346 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
9347 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
9348 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
9349 }
9350 }
9351 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9352
9353 XSETVECTOR (w->vertical_scroll_bar, bar);
9354 }
9355
9356
9357 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
9358 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
9359 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
9360 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
9361 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
9362 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
9363 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
9364
9365 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
9366 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
9367 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
9368
9369 static void
9370 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (frame)
9371 FRAME_PTR frame;
9372 {
9373 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
9374 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
9375 {
9376 Lisp_Object bar;
9377 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
9378 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
9379 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
9380 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
9381 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
9382 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
9383 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = bar;
9384 }
9385 }
9386
9387
9388 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
9389 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
9390
9391 static void
9392 XTredeem_scroll_bar (window)
9393 struct window *window;
9394 {
9395 struct scroll_bar *bar;
9396 struct frame *f;
9397
9398 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
9399 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
9400 abort ();
9401
9402 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
9403
9404 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
9405 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
9406 if (NILP (bar->prev))
9407 {
9408 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
9409 the lists. */
9410 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
9411 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
9412 return;
9413 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
9414 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
9415 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = bar->next;
9416 else
9417 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
9418 one or the other! */
9419 abort ();
9420 }
9421 else
9422 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
9423
9424 if (! NILP (bar->next))
9425 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
9426
9427 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
9428 bar->prev = Qnil;
9429 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
9430 if (! NILP (bar->next))
9431 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
9432 }
9433
9434 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
9435 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
9436
9437 static void
9438 XTjudge_scroll_bars (f)
9439 FRAME_PTR f;
9440 {
9441 Lisp_Object bar, next;
9442
9443 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
9444
9445 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
9446 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
9447 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = Qnil;
9448
9449 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
9450 {
9451 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
9452
9453 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
9454
9455 next = b->next;
9456 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
9457 }
9458
9459 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
9460 and they should get garbage-collected. */
9461 }
9462
9463
9464 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
9465 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
9466
9467 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
9468 mark bits. */
9469
9470 static void
9471 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, event)
9472 struct scroll_bar *bar;
9473 XEvent *event;
9474 {
9475 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9476
9477 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
9478 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
9479 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
9480 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
9481
9482 BLOCK_INPUT;
9483
9484 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, XINT (bar->start), XINT (bar->end), 1);
9485
9486 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
9487 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
9488
9489 /* x, y, width, height */
9490 0, 0,
9491 XINT (bar->width) - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
9492 XINT (bar->height) - 1);
9493
9494 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9495
9496 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9497 }
9498
9499 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
9500 is set to something other than no_event, it is enqueued.
9501
9502 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
9503 mark bits. */
9504
9505 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9506
9507 static void
9508 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, event, emacs_event)
9509 struct scroll_bar *bar;
9510 XEvent *event;
9511 struct input_event *emacs_event;
9512 {
9513 if (! GC_WINDOWP (bar->window))
9514 abort ();
9515
9516 emacs_event->kind = scroll_bar_click;
9517 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
9518 emacs_event->modifiers
9519 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
9520 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
9521 event->xbutton.state)
9522 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
9523 ? up_modifier
9524 : down_modifier));
9525 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
9526 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
9527 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
9528 {
9529 #if 0
9530 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
9531 int internal_height
9532 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
9533 #endif
9534 int top_range
9535 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
9536 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
9537
9538 if (y < 0) y = 0;
9539 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
9540
9541 if (y < XINT (bar->start))
9542 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
9543 else if (y < XINT (bar->end) + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
9544 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
9545 else
9546 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
9547
9548 /* Just because the user has clicked on the handle doesn't mean
9549 they want to drag it. Lisp code needs to be able to decide
9550 whether or not we're dragging. */
9551 #if 0
9552 /* If the user has just clicked on the handle, record where they're
9553 holding it. */
9554 if (event->type == ButtonPress
9555 && emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
9556 XSETINT (bar->dragging, y - XINT (bar->start));
9557 #endif
9558
9559 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
9560 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
9561 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
9562 {
9563 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
9564 int new_end = new_start + (XINT (bar->end) - XINT (bar->start));
9565
9566 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
9567 bar->dragging = Qnil;
9568 }
9569
9570 /* Same deal here as the other #if 0. */
9571 #if 0
9572 /* Clicks on the handle are always reported as occurring at the top of
9573 the handle. */
9574 if (emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
9575 emacs_event->x = bar->start;
9576 else
9577 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
9578 #else
9579 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
9580 #endif
9581
9582 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
9583 }
9584 }
9585
9586 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
9587
9588 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
9589 mark bits. */
9590
9591 static void
9592 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, event)
9593 struct scroll_bar *bar;
9594 XEvent *event;
9595 {
9596 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
9597
9598 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
9599
9600 f->mouse_moved = 1;
9601 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
9602
9603 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
9604 if (! GC_NILP (bar->dragging))
9605 {
9606 /* Where should the handle be now? */
9607 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
9608
9609 if (new_start != XINT (bar->start))
9610 {
9611 int new_end = new_start + (XINT (bar->end) - XINT (bar->start));
9612
9613 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
9614 }
9615 }
9616 }
9617
9618 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9619
9620 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
9621 on the scroll bar. */
9622
9623 static void
9624 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
9625 FRAME_PTR *fp;
9626 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
9627 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
9628 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
9629 unsigned long *time;
9630 {
9631 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
9632 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
9633 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
9634 int win_x, win_y;
9635 Window dummy_window;
9636 int dummy_coord;
9637 unsigned int dummy_mask;
9638
9639 BLOCK_INPUT;
9640
9641 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
9642 report that. */
9643 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
9644
9645 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
9646 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
9647 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
9648
9649 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
9650 &win_x, &win_y,
9651
9652 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
9653 &dummy_mask))
9654 ;
9655 else
9656 {
9657 #if 0
9658 int inside_height
9659 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
9660 #endif
9661 int top_range
9662 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
9663
9664 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
9665
9666 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
9667 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
9668
9669 if (win_y < 0)
9670 win_y = 0;
9671 if (win_y > top_range)
9672 win_y = top_range;
9673
9674 *fp = f;
9675 *bar_window = bar->window;
9676
9677 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
9678 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
9679 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->start))
9680 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
9681 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->end) + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
9682 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
9683 else
9684 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
9685
9686 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
9687 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
9688
9689 f->mouse_moved = 0;
9690 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
9691 }
9692
9693 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
9694
9695 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9696 }
9697
9698
9699 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
9700 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
9701 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
9702 redraw them. */
9703
9704 void
9705 x_scroll_bar_clear (f)
9706 FRAME_PTR f;
9707 {
9708 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9709 Lisp_Object bar;
9710
9711 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
9712 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
9713 But in that case we should not clear them. */
9714 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
9715 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
9716 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
9717 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9718 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)),
9719 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
9720 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9721 }
9722
9723 /* This processes Expose events from the menu-bar specific X event
9724 loop in xmenu.c. This allows to redisplay the frame if necessary
9725 when handling menu-bar or pop-up items. */
9726
9727 int
9728 process_expose_from_menu (event)
9729 XEvent event;
9730 {
9731 FRAME_PTR f;
9732 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
9733 int frame_exposed_p = 0;
9734
9735 BLOCK_INPUT;
9736
9737 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (event.xexpose.display);
9738 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
9739 if (f)
9740 {
9741 if (f->async_visible == 0)
9742 {
9743 f->async_visible = 1;
9744 f->async_iconified = 0;
9745 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
9746 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
9747 }
9748 else
9749 {
9750 expose_frame (x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window),
9751 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
9752 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
9753 frame_exposed_p = 1;
9754 }
9755 }
9756 else
9757 {
9758 struct scroll_bar *bar
9759 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.window);
9760
9761 if (bar)
9762 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
9763 }
9764
9765 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9766 return frame_exposed_p;
9767 }
9768 \f
9769 /* Define a queue to save up SelectionRequest events for later handling. */
9770
9771 struct selection_event_queue
9772 {
9773 XEvent event;
9774 struct selection_event_queue *next;
9775 };
9776
9777 static struct selection_event_queue *queue;
9778
9779 /* Nonzero means queue up certain events--don't process them yet. */
9780
9781 static int x_queue_selection_requests;
9782
9783 /* Queue up an X event *EVENT, to be processed later. */
9784
9785 static void
9786 x_queue_event (f, event)
9787 FRAME_PTR f;
9788 XEvent *event;
9789 {
9790 struct selection_event_queue *queue_tmp
9791 = (struct selection_event_queue *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct selection_event_queue));
9792
9793 if (queue_tmp != NULL)
9794 {
9795 queue_tmp->event = *event;
9796 queue_tmp->next = queue;
9797 queue = queue_tmp;
9798 }
9799 }
9800
9801 /* Take all the queued events and put them back
9802 so that they get processed afresh. */
9803
9804 static void
9805 x_unqueue_events (display)
9806 Display *display;
9807 {
9808 while (queue != NULL)
9809 {
9810 struct selection_event_queue *queue_tmp = queue;
9811 XPutBackEvent (display, &queue_tmp->event);
9812 queue = queue_tmp->next;
9813 xfree ((char *)queue_tmp);
9814 }
9815 }
9816
9817 /* Start queuing SelectionRequest events. */
9818
9819 void
9820 x_start_queuing_selection_requests (display)
9821 Display *display;
9822 {
9823 x_queue_selection_requests++;
9824 }
9825
9826 /* Stop queuing SelectionRequest events. */
9827
9828 void
9829 x_stop_queuing_selection_requests (display)
9830 Display *display;
9831 {
9832 x_queue_selection_requests--;
9833 x_unqueue_events (display);
9834 }
9835 \f
9836 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
9837
9838 #if 0
9839 /* Time stamp of enter window event. This is only used by XTread_socket,
9840 but we have to put it out here, since static variables within functions
9841 sometimes don't work. */
9842
9843 static Time enter_timestamp;
9844 #endif
9845
9846 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
9847 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
9848 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
9849 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
9850
9851 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
9852 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
9853
9854 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
9855
9856 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
9857 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
9858
9859 static int temp_index;
9860 static short temp_buffer[100];
9861
9862 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
9863 on a particular display. */
9864
9865 struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
9866
9867 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
9868 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
9869 We try all the open displays, one by one.
9870 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
9871
9872 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
9873
9874 #define SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT(size) \
9875 do \
9876 { \
9877 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
9878 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event \
9879 = (XEvent *) xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
9880 bcopy (&event, f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event, size); \
9881 if (numchars >= 1) \
9882 { \
9883 bufp->kind = menu_bar_activate_event; \
9884 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f); \
9885 bufp->arg = Qnil; \
9886 bufp++; \
9887 count++; \
9888 numchars--; \
9889 } \
9890 } \
9891 while (0)
9892
9893 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XButtonEvent))
9894 #define SET_SAVED_KEY_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XKeyEvent))
9895
9896 /* Read events coming from the X server.
9897 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler.
9898 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
9899
9900 Events representing keys are stored in buffer BUFP,
9901 which can hold up to NUMCHARS characters.
9902 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
9903 thus pretending to be `read'.
9904
9905 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
9906
9907 static int
9908 XTread_socket (sd, bufp, numchars, expected)
9909 register int sd;
9910 /* register */ struct input_event *bufp;
9911 /* register */ int numchars;
9912 int expected;
9913 {
9914 int count = 0;
9915 int nbytes = 0;
9916 XEvent event;
9917 struct frame *f;
9918 int event_found = 0;
9919 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
9920 struct coding_system coding;
9921
9922 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
9923 {
9924 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
9925 return -1;
9926 }
9927
9928 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
9929 BLOCK_INPUT;
9930
9931 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
9932 input_signal_count++;
9933
9934 if (numchars <= 0)
9935 abort (); /* Don't think this happens. */
9936
9937 ++handling_signal;
9938
9939 /* Find the display we are supposed to read input for.
9940 It's the one communicating on descriptor SD. */
9941 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
9942 {
9943 #if 0 /* This ought to be unnecessary; let's verify it. */
9944 #ifdef FIOSNBIO
9945 /* If available, Xlib uses FIOSNBIO to make the socket
9946 non-blocking, and then looks for EWOULDBLOCK. If O_NDELAY is set,
9947 FIOSNBIO is ignored, and instead of signaling EWOULDBLOCK,
9948 a read returns 0, which Xlib interprets as equivalent to EPIPE. */
9949 fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_SETFL, 0);
9950 #endif /* ! defined (FIOSNBIO) */
9951 #endif
9952
9953 #if 0 /* This code can't be made to work, with multiple displays,
9954 and appears not to be used on any system any more.
9955 Also keyboard.c doesn't turn O_NDELAY on and off
9956 for X connections. */
9957 #ifndef SIGIO
9958 #ifndef HAVE_SELECT
9959 if (! (fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_GETFL, 0) & O_NDELAY))
9960 {
9961 extern int read_alarm_should_throw;
9962 read_alarm_should_throw = 1;
9963 XPeekEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
9964 read_alarm_should_throw = 0;
9965 }
9966 #endif /* HAVE_SELECT */
9967 #endif /* SIGIO */
9968 #endif
9969
9970 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
9971 if (dpyinfo == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
9972 {
9973 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
9974 x_io_error_quitter (dpyinfo->display);
9975 }
9976
9977 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
9978 BLOCK_INPUT;
9979 count += x_session_check_input (bufp, &numchars);
9980 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9981 #endif
9982
9983 while (XPending (dpyinfo->display))
9984 {
9985 XNextEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
9986
9987 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9988 {
9989 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
9990 XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
9991 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
9992 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
9993 was created. */
9994 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
9995 event.xclient.window);
9996 if (XFilterEvent (&event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None))
9997 break;
9998 }
9999 #endif
10000 event_found = 1;
10001
10002 switch (event.type)
10003 {
10004 case ClientMessage:
10005 {
10006 if (event.xclient.message_type
10007 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
10008 && event.xclient.format == 32)
10009 {
10010 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
10011 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
10012 {
10013 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
10014 could be the shell widget window
10015 if the frame has no title bar. */
10016 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
10017 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10018 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
10019 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
10020 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
10021 #endif
10022 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
10023 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
10024 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
10025 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
10026 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
10027 needed.
10028
10029 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
10030 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
10031 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
10032 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
10033 Emacs. */
10034
10035 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
10036 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
10037 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
10038 if (f)
10039 {
10040 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
10041 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
10042 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
10043 int count = x_catch_errors (d);
10044 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
10045 /* The ICCCM says this is
10046 the only valid choice. */
10047 RevertToParent,
10048 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
10049 /* This is needed to detect the error
10050 if there is an error. */
10051 XSync (d, False);
10052 x_uncatch_errors (d, count);
10053 }
10054 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
10055 #endif /* 0 */
10056 }
10057 else if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
10058 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
10059 {
10060 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
10061 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
10062 the session manager, who's looking for such a
10063 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
10064 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
10065 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
10066 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
10067 session manager and one for this. */
10068 if (numchars > 0
10069 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10070 && ! x_session_have_connection ()
10071 #endif
10072 )
10073 {
10074 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
10075 event.xclient.window);
10076 /* This is just so we only give real data once
10077 for a single Emacs process. */
10078 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
10079 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
10080 event.xclient.window,
10081 initial_argv, initial_argc);
10082 else if (f)
10083 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
10084 event.xclient.window,
10085 0, 0);
10086 }
10087 }
10088 else if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
10089 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
10090 {
10091 struct frame *f
10092 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
10093 event.xclient.window);
10094
10095 if (f)
10096 {
10097 if (numchars == 0)
10098 abort ();
10099
10100 bufp->kind = delete_window_event;
10101 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f);
10102 bufp->arg = Qnil;
10103 bufp++;
10104
10105 count += 1;
10106 numchars -= 1;
10107 }
10108 }
10109 }
10110 else if (event.xclient.message_type
10111 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
10112 {
10113 }
10114 else if (event.xclient.message_type
10115 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
10116 {
10117 int new_x, new_y;
10118 struct frame *f
10119 = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
10120
10121 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
10122 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
10123
10124 if (f)
10125 {
10126 f->output_data.x->left_pos = new_x;
10127 f->output_data.x->top_pos = new_y;
10128 }
10129 }
10130 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
10131 else if (event.xclient.message_type
10132 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
10133 {
10134 struct frame *f
10135 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
10136 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
10137 &event, NULL);
10138 }
10139 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
10140 else if ((event.xclient.message_type
10141 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
10142 || (event.xclient.message_type
10143 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
10144 {
10145 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
10146 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
10147 currently never do because we are interested in
10148 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
10149 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
10150 struct frame *f
10151 = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
10152 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
10153 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
10154 }
10155 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10156 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
10157 we construct an input_event. */
10158 else if (event.xclient.message_type
10159 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
10160 {
10161 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, bufp);
10162 ++bufp, ++count, --numchars;
10163 goto out;
10164 }
10165 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
10166 else
10167 goto OTHER;
10168 }
10169 break;
10170
10171 case SelectionNotify:
10172 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10173 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
10174 goto OTHER;
10175 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10176 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
10177 break;
10178
10179 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
10180 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10181 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
10182 goto OTHER;
10183 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10184 {
10185 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = (XSelectionClearEvent *) &event;
10186
10187 if (numchars == 0)
10188 abort ();
10189
10190 bufp->kind = selection_clear_event;
10191 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (bufp) = eventp->display;
10192 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (bufp) = eventp->selection;
10193 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (bufp) = eventp->time;
10194 bufp->frame_or_window = Qnil;
10195 bufp->arg = Qnil;
10196 bufp++;
10197
10198 count += 1;
10199 numchars -= 1;
10200 }
10201 break;
10202
10203 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
10204 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10205 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
10206 goto OTHER;
10207 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10208 if (x_queue_selection_requests)
10209 x_queue_event (x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner),
10210 &event);
10211 else
10212 {
10213 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp
10214 = (XSelectionRequestEvent *) &event;
10215
10216 if (numchars == 0)
10217 abort ();
10218
10219 bufp->kind = selection_request_event;
10220 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (bufp) = eventp->display;
10221 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (bufp) = eventp->requestor;
10222 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (bufp) = eventp->selection;
10223 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (bufp) = eventp->target;
10224 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (bufp) = eventp->property;
10225 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (bufp) = eventp->time;
10226 bufp->frame_or_window = Qnil;
10227 bufp->arg = Qnil;
10228 bufp++;
10229
10230 count += 1;
10231 numchars -= 1;
10232 }
10233 break;
10234
10235 case PropertyNotify:
10236 #if 0 /* This is plain wrong. In the case that we are waiting for a
10237 PropertyNotify used as an ACK in incremental selection
10238 transfer, the property will be on the receiver's window. */
10239 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
10240 if (!x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window))
10241 goto OTHER;
10242 #endif
10243 #endif
10244 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
10245 goto OTHER;
10246
10247 case ReparentNotify:
10248 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
10249 if (f)
10250 {
10251 int x, y;
10252 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
10253 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
10254 f->output_data.x->left_pos = x;
10255 f->output_data.x->top_pos = y;
10256 }
10257 break;
10258
10259 case Expose:
10260 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
10261 if (f)
10262 {
10263 x_check_fullscreen (f);
10264
10265 if (f->async_visible == 0)
10266 {
10267 f->async_visible = 1;
10268 f->async_iconified = 0;
10269 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
10270 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
10271 }
10272 else
10273 expose_frame (x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
10274 event.xexpose.window),
10275 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
10276 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
10277 }
10278 else
10279 {
10280 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10281 struct scroll_bar *bar;
10282 #endif
10283 #if defined USE_LUCID
10284 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
10285 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
10286 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
10287 {
10288 Widget widget
10289 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
10290 if (widget)
10291 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
10292 }
10293 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
10294
10295 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10296 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
10297 goto OTHER;
10298 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
10299 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.window);
10300
10301 if (bar)
10302 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
10303 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10304 else
10305 goto OTHER;
10306 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10307 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
10308 }
10309 break;
10310
10311 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
10312 source area was obscured or not
10313 available. */
10314 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
10315 if (f)
10316 {
10317 expose_frame (f,
10318 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
10319 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
10320 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
10321 }
10322 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10323 else
10324 goto OTHER;
10325 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10326 break;
10327
10328 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
10329 source area was completely
10330 available. */
10331 break;
10332
10333 case UnmapNotify:
10334 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
10335 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
10336 {
10337 tip_window = 0;
10338 redo_mouse_highlight ();
10339 }
10340
10341 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
10342 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
10343 the frame was deleted. */
10344 {
10345 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
10346 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
10347 display that won't ever be seen. */
10348 f->async_visible = 0;
10349 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
10350 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
10351 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
10352 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
10353 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
10354 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
10355 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
10356 {
10357 f->async_iconified = 1;
10358
10359 bufp->kind = iconify_event;
10360 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f);
10361 bufp->arg = Qnil;
10362 bufp++;
10363 count++;
10364 numchars--;
10365 }
10366 }
10367 goto OTHER;
10368
10369 case MapNotify:
10370 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
10371 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
10372 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
10373 goto OTHER;
10374
10375 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
10376 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
10377 frame is visible. */
10378 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
10379 if (f)
10380 {
10381 f->async_visible = 1;
10382 f->async_iconified = 0;
10383 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
10384
10385 /* wait_reading_process_input will notice this and update
10386 the frame's display structures. */
10387 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
10388
10389 if (f->iconified)
10390 {
10391 bufp->kind = deiconify_event;
10392 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f);
10393 bufp->arg = Qnil;
10394 bufp++;
10395 count++;
10396 numchars--;
10397 }
10398 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
10399 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
10400 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
10401 to update the frame titles
10402 in case this is the second frame. */
10403 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
10404 }
10405 goto OTHER;
10406
10407 case KeyPress:
10408
10409 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
10410 if (popup_activated_flag)
10411 goto OTHER;
10412
10413 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
10414
10415 if (!dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight))
10416 {
10417 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
10418 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
10419 }
10420
10421 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10422 if (f == 0)
10423 {
10424 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
10425 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
10426 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
10427 event.xkey.window);
10428 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
10429 {
10430 widget = XtParent (widget);
10431 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
10432 }
10433 }
10434 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
10435
10436 if (f != 0)
10437 {
10438 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
10439 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
10440 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
10441 his Emacs hang.
10442
10443 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
10444 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
10445 status_return even if the input is too long to
10446 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
10447 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
10448 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
10449 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
10450 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
10451 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
10452 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
10453 int modifiers;
10454 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
10455
10456 event.xkey.state
10457 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
10458 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
10459 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
10460
10461 /* This will have to go some day... */
10462
10463 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
10464 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
10465 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
10466 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
10467 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
10468 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
10469 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
10470
10471 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
10472 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
10473 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
10474 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
10475 not it is combined with Meta. */
10476 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
10477 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
10478
10479 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10480 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
10481 {
10482 Status status_return;
10483
10484 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
10485 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
10486 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
10487 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
10488 &status_return);
10489 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
10490 {
10491 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
10492 copy_bufptr = (char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
10493 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
10494 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
10495 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
10496 &status_return);
10497 }
10498 #ifdef X_HAVE_UTF8_STRING
10499 else if (status_return == XLookupKeySym)
10500 { /* Try again but with utf-8. */
10501 coding_system = Qutf_8;
10502 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
10503 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
10504 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
10505 &status_return);
10506 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
10507 {
10508 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
10509 copy_bufptr = (char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
10510 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
10511 &event.xkey,
10512 copy_bufptr,
10513 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
10514 &status_return);
10515 }
10516 }
10517 #endif
10518
10519 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
10520 break;
10521 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
10522 {
10523 keysym = NoSymbol;
10524 modifiers = 0;
10525 }
10526 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
10527 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
10528 abort ();
10529 }
10530 else
10531 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
10532 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
10533 &compose_status);
10534 #else
10535 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
10536 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
10537 &compose_status);
10538 #endif
10539
10540 orig_keysym = keysym;
10541
10542 if (numchars > 1)
10543 {
10544 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
10545 || keysym == XK_Delete
10546 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
10547 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
10548 #endif
10549 || (keysym >= XK_Kanji && keysym <= XK_Eisu_toggle)
10550 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
10551 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
10552 #ifdef HPUX
10553 /* This recognizes the "extended function keys".
10554 It seems there's no cleaner way.
10555 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling mode_switch
10556 incorrectly. */
10557 || ((unsigned) (keysym) >= XK_Select
10558 && (unsigned)(keysym) < XK_KP_Space)
10559 #endif
10560 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
10561 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
10562 #endif
10563 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
10564 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
10565 #endif
10566 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
10567 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
10568 #endif
10569 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
10570 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
10571 #endif
10572 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
10573 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
10574 #endif
10575 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
10576 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
10577 #endif
10578 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
10579 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
10580 #endif
10581 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
10582 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
10583 #endif
10584 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
10585 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
10586 #endif
10587 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
10588 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
10589 #endif
10590 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
10591 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
10592 #endif
10593 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
10594 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
10595 #endif
10596 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
10597 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
10598 #endif
10599 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
10600 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
10601 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
10602 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
10603 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
10604 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
10605 #ifndef HAVE_X11R5
10606 #ifdef XK_Mode_switch
10607 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) == XK_Mode_switch)
10608 #endif
10609 #ifdef XK_Num_Lock
10610 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) == XK_Num_Lock)
10611 #endif
10612 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R5 */
10613 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock to
10614 XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock doesn't have real
10615 modifiers but should be treated similarly
10616 to Mode_switch by Emacs. */
10617 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
10618 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) >= XK_ISO_Lock
10619 && (unsigned)(orig_keysym) <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
10620 #endif
10621 ))
10622 {
10623 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short))
10624 temp_index = 0;
10625 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = keysym;
10626 bufp->kind = non_ascii_keystroke;
10627 bufp->code = keysym;
10628 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f);
10629 bufp->arg = Qnil;
10630 bufp->modifiers
10631 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
10632 modifiers);
10633 bufp->timestamp = event.xkey.time;
10634 bufp++;
10635 count++;
10636 numchars--;
10637 }
10638 else if (numchars > nbytes)
10639 {
10640 register int i;
10641 register int c;
10642 int nchars, len;
10643
10644 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
10645 which depends on which X*LookupString function
10646 we used just above and the locale. */
10647 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
10648 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
10649 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
10650 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
10651 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
10652 gives us composition information. */
10653 coding.composing = COMPOSITION_DISABLED;
10654
10655 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
10656 {
10657 if (temp_index == (sizeof temp_buffer
10658 / sizeof (short)))
10659 temp_index = 0;
10660 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = copy_bufptr[i];
10661 }
10662
10663 {
10664 /* Decode the input data. */
10665 int require;
10666 unsigned char *p;
10667
10668 require = decoding_buffer_size (&coding, nbytes);
10669 p = (unsigned char *) alloca (require);
10670 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
10671 decode_coding (&coding, copy_bufptr, p,
10672 nbytes, require);
10673 nbytes = coding.produced;
10674 nchars = coding.produced_char;
10675 copy_bufptr = p;
10676 }
10677
10678 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
10679 character events. */
10680 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
10681 {
10682 if (nchars == nbytes)
10683 c = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
10684 else
10685 c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i,
10686 nbytes - i, len);
10687
10688 bufp->kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (c)
10689 ? ascii_keystroke
10690 : multibyte_char_keystroke);
10691 bufp->code = c;
10692 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f);
10693 bufp->arg = Qnil;
10694 bufp->modifiers
10695 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
10696 modifiers);
10697 bufp->timestamp = event.xkey.time;
10698 bufp++;
10699 }
10700
10701 count += nchars;
10702 numchars -= nchars;
10703
10704 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
10705 break;
10706 }
10707 else
10708 abort ();
10709 }
10710 else
10711 abort ();
10712 }
10713 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10714 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
10715 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
10716 client. */
10717 break;
10718 #else
10719 goto OTHER;
10720 #endif
10721
10722 case KeyRelease:
10723 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10724 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
10725 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
10726 client. */
10727 break;
10728 #else
10729 goto OTHER;
10730 #endif
10731
10732 /* Here's a possible interpretation of the whole
10733 FocusIn-EnterNotify FocusOut-LeaveNotify mess. If
10734 you get a FocusIn event, you have to get a FocusOut
10735 event before you relinquish the focus. If you
10736 haven't received a FocusIn event, then a mere
10737 LeaveNotify is enough to free you. */
10738
10739 case EnterNotify:
10740 {
10741 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
10742
10743 #if 0
10744 if (event.xcrossing.focus)
10745 {
10746 /* Avoid nasty pop/raise loops. */
10747 if (f && (!(f->auto_raise)
10748 || !(f->auto_lower)
10749 || (event.xcrossing.time - enter_timestamp) > 500))
10750 {
10751 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, f);
10752 enter_timestamp = event.xcrossing.time;
10753 }
10754 }
10755 else if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
10756 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
10757 #endif
10758
10759 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
10760 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
10761 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
10762 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
10763 goto OTHER;
10764 }
10765
10766 case FocusIn:
10767 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xfocus.window);
10768 if (event.xfocus.detail != NotifyPointer)
10769 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = f;
10770 if (f)
10771 {
10772 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, f);
10773
10774 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
10775 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
10776 if (GC_NILP (Vterminal_frame)
10777 && GC_CONSP (Vframe_list)
10778 && !GC_NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
10779 {
10780 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
10781 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f);
10782 bufp->arg = Qnil;
10783 ++bufp, ++count, --numchars;
10784 }
10785 }
10786
10787 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10788 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
10789 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
10790 #endif
10791
10792 goto OTHER;
10793
10794 case LeaveNotify:
10795 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
10796 if (f)
10797 {
10798 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
10799 {
10800 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
10801 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
10802 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
10803 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10804 }
10805
10806 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
10807 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
10808 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
10809 the mouse leaves the frame. */
10810 if (any_help_event_p)
10811 {
10812 Lisp_Object frame;
10813 int n;
10814
10815 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
10816 help_echo = Qnil;
10817 n = gen_help_event (bufp, numchars,
10818 Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
10819 bufp += n, count += n, numchars -= n;
10820 }
10821
10822 #if 0
10823 if (event.xcrossing.focus)
10824 x_mouse_leave (dpyinfo);
10825 else
10826 {
10827 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
10828 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10829 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
10830 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
10831 }
10832 #endif
10833 }
10834 goto OTHER;
10835
10836 case FocusOut:
10837 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xfocus.window);
10838 if (event.xfocus.detail != NotifyPointer
10839 && f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
10840 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10841 if (f && f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
10842 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
10843
10844 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10845 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
10846 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
10847 #endif
10848
10849 goto OTHER;
10850
10851 case MotionNotify:
10852 {
10853 previous_help_echo = help_echo;
10854 help_echo = help_echo_object = help_echo_window = Qnil;
10855 help_echo_pos = -1;
10856
10857 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
10858 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
10859 f = last_mouse_frame;
10860 else
10861 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
10862
10863 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
10864 {
10865 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10866 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
10867 }
10868
10869 if (f)
10870 {
10871
10872 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed. */
10873 if (mouse_autoselect_window)
10874 {
10875 Lisp_Object window;
10876 int area;
10877
10878 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
10879 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
10880 &area, 0);
10881
10882 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
10883 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
10884 will be selected iff it is active. */
10885 if (WINDOWP(window)
10886 && !EQ (window, last_window)
10887 && !EQ (window, selected_window)
10888 && numchars > 0)
10889 {
10890 bufp->kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
10891 bufp->frame_or_window = window;
10892 bufp->arg = Qnil;
10893 ++bufp, ++count, --numchars;
10894 }
10895
10896 last_window=window;
10897 }
10898 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
10899 }
10900 else
10901 {
10902 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10903 struct scroll_bar *bar
10904 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.window);
10905
10906 if (bar)
10907 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
10908 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
10909
10910 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
10911 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
10912 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
10913 }
10914
10915 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo
10916 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
10917 if (!NILP (help_echo)
10918 || !NILP (previous_help_echo))
10919 {
10920 Lisp_Object frame;
10921 int n;
10922
10923 if (f)
10924 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
10925 else
10926 frame = Qnil;
10927
10928 any_help_event_p = 1;
10929 n = gen_help_event (bufp, numchars, help_echo, frame,
10930 help_echo_window, help_echo_object,
10931 help_echo_pos);
10932 bufp += n, count += n, numchars -= n;
10933 }
10934
10935 goto OTHER;
10936 }
10937
10938 case ConfigureNotify:
10939 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
10940 if (f)
10941 {
10942 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10943 /* If there is a pending resize for fullscreen, don't
10944 do this one, the right one will come later.
10945 The toolkit version doesn't seem to need this, but we
10946 need to reset it below. */
10947 int dont_resize =
10948 ((f->output_data.x->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
10949 && FRAME_NEW_WIDTH (f) != 0);
10950 int rows = PIXEL_TO_CHAR_HEIGHT (f, event.xconfigure.height);
10951 int columns = PIXEL_TO_CHAR_WIDTH (f, event.xconfigure.width);
10952 if (dont_resize)
10953 goto OTHER;
10954
10955 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
10956 is called by the code that handles resizing
10957 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
10958
10959 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
10960 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
10961 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
10962 if (columns != f->width
10963 || rows != f->height
10964 || event.xconfigure.width != f->output_data.x->pixel_width
10965 || event.xconfigure.height != f->output_data.x->pixel_height)
10966 {
10967 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
10968 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
10969 cancel_mouse_face (f);
10970 }
10971 #endif
10972
10973 f->output_data.x->pixel_width = event.xconfigure.width;
10974 f->output_data.x->pixel_height = event.xconfigure.height;
10975
10976 /* What we have now is the position of Emacs's own window.
10977 Convert that to the position of the window manager window. */
10978 x_real_positions (f, &f->output_data.x->left_pos,
10979 &f->output_data.x->top_pos);
10980
10981 x_check_fullscreen_move(f);
10982 if (f->output_data.x->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
10983 f->output_data.x->want_fullscreen &=
10984 ~(FULLSCREEN_WAIT|FULLSCREEN_BOTH);
10985 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10986 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
10987 xic_set_statusarea (f);
10988 #endif
10989
10990 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
10991 {
10992 /* Since the WM decorations come below top_pos now,
10993 we must put them below top_pos in the future. */
10994 f->output_data.x->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
10995 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
10996 }
10997 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10998 /* Some window managers pass (0,0) as the location of
10999 the window, and the Motif event handler stores it
11000 in the emacs widget, which messes up Motif menus. */
11001 if (event.xconfigure.x == 0 && event.xconfigure.y == 0)
11002 {
11003 event.xconfigure.x = f->output_data.x->widget->core.x;
11004 event.xconfigure.y = f->output_data.x->widget->core.y;
11005 }
11006 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
11007 }
11008 goto OTHER;
11009
11010 case ButtonPress:
11011 case ButtonRelease:
11012 {
11013 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
11014 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
11015 struct input_event emacs_event;
11016 int tool_bar_p = 0;
11017
11018 emacs_event.kind = no_event;
11019 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
11020
11021 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
11022 && last_mouse_frame
11023 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
11024 f = last_mouse_frame;
11025 else
11026 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
11027
11028 if (f)
11029 {
11030 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
11031 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
11032 && XFASTINT (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)->height))
11033 {
11034 Lisp_Object window;
11035 int p, x, y;
11036
11037 x = event.xbutton.x;
11038 y = event.xbutton.y;
11039
11040 /* Set x and y. */
11041 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, &p, 1);
11042 if (EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window))
11043 {
11044 x_handle_tool_bar_click (f, &event.xbutton);
11045 tool_bar_p = 1;
11046 }
11047 }
11048
11049 if (!tool_bar_p)
11050 if (!dpyinfo->x_focus_frame
11051 || f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
11052 construct_mouse_click (&emacs_event, &event, f);
11053 }
11054 else
11055 {
11056 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
11057 struct scroll_bar *bar
11058 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.window);
11059
11060 if (bar)
11061 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &emacs_event);
11062 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
11063 }
11064
11065 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
11066 {
11067 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
11068 last_mouse_frame = f;
11069 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened
11070 before this event; any subsequent mouse-movement
11071 Emacs events should reflect only motion after
11072 the ButtonPress. */
11073 if (f != 0)
11074 f->mouse_moved = 0;
11075
11076 if (!tool_bar_p)
11077 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
11078 }
11079 else
11080 {
11081 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
11082 }
11083
11084 if (numchars >= 1 && emacs_event.kind != no_event)
11085 {
11086 bcopy (&emacs_event, bufp, sizeof (struct input_event));
11087 bufp++;
11088 count++;
11089 numchars--;
11090 }
11091
11092 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11093 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
11094 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
11095 don't pass it to Xt right now.
11096 Instead, save it away
11097 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
11098 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
11099 if (f && event.type == ButtonPress
11100 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
11101 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
11102 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
11103 && event.xbutton.x < f->output_data.x->pixel_width
11104 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
11105 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
11106 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
11107 {
11108 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
11109 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
11110 }
11111 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
11112 {
11113 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
11114 goto OTHER;
11115 }
11116
11117 #ifdef USE_MOTIF /* This should do not harm for Lucid,
11118 but I am trying to be cautious. */
11119 else if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
11120 {
11121 if (!NILP (last_mouse_press_frame))
11122 {
11123 f = XFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame);
11124 if (f->output_data.x)
11125 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
11126 }
11127 else
11128 goto OTHER;
11129 }
11130 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
11131 else
11132 goto OTHER;
11133 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
11134 }
11135 break;
11136
11137 case CirculateNotify:
11138 goto OTHER;
11139
11140 case CirculateRequest:
11141 goto OTHER;
11142
11143 case VisibilityNotify:
11144 goto OTHER;
11145
11146 case MappingNotify:
11147 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
11148 local cache. */
11149 switch (event.xmapping.request)
11150 {
11151 case MappingModifier:
11152 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
11153 /* This is meant to fall through. */
11154 case MappingKeyboard:
11155 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
11156 }
11157 goto OTHER;
11158
11159 default:
11160 OTHER:
11161 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11162 BLOCK_INPUT;
11163 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
11164 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
11165 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
11166 break;
11167 }
11168 }
11169 }
11170
11171 out:;
11172
11173 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
11174 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
11175 if (! event_found)
11176 {
11177 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
11178 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
11179 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
11180 x_noop_count++;
11181 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
11182 {
11183 x_noop_count=0;
11184
11185 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
11186 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
11187
11188 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
11189
11190 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
11191 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
11192 }
11193 }
11194
11195 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
11196 raise it now. */
11197 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
11198 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
11199 {
11200 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
11201 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
11202 }
11203
11204 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
11205 --handling_signal;
11206 return count;
11207 }
11208
11209
11210
11211 \f
11212 /***********************************************************************
11213 Text Cursor
11214 ***********************************************************************/
11215
11216 /* Notice when the text cursor of window W has been completely
11217 overwritten by a drawing operation that outputs glyphs in AREA
11218 starting at X0 and ending at X1 in the line starting at Y0 and
11219 ending at Y1. X coordinates are area-relative. X1 < 0 means all
11220 the rest of the line after X0 has been written. Y coordinates
11221 are window-relative. */
11222
11223 static void
11224 notice_overwritten_cursor (w, area, x0, x1, y0, y1)
11225 struct window *w;
11226 enum glyph_row_area area;
11227 int x0, y0, x1, y1;
11228 {
11229 if (area == TEXT_AREA && w->phys_cursor_on_p)
11230 {
11231 int cx0 = w->phys_cursor.x;
11232 int cx1 = cx0 + w->phys_cursor_width;
11233 int cy0 = w->phys_cursor.y;
11234 int cy1 = cy0 + w->phys_cursor_height;
11235
11236 if (x0 <= cx0 && (x1 < 0 || x1 >= cx1))
11237 {
11238 /* The cursor image will be completely removed from the
11239 screen if the output area intersects the cursor area in
11240 y-direction. When we draw in [y0 y1[, and some part of
11241 the cursor is at y < y0, that part must have been drawn
11242 before. When scrolling, the cursor is erased before
11243 actually scrolling, so we don't come here. When not
11244 scrolling, the rows above the old cursor row must have
11245 changed, and in this case these rows must have written
11246 over the cursor image.
11247
11248 Likewise if part of the cursor is below y1, with the
11249 exception of the cursor being in the first blank row at
11250 the buffer and window end because update_text_area
11251 doesn't draw that row. (Except when it does, but
11252 that's handled in update_text_area.) */
11253
11254 if (((y0 >= cy0 && y0 < cy1) || (y1 > cy0 && y1 < cy1))
11255 && w->current_matrix->rows[w->phys_cursor.vpos].displays_text_p)
11256 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
11257 }
11258 }
11259 }
11260
11261
11262 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
11263 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
11264 WHOLE_LINE_P non-zero means include the areas used for truncation
11265 mark display and alike in the clipping rectangle.
11266
11267 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
11268 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
11269 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
11270
11271 static void
11272 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc, whole_line_p)
11273 struct window *w;
11274 struct glyph_row *row;
11275 GC gc;
11276 int whole_line_p;
11277 {
11278 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
11279 XRectangle clip_rect;
11280 int window_x, window_y, window_width, window_height;
11281
11282 window_box (w, -1, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, &window_height);
11283
11284 clip_rect.x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, 0);
11285 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
11286 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
11287 clip_rect.width = window_width;
11288 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
11289
11290 /* If clipping to the whole line, including trunc marks, extend
11291 the rectangle to the left and increase its width. */
11292 if (whole_line_p)
11293 {
11294 clip_rect.x -= FRAME_X_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f);
11295 clip_rect.width += FRAME_X_FRINGE_WIDTH (f);
11296 }
11297
11298 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
11299 }
11300
11301
11302 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
11303
11304 static void
11305 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, row)
11306 struct window *w;
11307 struct glyph_row *row;
11308 {
11309 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
11310 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
11311 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
11312 int x, y, wd, h;
11313 XGCValues xgcv;
11314 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
11315 GC gc;
11316
11317 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates from window-relative
11318 coordinates. */
11319 x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
11320 y = (WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y)
11321 + row->ascent - w->phys_cursor_ascent);
11322 h = row->height - 1;
11323
11324 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
11325 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
11326 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
11327 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
11328 return;
11329
11330 /* Compute the width of the rectangle to draw. If on a stretch
11331 glyph, and `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a
11332 rectangle as wide as the glyph, but use a canonical character
11333 width instead. */
11334 wd = cursor_glyph->pixel_width - 1;
11335 if (cursor_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
11336 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
11337 wd = min (CANON_X_UNIT (f), wd);
11338 w->phys_cursor_width = wd;
11339
11340 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
11341 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
11342 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
11343 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
11344 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
11345 else
11346 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
11347 GCForeground, &xgcv);
11348 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
11349
11350 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
11351 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc, 0);
11352 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h);
11353 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
11354 }
11355
11356
11357 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
11358
11359 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
11360 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
11361 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
11362 --gerd. */
11363
11364 static void
11365 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, row, width, kind)
11366 struct window *w;
11367 struct glyph_row *row;
11368 int width;
11369 enum text_cursor_kinds kind;
11370 {
11371 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
11372 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
11373
11374 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
11375 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
11376 and mini-buffer. */
11377 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
11378 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
11379 return;
11380
11381 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
11382 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
11383 the bar might not be in the window. */
11384 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
11385 {
11386 struct glyph_row *row;
11387 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
11388 x_draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, row, DRAW_CURSOR);
11389 }
11390 else
11391 {
11392 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
11393 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
11394 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
11395 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
11396 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
11397 XGCValues xgcv;
11398
11399 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
11400 the bar cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
11401 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
11402 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
11403 that the glyph is legible. */
11404 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
11405 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
11406 else
11407 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
11408 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
11409
11410 if (gc)
11411 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
11412 else
11413 {
11414 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
11415 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
11416 }
11417
11418 if (width < 0)
11419 width = f->output_data.x->cursor_width;
11420 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
11421
11422 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
11423 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc, 0);
11424
11425 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
11426 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
11427 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
11428 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
11429 width, row->height);
11430 else
11431 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
11432 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
11433 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
11434 row->height - width),
11435 cursor_glyph->pixel_width,
11436 width);
11437
11438 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
11439 }
11440 }
11441
11442
11443 /* Clear the cursor of window W to background color, and mark the
11444 cursor as not shown. This is used when the text where the cursor
11445 is is about to be rewritten. */
11446
11447 static void
11448 x_clear_cursor (w)
11449 struct window *w;
11450 {
11451 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (XFRAME (w->frame)) && w->phys_cursor_on_p)
11452 x_update_window_cursor (w, 0);
11453 }
11454
11455
11456 /* Draw the cursor glyph of window W in glyph row ROW. See the
11457 comment of x_draw_glyphs for the meaning of HL. */
11458
11459 static void
11460 x_draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, row, hl)
11461 struct window *w;
11462 struct glyph_row *row;
11463 enum draw_glyphs_face hl;
11464 {
11465 /* If cursor hpos is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can
11466 happen in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area
11467 glyphs and mini-buffer. */
11468 if (w->phys_cursor.hpos < row->used[TEXT_AREA])
11469 {
11470 int on_p = w->phys_cursor_on_p;
11471
11472 x_draw_glyphs (w, w->phys_cursor.x, row, TEXT_AREA,
11473 w->phys_cursor.hpos, w->phys_cursor.hpos + 1,
11474 hl, 0);
11475 w->phys_cursor_on_p = on_p;
11476
11477 if (hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
11478 {
11479 struct glyph *cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
11480 if (cursor_glyph)
11481 {
11482 if (x_stretch_cursor_p)
11483 w->phys_cursor_width = cursor_glyph->pixel_width;
11484 else
11485 w->phys_cursor_width = min (CANON_X_UNIT (XFRAME (w->frame)),
11486 cursor_glyph->pixel_width);
11487 }
11488 }
11489
11490 /* When we erase the cursor, and ROW is overlapped by other
11491 rows, make sure that these overlapping parts of other rows
11492 are redrawn. */
11493 else if (hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT && row->overlapped_p)
11494 {
11495 if (row > w->current_matrix->rows
11496 && MATRIX_ROW_OVERLAPS_SUCC_P (row - 1))
11497 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row - 1, TEXT_AREA);
11498
11499 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < window_text_bottom_y (w)
11500 && MATRIX_ROW_OVERLAPS_PRED_P (row + 1))
11501 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row + 1, TEXT_AREA);
11502 }
11503 }
11504 }
11505
11506
11507 /* Erase the image of a cursor of window W from the screen. */
11508
11509 static void
11510 x_erase_phys_cursor (w)
11511 struct window *w;
11512 {
11513 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
11514 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
11515 int hpos = w->phys_cursor.hpos;
11516 int vpos = w->phys_cursor.vpos;
11517 int mouse_face_here_p = 0;
11518 struct glyph_matrix *active_glyphs = w->current_matrix;
11519 struct glyph_row *cursor_row;
11520 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
11521 enum draw_glyphs_face hl;
11522
11523 /* No cursor displayed or row invalidated => nothing to do on the
11524 screen. */
11525 if (w->phys_cursor_type == NO_CURSOR)
11526 goto mark_cursor_off;
11527
11528 /* VPOS >= active_glyphs->nrows means that window has been resized.
11529 Don't bother to erase the cursor. */
11530 if (vpos >= active_glyphs->nrows)
11531 goto mark_cursor_off;
11532
11533 /* If row containing cursor is marked invalid, there is nothing we
11534 can do. */
11535 cursor_row = MATRIX_ROW (active_glyphs, vpos);
11536 if (!cursor_row->enabled_p)
11537 goto mark_cursor_off;
11538
11539 /* If row is completely invisible, don't attempt to delete a cursor which
11540 isn't there. This can happen if cursor is at top of a window, and
11541 we switch to a buffer with a header line in that window. */
11542 if (cursor_row->visible_height <= 0)
11543 goto mark_cursor_off;
11544
11545 /* This can happen when the new row is shorter than the old one.
11546 In this case, either x_draw_glyphs or clear_end_of_line
11547 should have cleared the cursor. Note that we wouldn't be
11548 able to erase the cursor in this case because we don't have a
11549 cursor glyph at hand. */
11550 if (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= cursor_row->used[TEXT_AREA])
11551 goto mark_cursor_off;
11552
11553 /* If the cursor is in the mouse face area, redisplay that when
11554 we clear the cursor. */
11555 if (! NILP (dpyinfo->mouse_face_window)
11556 && w == XWINDOW (dpyinfo->mouse_face_window)
11557 && (vpos > dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
11558 || (vpos == dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
11559 && hpos >= dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col))
11560 && (vpos < dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
11561 || (vpos == dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
11562 && hpos < dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col))
11563 /* Don't redraw the cursor's spot in mouse face if it is at the
11564 end of a line (on a newline). The cursor appears there, but
11565 mouse highlighting does not. */
11566 && cursor_row->used[TEXT_AREA] > hpos)
11567 mouse_face_here_p = 1;
11568
11569 /* Maybe clear the display under the cursor. */
11570 if (w->phys_cursor_type == HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR)
11571 {
11572 int x;
11573 int header_line_height = WINDOW_DISPLAY_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
11574
11575 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
11576 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
11577 goto mark_cursor_off;
11578
11579 x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
11580
11581 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
11582 x,
11583 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
11584 cursor_row->y)),
11585 cursor_glyph->pixel_width,
11586 cursor_row->visible_height,
11587 False);
11588 }
11589
11590 /* Erase the cursor by redrawing the character underneath it. */
11591 if (mouse_face_here_p)
11592 hl = DRAW_MOUSE_FACE;
11593 else
11594 hl = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
11595 x_draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, cursor_row, hl);
11596
11597 mark_cursor_off:
11598 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
11599 w->phys_cursor_type = NO_CURSOR;
11600 }
11601
11602
11603 /* Non-zero if physical cursor of window W is within mouse face. */
11604
11605 static int
11606 cursor_in_mouse_face_p (w)
11607 struct window *w;
11608 {
11609 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
11610 int in_mouse_face = 0;
11611
11612 if (WINDOWP (dpyinfo->mouse_face_window)
11613 && XWINDOW (dpyinfo->mouse_face_window) == w)
11614 {
11615 int hpos = w->phys_cursor.hpos;
11616 int vpos = w->phys_cursor.vpos;
11617
11618 if (vpos >= dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
11619 && vpos <= dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
11620 && (vpos > dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
11621 || hpos >= dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col)
11622 && (vpos < dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
11623 || hpos < dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col
11624 || dpyinfo->mouse_face_past_end))
11625 in_mouse_face = 1;
11626 }
11627
11628 return in_mouse_face;
11629 }
11630
11631
11632 /* Display or clear cursor of window W. If ON is zero, clear the
11633 cursor. If it is non-zero, display the cursor. If ON is nonzero,
11634 where to put the cursor is specified by HPOS, VPOS, X and Y. */
11635
11636 void
11637 x_display_and_set_cursor (w, on, hpos, vpos, x, y)
11638 struct window *w;
11639 int on, hpos, vpos, x, y;
11640 {
11641 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
11642 int new_cursor_type;
11643 int new_cursor_width;
11644 struct glyph_matrix *current_glyphs;
11645 struct glyph_row *glyph_row;
11646 struct glyph *glyph;
11647 int cursor_non_selected;
11648
11649 /* This is pointless on invisible frames, and dangerous on garbaged
11650 windows and frames; in the latter case, the frame or window may
11651 be in the midst of changing its size, and x and y may be off the
11652 window. */
11653 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
11654 || FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f)
11655 || vpos >= w->current_matrix->nrows
11656 || hpos >= w->current_matrix->matrix_w)
11657 return;
11658
11659 /* If cursor is off and we want it off, return quickly. */
11660 if (!on && !w->phys_cursor_on_p)
11661 return;
11662
11663 current_glyphs = w->current_matrix;
11664 glyph_row = MATRIX_ROW (current_glyphs, vpos);
11665 glyph = glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + hpos;
11666
11667 /* If cursor row is not enabled, we don't really know where to
11668 display the cursor. */
11669 if (!glyph_row->enabled_p)
11670 {
11671 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
11672 return;
11673 }
11674
11675 xassert (interrupt_input_blocked);
11676
11677 /* Set new_cursor_type to the cursor we want to be displayed. In a
11678 mini-buffer window, we want the cursor only to appear if we are
11679 reading input from this window. For the selected window, we want
11680 the cursor type given by the frame parameter. If explicitly
11681 marked off, draw no cursor. In all other cases, we want a hollow
11682 box cursor. */
11683 cursor_non_selected
11684 = !NILP (Fbuffer_local_value (Qcursor_in_non_selected_windows,
11685 w->buffer));
11686 new_cursor_width = -1;
11687 if (cursor_in_echo_area
11688 && FRAME_HAS_MINIBUF_P (f)
11689 && EQ (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (f), echo_area_window))
11690 {
11691 if (w == XWINDOW (echo_area_window))
11692 new_cursor_type = FRAME_DESIRED_CURSOR (f);
11693 else if (cursor_non_selected)
11694 new_cursor_type = HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
11695 else
11696 new_cursor_type = NO_CURSOR;
11697 }
11698 else
11699 {
11700 if (f != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame
11701 || w != XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
11702 {
11703 if ((MINI_WINDOW_P (w) && minibuf_level == 0)
11704 || !cursor_non_selected
11705 || NILP (XBUFFER (w->buffer)->cursor_type))
11706 new_cursor_type = NO_CURSOR;
11707 else
11708 new_cursor_type = HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
11709 }
11710 else
11711 {
11712 struct buffer *b = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
11713
11714 if (EQ (b->cursor_type, Qt))
11715 new_cursor_type = FRAME_DESIRED_CURSOR (f);
11716 else
11717 new_cursor_type = x_specified_cursor_type (b->cursor_type,
11718 &new_cursor_width);
11719 if (w->cursor_off_p)
11720 {
11721 if (new_cursor_type == FILLED_BOX_CURSOR)
11722 new_cursor_type = HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
11723 else if (new_cursor_type == BAR_CURSOR && new_cursor_width > 1)
11724 new_cursor_width = 1;
11725 else
11726 new_cursor_type = NO_CURSOR;
11727 }
11728 }
11729 }
11730
11731 /* If cursor is currently being shown and we don't want it to be or
11732 it is in the wrong place, or the cursor type is not what we want,
11733 erase it. */
11734 if (w->phys_cursor_on_p
11735 && (!on
11736 || w->phys_cursor.x != x
11737 || w->phys_cursor.y != y
11738 || new_cursor_type != w->phys_cursor_type
11739 || (new_cursor_type == BAR_CURSOR
11740 && new_cursor_width != w->phys_cursor_width)))
11741 x_erase_phys_cursor (w);
11742
11743 /* If the cursor is now invisible and we want it to be visible,
11744 display it. */
11745 if (on && !w->phys_cursor_on_p)
11746 {
11747 w->phys_cursor_ascent = glyph_row->ascent;
11748 w->phys_cursor_height = glyph_row->height;
11749
11750 /* Set phys_cursor_.* before x_draw_.* is called because some
11751 of them may need the information. */
11752 w->phys_cursor.x = x;
11753 w->phys_cursor.y = glyph_row->y;
11754 w->phys_cursor.hpos = hpos;
11755 w->phys_cursor.vpos = vpos;
11756 w->phys_cursor_type = new_cursor_type;
11757 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
11758
11759 switch (new_cursor_type)
11760 {
11761 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
11762 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
11763 break;
11764
11765 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
11766 x_draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
11767 break;
11768
11769 case BAR_CURSOR:
11770 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, new_cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
11771 break;
11772
11773 case HBAR_CURSOR:
11774 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, new_cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
11775 break;
11776
11777 case NO_CURSOR:
11778 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
11779 break;
11780
11781 default:
11782 abort ();
11783 }
11784
11785 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
11786 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
11787 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
11788 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
11789 #endif
11790 }
11791
11792 #ifndef XFlush
11793 if (updating_frame != f)
11794 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
11795 #endif
11796 }
11797
11798
11799 /* Display the cursor on window W, or clear it. X and Y are window
11800 relative pixel coordinates. HPOS and VPOS are glyph matrix
11801 positions. If W is not the selected window, display a hollow
11802 cursor. ON non-zero means display the cursor at X, Y which
11803 correspond to HPOS, VPOS, otherwise it is cleared. */
11804
11805 void
11806 x_display_cursor (w, on, hpos, vpos, x, y)
11807 struct window *w;
11808 int on, hpos, vpos, x, y;
11809 {
11810 BLOCK_INPUT;
11811 x_display_and_set_cursor (w, on, hpos, vpos, x, y);
11812 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
11813 }
11814
11815
11816 /* Display the cursor on window W, or clear it, according to ON_P.
11817 Don't change the cursor's position. */
11818
11819 void
11820 x_update_cursor (f, on_p)
11821 struct frame *f;
11822 {
11823 x_update_cursor_in_window_tree (XWINDOW (f->root_window), on_p);
11824 }
11825
11826
11827 /* Call x_update_window_cursor with parameter ON_P on all leaf windows
11828 in the window tree rooted at W. */
11829
11830 static void
11831 x_update_cursor_in_window_tree (w, on_p)
11832 struct window *w;
11833 int on_p;
11834 {
11835 while (w)
11836 {
11837 if (!NILP (w->hchild))
11838 x_update_cursor_in_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->hchild), on_p);
11839 else if (!NILP (w->vchild))
11840 x_update_cursor_in_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->vchild), on_p);
11841 else
11842 x_update_window_cursor (w, on_p);
11843
11844 w = NILP (w->next) ? 0 : XWINDOW (w->next);
11845 }
11846 }
11847
11848
11849 /* Switch the display of W's cursor on or off, according to the value
11850 of ON. */
11851
11852 static void
11853 x_update_window_cursor (w, on)
11854 struct window *w;
11855 int on;
11856 {
11857 /* Don't update cursor in windows whose frame is in the process
11858 of being deleted. */
11859 if (w->current_matrix)
11860 {
11861 BLOCK_INPUT;
11862 x_display_and_set_cursor (w, on, w->phys_cursor.hpos, w->phys_cursor.vpos,
11863 w->phys_cursor.x, w->phys_cursor.y);
11864 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
11865 }
11866 }
11867
11868
11869
11870 \f
11871 /* Icons. */
11872
11873 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
11874
11875 int
11876 x_bitmap_icon (f, file)
11877 struct frame *f;
11878 Lisp_Object file;
11879 {
11880 int bitmap_id;
11881
11882 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
11883 return 1;
11884
11885 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap if any. */
11886 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
11887 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
11888 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
11889
11890 if (STRINGP (file))
11891 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
11892 else
11893 {
11894 /* Create the GNU bitmap if necessary. */
11895 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
11896 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id
11897 = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, gnu_bits,
11898 gnu_width, gnu_height);
11899
11900 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap,
11901 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
11902 As a result, the GNU bitmap is never freed.
11903 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
11904 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
11905
11906 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
11907 }
11908
11909 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
11910 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
11911
11912 return 0;
11913 }
11914
11915
11916 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
11917 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
11918
11919 int
11920 x_text_icon (f, icon_name)
11921 struct frame *f;
11922 char *icon_name;
11923 {
11924 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
11925 return 1;
11926
11927 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
11928 {
11929 XTextProperty text;
11930 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
11931 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
11932 text.format = 8;
11933 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
11934 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11935 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
11936 &text);
11937 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
11938 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), &text);
11939 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
11940 }
11941 #else /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
11942 XSetIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), icon_name);
11943 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
11944
11945 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
11946 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
11947 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
11948 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
11949
11950 return 0;
11951 }
11952 \f
11953 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
11954
11955 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
11956 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string. */
11957
11958 static Lisp_Object x_error_message_string;
11959
11960 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
11961 x_error_message_string. This is called from x_error_handler if
11962 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
11963
11964 static void
11965 x_error_catcher (display, error)
11966 Display *display;
11967 XErrorEvent *error;
11968 {
11969 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code,
11970 XSTRING (x_error_message_string)->data,
11971 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
11972 }
11973
11974 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
11975 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
11976 operating on.
11977
11978 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
11979 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
11980 stored in x_error_message_string.
11981
11982 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
11983 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
11984
11985 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
11986
11987 void x_check_errors ();
11988 static Lisp_Object x_catch_errors_unwind ();
11989
11990 int
11991 x_catch_errors (dpy)
11992 Display *dpy;
11993 {
11994 int count = specpdl_ptr - specpdl;
11995
11996 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
11997 XSync (dpy, False);
11998
11999 record_unwind_protect (x_catch_errors_unwind, x_error_message_string);
12000
12001 x_error_message_string = make_uninit_string (X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
12002 XSTRING (x_error_message_string)->data[0] = 0;
12003
12004 return count;
12005 }
12006
12007 /* Unbind the binding that we made to check for X errors. */
12008
12009 static Lisp_Object
12010 x_catch_errors_unwind (old_val)
12011 Lisp_Object old_val;
12012 {
12013 x_error_message_string = old_val;
12014 return Qnil;
12015 }
12016
12017 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
12018 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
12019 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
12020
12021 void
12022 x_check_errors (dpy, format)
12023 Display *dpy;
12024 char *format;
12025 {
12026 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
12027 XSync (dpy, False);
12028
12029 if (XSTRING (x_error_message_string)->data[0])
12030 error (format, XSTRING (x_error_message_string)->data);
12031 }
12032
12033 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
12034 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
12035
12036 int
12037 x_had_errors_p (dpy)
12038 Display *dpy;
12039 {
12040 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
12041 XSync (dpy, False);
12042
12043 return XSTRING (x_error_message_string)->data[0] != 0;
12044 }
12045
12046 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
12047
12048 void
12049 x_clear_errors (dpy)
12050 Display *dpy;
12051 {
12052 XSTRING (x_error_message_string)->data[0] = 0;
12053 }
12054
12055 /* Stop catching X protocol errors and let them make Emacs die.
12056 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors.
12057 COUNT should be the value that was returned by
12058 the corresponding call to x_catch_errors. */
12059
12060 void
12061 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count)
12062 Display *dpy;
12063 int count;
12064 {
12065 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
12066 }
12067
12068 #if 0
12069 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
12070 x_trace_wire ()
12071 {
12072 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
12073 }
12074 #endif /* ! 0 */
12075
12076 \f
12077 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
12078 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
12079 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
12080 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
12081 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
12082
12083 static SIGTYPE
12084 x_connection_signal (signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
12085 int signalnum; /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
12086 {
12087 #ifdef USG
12088 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
12089 must reestablish each time */
12090 signal (signalnum, x_connection_signal);
12091 #endif /* USG */
12092 }
12093
12094 \f
12095 /************************************************************************
12096 Handling X errors
12097 ************************************************************************/
12098
12099 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
12100
12101 static char *error_msg;
12102
12103 /* Function installed as fatal_error_signal_hook in
12104 x_connection_closed. Print the X error message, and exit normally,
12105 instead of dumping core when XtCloseDisplay fails. */
12106
12107 static void
12108 x_fatal_error_signal ()
12109 {
12110 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
12111 exit (70);
12112 }
12113
12114 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
12115 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
12116
12117 static SIGTYPE
12118 x_connection_closed (dpy, error_message)
12119 Display *dpy;
12120 char *error_message;
12121 {
12122 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
12123 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
12124 int count;
12125
12126 error_msg = (char *) alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
12127 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
12128 handling_signal = 0;
12129
12130 /* Prevent being called recursively because of an error condition
12131 below. Otherwise, we might end up with printing ``can't find per
12132 display information'' in the recursive call instead of printing
12133 the original message here. */
12134 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
12135
12136 /* We have to close the display to inform Xt that it doesn't
12137 exist anymore. If we don't, Xt will continue to wait for
12138 events from the display. As a consequence, a sequence of
12139
12140 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
12141 ...kill the new frame, so that we get an IO error...
12142 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
12143
12144 will indefinitely wait in Xt for events for display `:1', opened
12145 in the first class to make-frame-on-display.
12146
12147 Closing the display is reported to lead to a bus error on
12148 OpenWindows in certain situations. I suspect that is a bug
12149 in OpenWindows. I don't know how to cicumvent it here. */
12150
12151 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
12152 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display
12153 in the first place, so don't try to close it. */
12154 if (dpyinfo)
12155 {
12156 extern void (*fatal_error_signal_hook) P_ ((void));
12157 fatal_error_signal_hook = x_fatal_error_signal;
12158 XtCloseDisplay (dpy);
12159 fatal_error_signal_hook = NULL;
12160 }
12161 #endif
12162
12163 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
12164 if (dpyinfo)
12165 dpyinfo->display = 0;
12166
12167 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
12168 that are on the dead display. */
12169 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
12170 {
12171 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
12172 minibuf_frame
12173 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
12174 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
12175 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
12176 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
12177 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
12178 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
12179 }
12180
12181 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
12182 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
12183 for another frame that we need to delete. */
12184 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
12185 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
12186 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
12187 {
12188 /* Set this to t so that Fdelete_frame won't get confused
12189 trying to find a replacement. */
12190 FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame))->Vdefault_minibuffer_frame = Qt;
12191 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
12192 }
12193
12194 if (dpyinfo)
12195 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
12196
12197 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
12198
12199 if (x_display_list == 0)
12200 {
12201 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
12202 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
12203 exit (70);
12204 }
12205
12206 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
12207 #ifdef SIGIO
12208 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO));
12209 #endif
12210 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM));
12211 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
12212
12213 clear_waiting_for_input ();
12214 error ("%s", error_msg);
12215 }
12216
12217
12218 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
12219 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
12220 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
12221
12222 static void
12223 x_error_quitter (display, error)
12224 Display *display;
12225 XErrorEvent *error;
12226 {
12227 char buf[256], buf1[356];
12228
12229 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
12230 original error handler. */
12231
12232 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
12233 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
12234 buf, error->request_code);
12235 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
12236 }
12237
12238
12239 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
12240 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
12241
12242 static int
12243 x_error_handler (display, error)
12244 Display *display;
12245 XErrorEvent *error;
12246 {
12247 if (! NILP (x_error_message_string))
12248 x_error_catcher (display, error);
12249 else
12250 x_error_quitter (display, error);
12251 return 0;
12252 }
12253
12254 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
12255 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
12256 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
12257
12258 static int
12259 x_io_error_quitter (display)
12260 Display *display;
12261 {
12262 char buf[256];
12263
12264 sprintf (buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'", DisplayString (display));
12265 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
12266 return 0;
12267 }
12268 \f
12269 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
12270
12271 /* Give frame F the font named FONTNAME as its default font, and
12272 return the full name of that font. FONTNAME may be a wildcard
12273 pattern; in that case, we choose some font that fits the pattern.
12274 The return value shows which font we chose. */
12275
12276 Lisp_Object
12277 x_new_font (f, fontname)
12278 struct frame *f;
12279 register char *fontname;
12280 {
12281 struct font_info *fontp
12282 = FS_LOAD_FONT (f, 0, fontname, -1);
12283
12284 if (!fontp)
12285 return Qnil;
12286
12287 f->output_data.x->font = (XFontStruct *) (fontp->font);
12288 f->output_data.x->baseline_offset = fontp->baseline_offset;
12289 f->output_data.x->fontset = -1;
12290
12291 x_compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
12292
12293 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
12294 if (f->scroll_bar_pixel_width > 0)
12295 {
12296 int wid = FONT_WIDTH (f->output_data.x->font);
12297 f->scroll_bar_cols = (f->scroll_bar_pixel_width + wid-1) / wid;
12298 }
12299 else
12300 {
12301 int wid = FONT_WIDTH (f->output_data.x->font);
12302 f->scroll_bar_cols = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
12303 }
12304
12305 /* Now make the frame display the given font. */
12306 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
12307 {
12308 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
12309 f->output_data.x->font->fid);
12310 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->reverse_gc,
12311 f->output_data.x->font->fid);
12312 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->cursor_gc,
12313 f->output_data.x->font->fid);
12314
12315 frame_update_line_height (f);
12316
12317 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
12318 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
12319 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
12320 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
12321 x_set_window_size (f, 0, f->width, f->height);
12322 }
12323 else
12324 /* If we are setting a new frame's font for the first time,
12325 there are no faces yet, so this font's height is the line height. */
12326 f->output_data.x->line_height = FONT_HEIGHT (f->output_data.x->font);
12327
12328 return build_string (fontp->full_name);
12329 }
12330
12331 /* Give frame F the fontset named FONTSETNAME as its default font, and
12332 return the full name of that fontset. FONTSETNAME may be a wildcard
12333 pattern; in that case, we choose some fontset that fits the pattern.
12334 The return value shows which fontset we chose. */
12335
12336 Lisp_Object
12337 x_new_fontset (f, fontsetname)
12338 struct frame *f;
12339 char *fontsetname;
12340 {
12341 int fontset = fs_query_fontset (build_string (fontsetname), 0);
12342 Lisp_Object result;
12343
12344 if (fontset < 0)
12345 return Qnil;
12346
12347 if (f->output_data.x->fontset == fontset)
12348 /* This fontset is already set in frame F. There's nothing more
12349 to do. */
12350 return fontset_name (fontset);
12351
12352 result = x_new_font (f, (XSTRING (fontset_ascii (fontset))->data));
12353
12354 if (!STRINGP (result))
12355 /* Can't load ASCII font. */
12356 return Qnil;
12357
12358 /* Since x_new_font doesn't update any fontset information, do it now. */
12359 f->output_data.x->fontset = fontset;
12360
12361 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
12362 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
12363 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
12364 xic_set_xfontset (f, XSTRING (fontset_ascii (fontset))->data);
12365 #endif
12366
12367 return build_string (fontsetname);
12368 }
12369
12370 /* Compute actual fringe widths */
12371
12372 void
12373 x_compute_fringe_widths (f, redraw)
12374 struct frame *f;
12375 int redraw;
12376 {
12377 int o_left = f->output_data.x->left_fringe_width;
12378 int o_right = f->output_data.x->right_fringe_width;
12379 int o_cols = f->output_data.x->fringe_cols;
12380
12381 Lisp_Object left_fringe = Fassq (Qleft_fringe, f->param_alist);
12382 Lisp_Object right_fringe = Fassq (Qright_fringe, f->param_alist);
12383 int left_fringe_width, right_fringe_width;
12384
12385 if (!NILP (left_fringe))
12386 left_fringe = Fcdr (left_fringe);
12387 if (!NILP (right_fringe))
12388 right_fringe = Fcdr (right_fringe);
12389
12390 left_fringe_width = ((NILP (left_fringe) || !INTEGERP (left_fringe)) ? 8 :
12391 XINT (left_fringe));
12392 right_fringe_width = ((NILP (right_fringe) || !INTEGERP (right_fringe)) ? 8 :
12393 XINT (right_fringe));
12394
12395 if (left_fringe_width || right_fringe_width)
12396 {
12397 int left_wid = left_fringe_width >= 0 ? left_fringe_width : -left_fringe_width;
12398 int right_wid = right_fringe_width >= 0 ? right_fringe_width : -right_fringe_width;
12399 int conf_wid = left_wid + right_wid;
12400 int font_wid = FONT_WIDTH (f->output_data.x->font);
12401 int cols = (left_wid + right_wid + font_wid-1) / font_wid;
12402 int real_wid = cols * font_wid;
12403 if (left_wid && right_wid)
12404 {
12405 if (left_fringe_width < 0)
12406 {
12407 /* Left fringe width is fixed, adjust right fringe if necessary */
12408 f->output_data.x->left_fringe_width = left_wid;
12409 f->output_data.x->right_fringe_width = real_wid - left_wid;
12410 }
12411 else if (right_fringe_width < 0)
12412 {
12413 /* Right fringe width is fixed, adjust left fringe if necessary */
12414 f->output_data.x->left_fringe_width = real_wid - right_wid;
12415 f->output_data.x->right_fringe_width = right_wid;
12416 }
12417 else
12418 {
12419 /* Adjust both fringes with an equal amount.
12420 Note that we are doing integer arithmetic here, so don't
12421 lose a pixel if the total width is an odd number. */
12422 int fill = real_wid - conf_wid;
12423 f->output_data.x->left_fringe_width = left_wid + fill/2;
12424 f->output_data.x->right_fringe_width = right_wid + fill - fill/2;
12425 }
12426 }
12427 else if (left_fringe_width)
12428 {
12429 f->output_data.x->left_fringe_width = real_wid;
12430 f->output_data.x->right_fringe_width = 0;
12431 }
12432 else
12433 {
12434 f->output_data.x->left_fringe_width = 0;
12435 f->output_data.x->right_fringe_width = real_wid;
12436 }
12437 f->output_data.x->fringe_cols = cols;
12438 f->output_data.x->fringes_extra = real_wid;
12439 }
12440 else
12441 {
12442 f->output_data.x->left_fringe_width = 0;
12443 f->output_data.x->right_fringe_width = 0;
12444 f->output_data.x->fringe_cols = 0;
12445 f->output_data.x->fringes_extra = 0;
12446 }
12447
12448 if (redraw && FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
12449 if (o_left != f->output_data.x->left_fringe_width ||
12450 o_right != f->output_data.x->right_fringe_width ||
12451 o_cols != f->output_data.x->fringe_cols)
12452 redraw_frame (f);
12453 }
12454 \f
12455 /***********************************************************************
12456 X Input Methods
12457 ***********************************************************************/
12458
12459 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
12460
12461 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
12462
12463 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
12464 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
12465 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
12466
12467 static void
12468 xim_destroy_callback (xim, client_data, call_data)
12469 XIM xim;
12470 XPointer client_data;
12471 XPointer call_data;
12472 {
12473 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
12474 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
12475
12476 BLOCK_INPUT;
12477
12478 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
12479 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
12480 {
12481 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
12482 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
12483 {
12484 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
12485 if (FRAME_XIC_FONTSET (f))
12486 {
12487 XFreeFontSet (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_XIC_FONTSET (f));
12488 FRAME_XIC_FONTSET (f) = NULL;
12489 }
12490 }
12491 }
12492
12493 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
12494 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
12495 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
12496 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
12497 }
12498
12499 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
12500
12501 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
12502 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
12503
12504 static void
12505 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name)
12506 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
12507 char *resource_name;
12508 {
12509 #ifdef USE_XIM
12510 XIM xim;
12511
12512 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
12513 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
12514
12515 if (xim)
12516 {
12517 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
12518 XIMCallback destroy;
12519 #endif
12520
12521 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
12522 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
12523
12524 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
12525 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
12526 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
12527 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0. */
12528 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
12529 #endif
12530 }
12531
12532 #else /* not USE_XIM */
12533 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
12534 #endif /* not USE_XIM */
12535 }
12536
12537
12538 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
12539
12540 struct xim_inst_t
12541 {
12542 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
12543 char *resource_name;
12544 };
12545
12546 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
12547 server is available. DISPLAY is teh display of the XIM.
12548 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
12549 when the callback was registered. */
12550
12551 static void
12552 xim_instantiate_callback (display, client_data, call_data)
12553 Display *display;
12554 XPointer client_data;
12555 XPointer call_data;
12556 {
12557 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
12558 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
12559
12560 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
12561 if (dpyinfo->xim)
12562 return;
12563
12564 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
12565
12566 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
12567 as they have no XIC. */
12568 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
12569 {
12570 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
12571
12572 BLOCK_INPUT;
12573 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
12574 {
12575 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
12576
12577 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
12578 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
12579 {
12580 create_frame_xic (f);
12581 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
12582 xic_set_statusarea (f);
12583 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
12584 {
12585 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
12586 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
12587 }
12588 }
12589 }
12590
12591 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
12592 }
12593 }
12594
12595 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
12596
12597
12598 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
12599 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
12600 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
12601 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
12602
12603 static void
12604 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name)
12605 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
12606 char *resource_name;
12607 {
12608 #ifdef USE_XIM
12609 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
12610 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst;
12611 int len;
12612
12613 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
12614 xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct xim_inst_t));
12615 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
12616 len = strlen (resource_name);
12617 xim_inst->resource_name = (char *) xmalloc (len + 1);
12618 bcopy (resource_name, xim_inst->resource_name, len + 1);
12619 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
12620 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
12621 xim_instantiate_callback,
12622 /* Fixme: This is XPointer in
12623 XFree86 but (XPointer *) on
12624 Tru64, at least. */
12625 (XPointer) xim_inst);
12626 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
12627 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
12628 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
12629 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
12630
12631 #else /* not USE_XIM */
12632 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
12633 #endif /* not USE_XIM */
12634 }
12635
12636
12637 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
12638
12639 static void
12640 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo)
12641 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
12642 {
12643 #ifdef USE_XIM
12644 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
12645 if (dpyinfo->display)
12646 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
12647 NULL, EMACS_CLASS,
12648 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
12649 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
12650 if (dpyinfo->display)
12651 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
12652 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
12653 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
12654 #endif /* USE_XIM */
12655 }
12656
12657 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
12658
12659
12660 \f
12661 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
12662 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
12663
12664 void
12665 x_calc_absolute_position (f)
12666 struct frame *f;
12667 {
12668 Window child;
12669 int win_x = 0, win_y = 0;
12670 int flags = f->output_data.x->size_hint_flags;
12671 int this_window;
12672
12673 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
12674 is already for the top-left corner. */
12675 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
12676 return;
12677
12678 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
12679 this_window = XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget);
12680 #else
12681 this_window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
12682 #endif
12683
12684 /* Find the position of the outside upper-left corner of
12685 the inner window, with respect to the outer window.
12686 But do this only if we will need the results. */
12687 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
12688 {
12689 int count;
12690
12691 BLOCK_INPUT;
12692 count = x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
12693 while (1)
12694 {
12695 x_clear_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
12696 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
12697
12698 /* From-window, to-window. */
12699 this_window,
12700 f->output_data.x->parent_desc,
12701
12702 /* From-position, to-position. */
12703 0, 0, &win_x, &win_y,
12704
12705 /* Child of win. */
12706 &child);
12707 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)))
12708 {
12709 Window newroot, newparent = 0xdeadbeef;
12710 Window *newchildren;
12711 unsigned int nchildren;
12712
12713 if (! XQueryTree (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), this_window, &newroot,
12714 &newparent, &newchildren, &nchildren))
12715 break;
12716
12717 XFree ((char *) newchildren);
12718
12719 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = newparent;
12720 }
12721 else
12722 break;
12723 }
12724
12725 x_uncatch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), count);
12726 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
12727 }
12728
12729 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
12730 position that fits on the screen. */
12731 if (flags & XNegative)
12732 f->output_data.x->left_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width
12733 - 2 * f->output_data.x->border_width - win_x
12734 - PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
12735 + f->output_data.x->left_pos);
12736
12737 {
12738 int height = PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
12739
12740 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
12741 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
12742 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
12743
12744 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
12745 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
12746 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
12747 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
12748 is right, though.
12749
12750 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
12751 2000-12-01, gerd. */
12752
12753 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
12754 #endif
12755
12756 if (flags & YNegative)
12757 f->output_data.x->top_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height
12758 - 2 * f->output_data.x->border_width
12759 - win_y
12760 - height
12761 + f->output_data.x->top_pos);
12762 }
12763
12764 /* The left_pos and top_pos
12765 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
12766 so the flags should correspond. */
12767 f->output_data.x->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
12768 }
12769
12770 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
12771 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
12772 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
12773 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
12774 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
12775
12776 void
12777 x_set_offset (f, xoff, yoff, change_gravity)
12778 struct frame *f;
12779 register int xoff, yoff;
12780 int change_gravity;
12781 {
12782 int modified_top, modified_left;
12783
12784 if (change_gravity > 0)
12785 {
12786 f->output_data.x->top_pos = yoff;
12787 f->output_data.x->left_pos = xoff;
12788 f->output_data.x->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
12789 if (xoff < 0)
12790 f->output_data.x->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
12791 if (yoff < 0)
12792 f->output_data.x->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
12793 f->output_data.x->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
12794 }
12795 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
12796
12797 BLOCK_INPUT;
12798 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
12799
12800 modified_left = f->output_data.x->left_pos;
12801 modified_top = f->output_data.x->top_pos;
12802 #if 0 /* Running on psilocin (Debian), and displaying on the NCD X-terminal,
12803 this seems to be unnecessary and incorrect. rms, 4/17/97. */
12804 /* It is a mystery why we need to add the border_width here
12805 when the frame is already visible, but experiment says we do. */
12806 if (change_gravity != 0)
12807 {
12808 modified_left += f->output_data.x->border_width;
12809 modified_top += f->output_data.x->border_width;
12810 }
12811 #endif
12812
12813 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
12814 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
12815 modified_left, modified_top);
12816 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
12817 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
12818 modified_left, modified_top);
12819 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
12820 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
12821 }
12822
12823 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
12824 If so needed, resize the frame. */
12825 static void
12826 x_check_fullscreen (f)
12827 struct frame *f;
12828 {
12829 if (f->output_data.x->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
12830 {
12831 int width, height, ign;
12832
12833 x_real_positions (f, &f->output_data.x->left_pos,
12834 &f->output_data.x->top_pos);
12835
12836 x_fullscreen_adjust (f, &width, &height, &ign, &ign);
12837
12838 /* We do not need to move the window, it shall be taken care of
12839 when setting WM manager hints.
12840 If the frame is visible already, the position is checked by
12841 x_check_fullscreen_move. */
12842 if (f->width != width || f->height != height)
12843 {
12844 change_frame_size (f, height, width, 0, 1, 0);
12845 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
12846 cancel_mouse_face (f);
12847
12848 /* Wait for the change of frame size to occur */
12849 f->output_data.x->want_fullscreen |= FULLSCREEN_WAIT;
12850
12851 }
12852 }
12853 }
12854
12855 /* If frame parameters are set after the frame is mapped, we need to move
12856 the window. This is done in xfns.c.
12857 Some window managers moves the window to the right position, some
12858 moves the outer window manager window to the specified position.
12859 Here we check that we are in the right spot. If not, make a second
12860 move, assuming we are dealing with the second kind of window manager. */
12861 static void
12862 x_check_fullscreen_move (f)
12863 struct frame *f;
12864 {
12865 if (f->output_data.x->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_MOVE_WAIT)
12866 {
12867 int expect_top = f->output_data.x->top_pos;
12868 int expect_left = f->output_data.x->left_pos;
12869
12870 if (f->output_data.x->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
12871 expect_top = 0;
12872 if (f->output_data.x->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WIDTH)
12873 expect_left = 0;
12874
12875 if (expect_top != f->output_data.x->top_pos
12876 || expect_left != f->output_data.x->left_pos)
12877 x_set_offset (f, expect_left, expect_top, 1);
12878
12879 /* Just do this once */
12880 f->output_data.x->want_fullscreen &= ~FULLSCREEN_MOVE_WAIT;
12881 }
12882 }
12883
12884
12885 /* Calculate fullscreen size. Return in *TOP_POS and *LEFT_POS the
12886 wanted positions of the WM window (not emacs window).
12887 Return in *WIDTH and *HEIGHT the wanted width and height of Emacs
12888 window (FRAME_X_WINDOW).
12889 */
12890 void
12891 x_fullscreen_adjust (f, width, height, top_pos, left_pos)
12892 struct frame *f;
12893 int *width;
12894 int *height;
12895 int *top_pos;
12896 int *left_pos;
12897 {
12898 int newwidth = f->width, newheight = f->height;
12899
12900 *top_pos = f->output_data.x->top_pos;
12901 *left_pos = f->output_data.x->left_pos;
12902
12903 if (f->output_data.x->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
12904 {
12905 int ph;
12906
12907 ph = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height;
12908 newheight = PIXEL_TO_CHAR_HEIGHT (f, ph);
12909 ph = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, newheight)
12910 - f->output_data.x->y_pixels_diff;
12911 newheight = PIXEL_TO_CHAR_HEIGHT (f, ph);
12912 *top_pos = 0;
12913 }
12914
12915 if (f->output_data.x->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WIDTH)
12916 {
12917 int pw;
12918
12919 pw = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width;
12920 newwidth = PIXEL_TO_CHAR_WIDTH (f, pw);
12921 pw = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, newwidth)
12922 - f->output_data.x->x_pixels_diff;
12923 newwidth = PIXEL_TO_CHAR_WIDTH (f, pw);
12924 *left_pos = 0;
12925 }
12926
12927 *width = newwidth;
12928 *height = newheight;
12929 }
12930
12931
12932 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
12933 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
12934 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
12935 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
12936
12937 static void
12938 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
12939 struct frame *f;
12940 int change_gravity;
12941 int cols, rows;
12942 {
12943 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
12944
12945 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
12946 f->output_data.x->vertical_scroll_bar_extra
12947 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
12948 ? 0
12949 : FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) > 0
12950 ? FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
12951 : (FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FONT_WIDTH (f->output_data.x->font)));
12952
12953 x_compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
12954
12955 pixelwidth = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols);
12956 pixelheight = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows);
12957
12958 f->output_data.x->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
12959 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
12960
12961 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
12962 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
12963 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
12964
12965 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
12966 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
12967 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
12968 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
12969
12970 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
12971 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
12972 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
12973 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
12974 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
12975
12976 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
12977 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
12978 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
12979 PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
12980 PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
12981
12982 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
12983 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
12984 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
12985 we have to make sure to do it here. */
12986 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
12987
12988 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
12989 }
12990
12991
12992 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
12993 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
12994 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
12995 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
12996
12997 void
12998 x_set_window_size (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
12999 struct frame *f;
13000 int change_gravity;
13001 int cols, rows;
13002 {
13003 BLOCK_INPUT;
13004
13005 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
13006
13007 if (f->output_data.x->widget != NULL)
13008 {
13009 /* The x and y position of the widget is clobbered by the
13010 call to XtSetValues within EmacsFrameSetCharSize.
13011 This is a real kludge, but I don't understand Xt so I can't
13012 figure out a correct fix. Can anyone else tell me? -- rms. */
13013 int xpos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.x;
13014 int ypos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.y;
13015 EmacsFrameSetCharSize (f->output_data.x->edit_widget, cols, rows);
13016 f->output_data.x->widget->core.x = xpos;
13017 f->output_data.x->widget->core.y = ypos;
13018 }
13019 else
13020 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
13021
13022 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13023
13024 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
13025
13026 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13027
13028 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
13029 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
13030
13031 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
13032 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
13033 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
13034 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
13035 cancel_mouse_face (f);
13036
13037 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
13038 }
13039 \f
13040 /* Mouse warping. */
13041
13042 void
13043 x_set_mouse_position (f, x, y)
13044 struct frame *f;
13045 int x, y;
13046 {
13047 int pix_x, pix_y;
13048
13049 pix_x = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_COL (f, x) + FONT_WIDTH (f->output_data.x->font) / 2;
13050 pix_y = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_ROW (f, y) + f->output_data.x->line_height / 2;
13051
13052 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
13053 if (pix_x > PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
13054
13055 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
13056 if (pix_y > PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
13057
13058 BLOCK_INPUT;
13059
13060 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
13061 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
13062 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
13063 }
13064
13065 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
13066
13067 void
13068 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (f, pix_x, pix_y)
13069 struct frame *f;
13070 int pix_x, pix_y;
13071 {
13072 BLOCK_INPUT;
13073
13074 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
13075 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
13076 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
13077 }
13078 \f
13079 /* focus shifting, raising and lowering. */
13080
13081 void
13082 x_focus_on_frame (f)
13083 struct frame *f;
13084 {
13085 #if 0 /* This proves to be unpleasant. */
13086 x_raise_frame (f);
13087 #endif
13088 #if 0
13089 /* I don't think that the ICCCM allows programs to do things like this
13090 without the interaction of the window manager. Whatever you end up
13091 doing with this code, do it to x_unfocus_frame too. */
13092 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
13093 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
13094 #endif /* ! 0 */
13095 }
13096
13097 void
13098 x_unfocus_frame (f)
13099 struct frame *f;
13100 {
13101 #if 0
13102 /* Look at the remarks in x_focus_on_frame. */
13103 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_focus_frame == f)
13104 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), PointerRoot,
13105 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
13106 #endif /* ! 0 */
13107 }
13108
13109 /* Raise frame F. */
13110
13111 void
13112 x_raise_frame (f)
13113 struct frame *f;
13114 {
13115 if (f->async_visible)
13116 {
13117 BLOCK_INPUT;
13118 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
13119 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget));
13120 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13121 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
13122 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13123 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
13124 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
13125 }
13126 }
13127
13128 /* Lower frame F. */
13129
13130 void
13131 x_lower_frame (f)
13132 struct frame *f;
13133 {
13134 if (f->async_visible)
13135 {
13136 BLOCK_INPUT;
13137 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
13138 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget));
13139 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13140 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
13141 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13142 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
13143 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
13144 }
13145 }
13146
13147 static void
13148 XTframe_raise_lower (f, raise_flag)
13149 FRAME_PTR f;
13150 int raise_flag;
13151 {
13152 if (raise_flag)
13153 x_raise_frame (f);
13154 else
13155 x_lower_frame (f);
13156 }
13157 \f
13158 /* Change of visibility. */
13159
13160 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
13161 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
13162 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
13163 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
13164 but it will become visible later when the window manager
13165 finishes with it. */
13166
13167 void
13168 x_make_frame_visible (f)
13169 struct frame *f;
13170 {
13171 Lisp_Object type;
13172 int original_top, original_left;
13173 int retry_count = 2;
13174
13175 retry:
13176
13177 BLOCK_INPUT;
13178
13179 type = x_icon_type (f);
13180 if (!NILP (type))
13181 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
13182
13183 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
13184 {
13185 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
13186 call x_set_offset a second time
13187 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
13188 before the window gets really visible. */
13189 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
13190 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
13191 x_set_offset (f, f->output_data.x->left_pos, f->output_data.x->top_pos, 0);
13192
13193 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
13194
13195 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
13196 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
13197 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
13198 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
13199 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
13200 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13201 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
13202 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13203 #if 0 /* This seems to bring back scroll bars in the wrong places
13204 if the window configuration has changed. They seem
13205 to come back ok without this. */
13206 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
13207 XMapSubwindows (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
13208 #endif
13209 }
13210
13211 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
13212
13213 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
13214 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
13215 so that incoming events are handled. */
13216 {
13217 Lisp_Object frame;
13218 int count;
13219 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
13220 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
13221 will set it when they are handled. */
13222 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
13223
13224 original_left = f->output_data.x->left_pos;
13225 original_top = f->output_data.x->top_pos;
13226
13227 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
13228 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
13229
13230 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
13231
13232 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
13233 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
13234 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
13235 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
13236
13237 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
13238 because the window manager may choose the position
13239 and we don't want to override it. */
13240
13241 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
13242 && f->output_data.x->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
13243 && previously_visible)
13244 {
13245 Drawable rootw;
13246 int x, y;
13247 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
13248
13249 BLOCK_INPUT;
13250
13251 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
13252 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
13253 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
13254 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
13255 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
13256 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
13257 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
13258 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
13259 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
13260
13261 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
13262 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
13263 original_left, original_top);
13264
13265 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
13266 }
13267
13268 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
13269
13270 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
13271 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
13272 MapNotify at all.. */
13273 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
13274 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
13275 {
13276 /* Force processing of queued events. */
13277 x_sync (f);
13278
13279 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
13280 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
13281 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
13282 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
13283 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
13284 probably a bug. */
13285 if (input_polling_used ())
13286 {
13287 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
13288 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
13289 handler reset it. */
13290 extern void poll_for_input_1 P_ ((void));
13291 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
13292 poll_suppress_count = 1;
13293 poll_for_input_1 ();
13294 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
13295 }
13296
13297 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
13298 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
13299 }
13300
13301 /* 2000-09-28: In
13302
13303 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
13304 (iconify-frame f)
13305 (raise-frame f))
13306
13307 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
13308 FreeBSD, Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
13309 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
13310 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
13311
13312 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count > 0)
13313 goto retry;
13314 }
13315 }
13316
13317 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
13318
13319 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
13320
13321 void
13322 x_make_frame_invisible (f)
13323 struct frame *f;
13324 {
13325 Window window;
13326
13327 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
13328 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
13329 window = XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget);
13330 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13331 window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
13332 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13333
13334 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
13335 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
13336 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
13337
13338 #if 0/* This might add unreliability; I don't trust it -- rms. */
13339 if (! f->async_visible && ! f->async_iconified)
13340 return;
13341 #endif
13342
13343 BLOCK_INPUT;
13344
13345 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
13346 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
13347 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
13348 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
13349 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
13350 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
13351
13352 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
13353
13354 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
13355 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
13356 {
13357 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
13358 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
13359 }
13360 #else /* ! defined (HAVE_X11R4) */
13361
13362 /* Tell the window manager what we're going to do. */
13363 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
13364 {
13365 XEvent unmap;
13366
13367 unmap.xunmap.type = UnmapNotify;
13368 unmap.xunmap.window = window;
13369 unmap.xunmap.event = DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
13370 unmap.xunmap.from_configure = False;
13371 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
13372 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
13373 False,
13374 SubstructureRedirectMaskSubstructureNotifyMask,
13375 &unmap))
13376 {
13377 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
13378 error ("Can't notify window manager of withdrawal");
13379 }
13380 }
13381
13382 /* Unmap the window ourselves. Cheeky! */
13383 XUnmapWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window);
13384 #endif /* ! defined (HAVE_X11R4) */
13385
13386 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
13387 just by the event that we get from the server.
13388 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
13389 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
13390 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
13391 f->visible = 0;
13392 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
13393 f->async_visible = 0;
13394 f->async_iconified = 0;
13395
13396 x_sync (f);
13397
13398 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
13399 }
13400
13401 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
13402
13403 void
13404 x_iconify_frame (f)
13405 struct frame *f;
13406 {
13407 int result;
13408 Lisp_Object type;
13409
13410 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
13411 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
13412 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
13413
13414 if (f->async_iconified)
13415 return;
13416
13417 BLOCK_INPUT;
13418
13419 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
13420
13421 type = x_icon_type (f);
13422 if (!NILP (type))
13423 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
13424
13425 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
13426
13427 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
13428 {
13429 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
13430 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
13431 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
13432 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
13433 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
13434 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
13435 so we have to record it here. */
13436 f->iconified = 1;
13437 f->visible = 1;
13438 f->async_iconified = 1;
13439 f->async_visible = 0;
13440 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
13441 return;
13442 }
13443
13444 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
13445 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
13446 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
13447 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
13448
13449 if (!result)
13450 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
13451
13452 f->async_iconified = 1;
13453 f->async_visible = 0;
13454
13455
13456 BLOCK_INPUT;
13457 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
13458 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
13459 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13460
13461 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
13462 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
13463 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && !FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
13464 x_set_offset (f, f->output_data.x->left_pos, f->output_data.x->top_pos, 0);
13465
13466 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
13467 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
13468
13469 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
13470 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
13471 {
13472 XEvent message;
13473
13474 message.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
13475 message.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
13476 message.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
13477 message.xclient.format = 32;
13478 message.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
13479
13480 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
13481 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
13482 False,
13483 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
13484 &message))
13485 {
13486 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
13487 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
13488 }
13489 }
13490
13491 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
13492 IconicState. */
13493 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
13494
13495 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
13496 {
13497 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
13498 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
13499 }
13500
13501 f->async_iconified = 1;
13502 f->async_visible = 0;
13503
13504 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
13505 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
13506 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13507 }
13508
13509 \f
13510 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
13511
13512 void
13513 x_free_frame_resources (f)
13514 struct frame *f;
13515 {
13516 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
13517 Lisp_Object bar;
13518 struct scroll_bar *b;
13519
13520 BLOCK_INPUT;
13521
13522 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
13523 commands to the X server. */
13524 if (dpyinfo->display)
13525 {
13526 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
13527 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
13528
13529 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
13530 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
13531 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
13532 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
13533 toolkit scroll bars. */
13534 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
13535 {
13536 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
13537 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
13538 }
13539 #endif
13540
13541 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
13542 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
13543 free_frame_xic (f);
13544 #endif
13545
13546 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
13547 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
13548 {
13549 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
13550 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
13551 }
13552 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
13553 we are using a toolkit. */
13554 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
13555 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
13556
13557 free_frame_menubar (f);
13558 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13559 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
13560 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
13561 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13562
13563 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
13564 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->background_pixel);
13565 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
13566 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
13567 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
13568 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
13569
13570 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
13571 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
13572 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
13573 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
13574 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
13575 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
13576 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
13577 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
13578 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
13579 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
13580 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
13581 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
13582 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
13583 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
13584 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
13585
13586 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
13587 free_frame_faces (f);
13588
13589 x_free_gcs (f);
13590 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
13591 }
13592
13593 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event)
13594 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
13595
13596 xfree (f->output_data.x);
13597 f->output_data.x = NULL;
13598
13599 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
13600 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
13601 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
13602 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
13603 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
13604 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
13605
13606 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
13607 {
13608 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
13609 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
13610 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
13611 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
13612 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
13613 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
13614 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
13615 }
13616
13617 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
13618 }
13619
13620
13621 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
13622
13623 void
13624 x_destroy_window (f)
13625 struct frame *f;
13626 {
13627 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
13628
13629 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
13630 commands to the X server. */
13631 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
13632 x_free_frame_resources (f);
13633
13634 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
13635 }
13636
13637 \f
13638 /* Setting window manager hints. */
13639
13640 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
13641 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
13642 that the window now has.
13643 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
13644 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0). */
13645
13646 void
13647 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, flags, user_position)
13648 struct frame *f;
13649 long flags;
13650 int user_position;
13651 {
13652 XSizeHints size_hints;
13653
13654 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
13655 Arg al[2];
13656 int ac = 0;
13657 Dimension widget_width, widget_height;
13658 Window window = XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget);
13659 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13660 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
13661 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13662
13663 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
13664 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
13665
13666 size_hints.x = f->output_data.x->left_pos;
13667 size_hints.y = f->output_data.x->top_pos;
13668
13669 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
13670 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNwidth, &widget_width); ac++;
13671 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNheight, &widget_height); ac++;
13672 XtGetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, ac);
13673 size_hints.height = widget_height;
13674 size_hints.width = widget_width;
13675 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13676 size_hints.height = PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
13677 size_hints.width = PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
13678 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13679
13680 size_hints.width_inc = FONT_WIDTH (f->output_data.x->font);
13681 size_hints.height_inc = f->output_data.x->line_height;
13682 size_hints.max_width
13683 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width - CHAR_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
13684 size_hints.max_height
13685 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height - CHAR_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
13686
13687 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes.
13688
13689 (When we use the X toolkit, we don't do it here.
13690 Instead we copy the values that the widgets are using, below.) */
13691 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
13692 {
13693 int base_width, base_height;
13694 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
13695
13696 base_width = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
13697 base_height = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
13698
13699 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
13700
13701 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
13702 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
13703 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
13704 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
13705 zero-row, zero-column frame.
13706
13707 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
13708 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
13709 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
13710
13711 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
13712 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
13713 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
13714 size_hints.base_height = base_height;
13715 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
13716 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
13717 #else
13718 size_hints.min_width = base_width;
13719 size_hints.min_height = base_height;
13720 #endif
13721 }
13722
13723 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
13724 if (flags)
13725 {
13726 size_hints.flags |= flags;
13727 goto no_read;
13728 }
13729 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13730
13731 {
13732 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
13733 long supplied_return;
13734 int value;
13735
13736 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
13737 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
13738 &supplied_return);
13739 #else
13740 value = XGetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints);
13741 #endif
13742
13743 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
13744 size_hints.base_height = hints.base_height;
13745 size_hints.base_width = hints.base_width;
13746 size_hints.min_height = hints.min_height;
13747 size_hints.min_width = hints.min_width;
13748 #endif
13749
13750 if (flags)
13751 size_hints.flags |= flags;
13752 else
13753 {
13754 if (value == 0)
13755 hints.flags = 0;
13756 if (hints.flags & PSize)
13757 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
13758 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
13759 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
13760 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
13761 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
13762 if (hints.flags & USSize)
13763 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
13764 }
13765 }
13766
13767 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
13768 no_read:
13769 #endif
13770
13771 #ifdef PWinGravity
13772 size_hints.win_gravity = f->output_data.x->win_gravity;
13773 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
13774
13775 if (user_position)
13776 {
13777 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
13778 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
13779 }
13780 #endif /* PWinGravity */
13781
13782 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
13783 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
13784 #else
13785 XSetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
13786 #endif
13787 }
13788
13789 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
13790
13791 void
13792 x_wm_set_window_state (f, state)
13793 struct frame *f;
13794 int state;
13795 {
13796 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
13797 Arg al[1];
13798
13799 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
13800 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
13801 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13802 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
13803
13804 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
13805 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
13806
13807 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
13808 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13809 }
13810
13811 void
13812 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, pixmap_id)
13813 struct frame *f;
13814 int pixmap_id;
13815 {
13816 Pixmap icon_pixmap;
13817
13818 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
13819 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
13820 #endif
13821
13822 if (pixmap_id > 0)
13823 {
13824 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
13825 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
13826 }
13827 else
13828 {
13829 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon pixmap.
13830 The following line does it, only if no icon has yet been created,
13831 for some window managers. But with mwm it crashes.
13832 Some people say it should clear the IconPixmapHint bit in this case,
13833 but that doesn't work, and the X consortium said it isn't the
13834 right thing at all. Since there is no way to win,
13835 best to explicitly give up. */
13836 #if 0
13837 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = None;
13838 #else
13839 return;
13840 #endif
13841 }
13842
13843 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
13844
13845 {
13846 Arg al[1];
13847 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
13848 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
13849 }
13850
13851 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13852
13853 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPixmapHint;
13854 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
13855
13856 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13857 }
13858
13859 void
13860 x_wm_set_icon_position (f, icon_x, icon_y)
13861 struct frame *f;
13862 int icon_x, icon_y;
13863 {
13864 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
13865 Window window = XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget);
13866 #else
13867 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
13868 #endif
13869
13870 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
13871 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
13872 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
13873
13874 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
13875 }
13876
13877 \f
13878 /***********************************************************************
13879 Fonts
13880 ***********************************************************************/
13881
13882 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of font FONT_IDX of frame F. */
13883
13884 struct font_info *
13885 x_get_font_info (f, font_idx)
13886 FRAME_PTR f;
13887 int font_idx;
13888 {
13889 return (FRAME_X_FONT_TABLE (f) + font_idx);
13890 }
13891
13892
13893 /* Return a list of names of available fonts matching PATTERN on frame F.
13894
13895 If SIZE is > 0, it is the size (maximum bounds width) of fonts
13896 to be listed.
13897
13898 SIZE < 0 means include scalable fonts.
13899
13900 Frame F null means we have not yet created any frame on X, and
13901 consult the first display in x_display_list. MAXNAMES sets a limit
13902 on how many fonts to match. */
13903
13904 Lisp_Object
13905 x_list_fonts (f, pattern, size, maxnames)
13906 struct frame *f;
13907 Lisp_Object pattern;
13908 int size;
13909 int maxnames;
13910 {
13911 Lisp_Object list = Qnil, patterns, newlist = Qnil, key = Qnil;
13912 Lisp_Object tem, second_best;
13913 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo
13914 = f ? FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) : x_display_list;
13915 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
13916 int try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
13917 int count;
13918 int allow_scalable_fonts_p = 0;
13919
13920 if (size < 0)
13921 {
13922 allow_scalable_fonts_p = 1;
13923 size = 0;
13924 }
13925
13926 patterns = Fassoc (pattern, Valternate_fontname_alist);
13927 if (NILP (patterns))
13928 patterns = Fcons (pattern, Qnil);
13929
13930 if (maxnames == 1 && !size)
13931 /* We can return any single font matching PATTERN. */
13932 try_XLoadQueryFont = 1;
13933
13934 for (; CONSP (patterns); patterns = XCDR (patterns))
13935 {
13936 int num_fonts;
13937 char **names = NULL;
13938
13939 pattern = XCAR (patterns);
13940 /* See if we cached the result for this particular query.
13941 The cache is an alist of the form:
13942 ((((PATTERN . MAXNAMES) . SCALABLE) (FONTNAME . WIDTH) ...) ...) */
13943 tem = XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element);
13944 key = Fcons (Fcons (pattern, make_number (maxnames)),
13945 allow_scalable_fonts_p ? Qt : Qnil);
13946 list = Fassoc (key, tem);
13947 if (!NILP (list))
13948 {
13949 list = Fcdr_safe (list);
13950 /* We have a cashed list. Don't have to get the list again. */
13951 goto label_cached;
13952 }
13953
13954 /* At first, put PATTERN in the cache. */
13955
13956 BLOCK_INPUT;
13957 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
13958
13959 if (try_XLoadQueryFont)
13960 {
13961 XFontStruct *font;
13962 unsigned long value;
13963
13964 font = XLoadQueryFont (dpy, XSTRING (pattern)->data);
13965 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
13966 {
13967 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
13968 server. Let's just ignore it. */
13969 font = NULL;
13970 x_clear_errors (dpy);
13971 }
13972
13973 if (font
13974 && XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
13975 {
13976 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (dpy, (Atom) value);
13977 int len = strlen (name);
13978 char *tmp;
13979
13980 /* If DXPC (a Differential X Protocol Compressor)
13981 Ver.3.7 is running, XGetAtomName will return null
13982 string. We must avoid such a name. */
13983 if (len == 0)
13984 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
13985 else
13986 {
13987 num_fonts = 1;
13988 names = (char **) alloca (sizeof (char *));
13989 /* Some systems only allow alloca assigned to a
13990 simple var. */
13991 tmp = (char *) alloca (len + 1); names[0] = tmp;
13992 bcopy (name, names[0], len + 1);
13993 XFree (name);
13994 }
13995 }
13996 else
13997 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
13998
13999 if (font)
14000 XFreeFont (dpy, font);
14001 }
14002
14003 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
14004 {
14005 /* We try at least 10 fonts because XListFonts will return
14006 auto-scaled fonts at the head. */
14007 names = XListFonts (dpy, XSTRING (pattern)->data, max (maxnames, 10),
14008 &num_fonts);
14009 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
14010 {
14011 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
14012 server. Let's just ignore it. */
14013 names = NULL;
14014 x_clear_errors (dpy);
14015 }
14016 }
14017
14018 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
14019 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
14020
14021 if (names)
14022 {
14023 int i;
14024
14025 /* Make a list of all the fonts we got back.
14026 Store that in the font cache for the display. */
14027 for (i = 0; i < num_fonts; i++)
14028 {
14029 int width = 0;
14030 char *p = names[i];
14031 int average_width = -1, dashes = 0;
14032
14033 /* Count the number of dashes in NAMES[I]. If there are
14034 14 dashes, and the field value following 12th dash
14035 (AVERAGE_WIDTH) is 0, this is a auto-scaled font which
14036 is usually too ugly to be used for editing. Let's
14037 ignore it. */
14038 while (*p)
14039 if (*p++ == '-')
14040 {
14041 dashes++;
14042 if (dashes == 7) /* PIXEL_SIZE field */
14043 width = atoi (p);
14044 else if (dashes == 12) /* AVERAGE_WIDTH field */
14045 average_width = atoi (p);
14046 }
14047
14048 if (allow_scalable_fonts_p
14049 || dashes < 14 || average_width != 0)
14050 {
14051 tem = build_string (names[i]);
14052 if (NILP (Fassoc (tem, list)))
14053 {
14054 if (STRINGP (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp)
14055 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case
14056 (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp, names[i]))
14057 >= 0))
14058 /* We can set the value of PIXEL_SIZE to the
14059 width of this font. */
14060 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, make_number (width)), list);
14061 else
14062 /* For the moment, width is not known. */
14063 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, Qnil), list);
14064 }
14065 }
14066 }
14067
14068 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
14069 {
14070 BLOCK_INPUT;
14071 XFreeFontNames (names);
14072 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
14073 }
14074 }
14075
14076 /* Now store the result in the cache. */
14077 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
14078 Fcons (Fcons (key, list), XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
14079
14080 label_cached:
14081 if (NILP (list)) continue; /* Try the remaining alternatives. */
14082
14083 newlist = second_best = Qnil;
14084 /* Make a list of the fonts that have the right width. */
14085 for (; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
14086 {
14087 int found_size;
14088
14089 tem = XCAR (list);
14090
14091 if (!CONSP (tem) || NILP (XCAR (tem)))
14092 continue;
14093 if (!size)
14094 {
14095 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
14096 continue;
14097 }
14098
14099 if (!INTEGERP (XCDR (tem)))
14100 {
14101 /* Since we have not yet known the size of this font, we
14102 must try slow function call XLoadQueryFont. */
14103 XFontStruct *thisinfo;
14104
14105 BLOCK_INPUT;
14106 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
14107 thisinfo = XLoadQueryFont (dpy,
14108 XSTRING (XCAR (tem))->data);
14109 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
14110 {
14111 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
14112 server. Let's just ignore it. */
14113 thisinfo = NULL;
14114 x_clear_errors (dpy);
14115 }
14116 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
14117 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
14118
14119 if (thisinfo)
14120 {
14121 XSETCDR (tem,
14122 (thisinfo->min_bounds.width == 0
14123 ? make_number (0)
14124 : make_number (thisinfo->max_bounds.width)));
14125 BLOCK_INPUT;
14126 XFreeFont (dpy, thisinfo);
14127 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
14128 }
14129 else
14130 /* For unknown reason, the previous call of XListFont had
14131 returned a font which can't be opened. Record the size
14132 as 0 not to try to open it again. */
14133 XSETCDR (tem, make_number (0));
14134 }
14135
14136 found_size = XINT (XCDR (tem));
14137 if (found_size == size)
14138 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
14139 else if (found_size > 0)
14140 {
14141 if (NILP (second_best))
14142 second_best = tem;
14143 else if (found_size < size)
14144 {
14145 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
14146 || XINT (XCDR (second_best)) < found_size)
14147 second_best = tem;
14148 }
14149 else
14150 {
14151 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
14152 && XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > found_size)
14153 second_best = tem;
14154 }
14155 }
14156 }
14157 if (!NILP (newlist))
14158 break;
14159 else if (!NILP (second_best))
14160 {
14161 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (second_best), Qnil);
14162 break;
14163 }
14164 }
14165
14166 return newlist;
14167 }
14168
14169
14170 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
14171
14172 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
14173 font table. */
14174
14175 static void
14176 x_check_font (f, font)
14177 struct frame *f;
14178 XFontStruct *font;
14179 {
14180 int i;
14181 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
14182
14183 xassert (font != NULL);
14184
14185 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
14186 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
14187 && font == dpyinfo->font_table[i].font)
14188 break;
14189
14190 xassert (i < dpyinfo->n_fonts);
14191 }
14192
14193 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
14194
14195 /* Set *W to the minimum width, *H to the minimum font height of FONT.
14196 Note: There are (broken) X fonts out there with invalid XFontStruct
14197 min_bounds contents. For example, handa@etl.go.jp reports that
14198 "-adobe-courier-medium-r-normal--*-180-*-*-m-*-iso8859-1" fonts
14199 have font->min_bounds.width == 0. */
14200
14201 static INLINE void
14202 x_font_min_bounds (font, w, h)
14203 XFontStruct *font;
14204 int *w, *h;
14205 {
14206 *h = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
14207 *w = font->min_bounds.width;
14208
14209 /* Try to handle the case where FONT->min_bounds has invalid
14210 contents. Since the only font known to have invalid min_bounds
14211 is fixed-width, use max_bounds if min_bounds seems to be invalid. */
14212 if (*w <= 0)
14213 *w = font->max_bounds.width;
14214 }
14215
14216
14217 /* Compute the smallest character width and smallest font height over
14218 all fonts available on frame F. Set the members smallest_char_width
14219 and smallest_font_height in F's x_display_info structure to
14220 the values computed. Value is non-zero if smallest_font_height or
14221 smallest_char_width become smaller than they were before. */
14222
14223 static int
14224 x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f)
14225 struct frame *f;
14226 {
14227 int i;
14228 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
14229 XFontStruct *font;
14230 int old_width = dpyinfo->smallest_char_width;
14231 int old_height = dpyinfo->smallest_font_height;
14232
14233 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = 100000;
14234 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = 100000;
14235
14236 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
14237 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name)
14238 {
14239 struct font_info *fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
14240 int w, h;
14241
14242 font = (XFontStruct *) fontp->font;
14243 xassert (font != (XFontStruct *) ~0);
14244 x_font_min_bounds (font, &w, &h);
14245
14246 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = min (dpyinfo->smallest_font_height, h);
14247 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = min (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width, w);
14248 }
14249
14250 xassert (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width > 0
14251 && dpyinfo->smallest_font_height > 0);
14252
14253 return (dpyinfo->n_fonts == 1
14254 || dpyinfo->smallest_char_width < old_width
14255 || dpyinfo->smallest_font_height < old_height);
14256 }
14257
14258
14259 /* Load font named FONTNAME of the size SIZE for frame F, and return a
14260 pointer to the structure font_info while allocating it dynamically.
14261 If SIZE is 0, load any size of font.
14262 If loading is failed, return NULL. */
14263
14264 struct font_info *
14265 x_load_font (f, fontname, size)
14266 struct frame *f;
14267 register char *fontname;
14268 int size;
14269 {
14270 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
14271 Lisp_Object font_names;
14272 int count;
14273
14274 /* Get a list of all the fonts that match this name. Once we
14275 have a list of matching fonts, we compare them against the fonts
14276 we already have by comparing names. */
14277 font_names = x_list_fonts (f, build_string (fontname), size, 1);
14278
14279 if (!NILP (font_names))
14280 {
14281 Lisp_Object tail;
14282 int i;
14283
14284 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
14285 for (tail = font_names; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
14286 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
14287 && (!strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name,
14288 XSTRING (XCAR (tail))->data)
14289 || !strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name,
14290 XSTRING (XCAR (tail))->data)))
14291 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
14292 }
14293
14294 /* Load the font and add it to the table. */
14295 {
14296 char *full_name;
14297 XFontStruct *font;
14298 struct font_info *fontp;
14299 unsigned long value;
14300 int i;
14301
14302 /* If we have found fonts by x_list_font, load one of them. If
14303 not, we still try to load a font by the name given as FONTNAME
14304 because XListFonts (called in x_list_font) of some X server has
14305 a bug of not finding a font even if the font surely exists and
14306 is loadable by XLoadQueryFont. */
14307 if (size > 0 && !NILP (font_names))
14308 fontname = (char *) XSTRING (XCAR (font_names))->data;
14309
14310 BLOCK_INPUT;
14311 count = x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
14312 font = (XFontStruct *) XLoadQueryFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), fontname);
14313 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)))
14314 {
14315 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
14316 server. Let's just ignore it. */
14317 font = NULL;
14318 x_clear_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
14319 }
14320 x_uncatch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), count);
14321 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
14322 if (!font)
14323 return NULL;
14324
14325 /* Find a free slot in the font table. */
14326 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
14327 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name == NULL)
14328 break;
14329
14330 /* If no free slot found, maybe enlarge the font table. */
14331 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts
14332 && dpyinfo->n_fonts == dpyinfo->font_table_size)
14333 {
14334 int sz;
14335 dpyinfo->font_table_size = max (16, 2 * dpyinfo->font_table_size);
14336 sz = dpyinfo->font_table_size * sizeof *dpyinfo->font_table;
14337 dpyinfo->font_table
14338 = (struct font_info *) xrealloc (dpyinfo->font_table, sz);
14339 }
14340
14341 fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
14342 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts)
14343 ++dpyinfo->n_fonts;
14344
14345 /* Now fill in the slots of *FONTP. */
14346 BLOCK_INPUT;
14347 fontp->font = font;
14348 fontp->font_idx = i;
14349 fontp->name = (char *) xmalloc (strlen (fontname) + 1);
14350 bcopy (fontname, fontp->name, strlen (fontname) + 1);
14351
14352 /* Try to get the full name of FONT. Put it in FULL_NAME. */
14353 full_name = 0;
14354 if (XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
14355 {
14356 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), (Atom) value);
14357 char *p = name;
14358 int dashes = 0;
14359
14360 /* Count the number of dashes in the "full name".
14361 If it is too few, this isn't really the font's full name,
14362 so don't use it.
14363 In X11R4, the fonts did not come with their canonical names
14364 stored in them. */
14365 while (*p)
14366 {
14367 if (*p == '-')
14368 dashes++;
14369 p++;
14370 }
14371
14372 if (dashes >= 13)
14373 {
14374 full_name = (char *) xmalloc (p - name + 1);
14375 bcopy (name, full_name, p - name + 1);
14376 }
14377
14378 XFree (name);
14379 }
14380
14381 if (full_name != 0)
14382 fontp->full_name = full_name;
14383 else
14384 fontp->full_name = fontp->name;
14385
14386 fontp->size = font->max_bounds.width;
14387 fontp->height = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
14388
14389 if (NILP (font_names))
14390 {
14391 /* We come here because of a bug of XListFonts mentioned at
14392 the head of this block. Let's store this information in
14393 the cache for x_list_fonts. */
14394 Lisp_Object lispy_name = build_string (fontname);
14395 Lisp_Object lispy_full_name = build_string (fontp->full_name);
14396 Lisp_Object key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_name, make_number (256)),
14397 Qnil);
14398
14399 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
14400 Fcons (Fcons (key,
14401 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
14402 make_number (fontp->size)),
14403 Qnil)),
14404 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
14405 if (full_name)
14406 {
14407 key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name, make_number (256)),
14408 Qnil);
14409 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
14410 Fcons (Fcons (key,
14411 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
14412 make_number (fontp->size)),
14413 Qnil)),
14414 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
14415 }
14416 }
14417
14418 /* The slot `encoding' specifies how to map a character
14419 code-points (0x20..0x7F or 0x2020..0x7F7F) of each charset to
14420 the font code-points (0:0x20..0x7F, 1:0xA0..0xFF), or
14421 (0:0x2020..0x7F7F, 1:0xA0A0..0xFFFF, 3:0x20A0..0x7FFF,
14422 2:0xA020..0xFF7F). For the moment, we don't know which charset
14423 uses this font. So, we set information in fontp->encoding[1]
14424 which is never used by any charset. If mapping can't be
14425 decided, set FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED. */
14426 fontp->encoding[1]
14427 = (font->max_byte1 == 0
14428 /* 1-byte font */
14429 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
14430 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
14431 ? 0 /* 0x20..0x7F */
14432 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20..0xFF */
14433 : 1) /* 0xA0..0xFF */
14434 /* 2-byte font */
14435 : (font->min_byte1 < 0x80
14436 ? (font->max_byte1 < 0x80
14437 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
14438 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
14439 ? 0 /* 0x2020..0x7F7F */
14440 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x2020..0x7FFF */
14441 : 3) /* 0x20A0..0x7FFF */
14442 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20??..0xA0?? */
14443 : (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
14444 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
14445 ? 2 /* 0xA020..0xFF7F */
14446 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0xA020..0xFFFF */
14447 : 1))); /* 0xA0A0..0xFFFF */
14448
14449 fontp->baseline_offset
14450 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET, &value)
14451 ? (long) value : 0);
14452 fontp->relative_compose
14453 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE, &value)
14454 ? (long) value : 0);
14455 fontp->default_ascent
14456 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT, &value)
14457 ? (long) value : 0);
14458
14459 /* Set global flag fonts_changed_p to non-zero if the font loaded
14460 has a character with a smaller width than any other character
14461 before, or if the font loaded has a smaller height than any
14462 other font loaded before. If this happens, it will make a
14463 glyph matrix reallocation necessary. */
14464 fonts_changed_p |= x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f);
14465 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
14466 return fontp;
14467 }
14468 }
14469
14470
14471 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of a font named FONTNAME for
14472 frame F. If no such font is loaded, return NULL. */
14473
14474 struct font_info *
14475 x_query_font (f, fontname)
14476 struct frame *f;
14477 register char *fontname;
14478 {
14479 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
14480 int i;
14481
14482 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
14483 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
14484 && (!strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name, fontname)
14485 || !strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name, fontname)))
14486 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
14487 return NULL;
14488 }
14489
14490
14491 /* Find a CCL program for a font specified by FONTP, and set the member
14492 `encoder' of the structure. */
14493
14494 void
14495 x_find_ccl_program (fontp)
14496 struct font_info *fontp;
14497 {
14498 Lisp_Object list, elt;
14499
14500 elt = Qnil;
14501 for (list = Vfont_ccl_encoder_alist; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
14502 {
14503 elt = XCAR (list);
14504 if (CONSP (elt)
14505 && STRINGP (XCAR (elt))
14506 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->name)
14507 >= 0)
14508 || (fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->full_name)
14509 >= 0)))
14510 break;
14511 }
14512
14513 if (! NILP (list))
14514 {
14515 struct ccl_program *ccl
14516 = (struct ccl_program *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct ccl_program));
14517
14518 if (setup_ccl_program (ccl, XCDR (elt)) < 0)
14519 xfree (ccl);
14520 else
14521 fontp->font_encoder = ccl;
14522 }
14523 }
14524
14525
14526 \f
14527 /***********************************************************************
14528 Initialization
14529 ***********************************************************************/
14530
14531 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
14532 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
14533 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
14534 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
14535
14536 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
14537 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
14538 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
14539
14540 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
14541 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
14542 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
14543 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
14544 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
14545 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
14546 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
14547 };
14548 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
14549
14550 static int x_initialized;
14551
14552 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
14553 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
14554 the screen number from the server number. */
14555 static int
14556 same_x_server (name1, name2)
14557 char *name1, *name2;
14558 {
14559 int seen_colon = 0;
14560 unsigned char *system_name = XSTRING (Vsystem_name)->data;
14561 int system_name_length = strlen (system_name);
14562 int length_until_period = 0;
14563
14564 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
14565 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
14566 length_until_period++;
14567
14568 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
14569 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
14570 name1 += 4;
14571 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
14572 name2 += 4;
14573 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
14574 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
14575 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
14576 name1 += system_name_length;
14577 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
14578 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
14579 name2 += system_name_length;
14580 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
14581 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
14582 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
14583 name1 += length_until_period;
14584 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
14585 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
14586 name2 += length_until_period;
14587
14588 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
14589 {
14590 if (*name1 == ':')
14591 seen_colon++;
14592 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
14593 return 1;
14594 }
14595 return (seen_colon
14596 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
14597 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
14598 }
14599 #endif
14600
14601 struct x_display_info *
14602 x_term_init (display_name, xrm_option, resource_name)
14603 Lisp_Object display_name;
14604 char *xrm_option;
14605 char *resource_name;
14606 {
14607 int connection;
14608 Display *dpy;
14609 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
14610 XrmDatabase xrdb;
14611
14612 BLOCK_INPUT;
14613
14614 if (!x_initialized)
14615 {
14616 x_initialize ();
14617 x_initialized = 1;
14618 }
14619
14620 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
14621 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
14622 errors with X11R5:
14623 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
14624 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
14625 So let's not use it until R6. */
14626 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
14627 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
14628 #endif
14629
14630 {
14631 int argc = 0;
14632 char *argv[3];
14633
14634 argv[0] = "";
14635 argc = 1;
14636 if (xrm_option)
14637 {
14638 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
14639 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
14640 }
14641 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, XSTRING (display_name)->data,
14642 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
14643 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
14644 &argc, argv);
14645
14646 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
14647 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
14648 fixup_locale ();
14649 #endif
14650 }
14651
14652 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
14653 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5
14654 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
14655 #endif
14656 dpy = XOpenDisplay (XSTRING (display_name)->data);
14657 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
14658
14659 /* Detect failure. */
14660 if (dpy == 0)
14661 {
14662 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
14663 return 0;
14664 }
14665
14666 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
14667
14668 dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct x_display_info));
14669 bzero (dpyinfo, sizeof *dpyinfo);
14670
14671 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
14672 {
14673 struct x_display_info *share;
14674 Lisp_Object tail;
14675
14676 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
14677 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
14678 if (same_x_server (XSTRING (XCAR (XCAR (tail)))->data,
14679 XSTRING (display_name)->data))
14680 break;
14681 if (share)
14682 dpyinfo->kboard = share->kboard;
14683 else
14684 {
14685 dpyinfo->kboard = (KBOARD *) xmalloc (sizeof (KBOARD));
14686 init_kboard (dpyinfo->kboard);
14687 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
14688 {
14689 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
14690 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
14691 dpyinfo->kboard->Vsystem_key_alist
14692 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
14693 build_string (vendor ? vendor : ""));
14694 BLOCK_INPUT;
14695 }
14696
14697 dpyinfo->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
14698 all_kboards = dpyinfo->kboard;
14699 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
14700 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
14701 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
14702 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
14703 current_kboard = dpyinfo->kboard;
14704 }
14705 dpyinfo->kboard->reference_count++;
14706 }
14707 #endif
14708
14709 /* Put this display on the chain. */
14710 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
14711 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
14712
14713 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
14714 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
14715 x_display_name_list);
14716 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
14717
14718 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
14719
14720 #if 0
14721 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
14722 #endif /* ! 0 */
14723
14724 dpyinfo->x_id_name
14725 = (char *) xmalloc (STRING_BYTES (XSTRING (Vinvocation_name))
14726 + STRING_BYTES (XSTRING (Vsystem_name))
14727 + 2);
14728 sprintf (dpyinfo->x_id_name, "%s@%s",
14729 XSTRING (Vinvocation_name)->data, XSTRING (Vsystem_name)->data);
14730
14731 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
14732 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
14733
14734 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
14735 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
14736 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
14737
14738 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
14739 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
14740 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
14741 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
14742 #else
14743 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
14744 #endif
14745 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
14746 all versions. */
14747 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
14748
14749 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
14750 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
14751 select_visual (dpyinfo);
14752 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
14753 dpyinfo->height = HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
14754 dpyinfo->width = WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
14755 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
14756 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
14757 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
14758 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
14759 dpyinfo->font_table = NULL;
14760 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
14761 dpyinfo->font_table_size = 0;
14762 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
14763 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
14764 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
14765 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
14766 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
14767 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
14768 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
14769 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
14770 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
14771 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
14772 dpyinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
14773 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
14774 dpyinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
14775 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
14776 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
14777 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
14778 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
14779 dpyinfo->image_cache = make_image_cache ();
14780
14781 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
14782 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
14783 {
14784 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
14785 {
14786 Lisp_Object value;
14787 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
14788 build_string ("privateColormap"),
14789 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
14790 Qnil, Qnil);
14791 if (STRINGP (value)
14792 && (!strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "true")
14793 || !strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "on")))
14794 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
14795 }
14796 }
14797 else
14798 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
14799 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
14800
14801 {
14802 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
14803 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
14804 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
14805 dpyinfo->resy = pixels * 25.4 / mm;
14806 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
14807 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
14808 dpyinfo->resx = pixels * 25.4 / mm;
14809 }
14810
14811 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
14812 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_PROTOCOLS", False);
14813 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus
14814 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", False);
14815 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself
14816 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", False);
14817 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window
14818 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", False);
14819 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state
14820 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CHANGE_STATE", False);
14821 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied
14822 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", False);
14823 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved
14824 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_MOVED", False);
14825 dpyinfo->Xatom_editres
14826 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "Editres", False);
14827 dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD
14828 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "CLIPBOARD", False);
14829 dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP
14830 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TIMESTAMP", False);
14831 dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT
14832 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TEXT", False);
14833 dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT
14834 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "COMPOUND_TEXT", False);
14835 dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE
14836 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DELETE", False);
14837 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE
14838 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "MULTIPLE", False);
14839 dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR
14840 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "INCR", False);
14841 dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP
14842 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_EMACS_TMP_", False);
14843 dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS
14844 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TARGETS", False);
14845 dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL
14846 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "NULL", False);
14847 dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR
14848 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "ATOM_PAIR", False);
14849 /* For properties of font. */
14850 dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE
14851 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PIXEL_SIZE", False);
14852 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET
14853 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", False);
14854 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE
14855 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", False);
14856 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT
14857 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", False);
14858
14859 /* Ghostscript support. */
14860 dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PAGE", False);
14861 dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DONE", False);
14862
14863 dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "SCROLLBAR",
14864 False);
14865
14866 dpyinfo->cut_buffers_initialized = 0;
14867
14868 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
14869 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
14870
14871 {
14872 char null_bits[1];
14873
14874 null_bits[0] = 0x00;
14875
14876 dpyinfo->null_pixel
14877 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
14878 null_bits, 1, 1, (long) 0, (long) 0,
14879 1);
14880 }
14881
14882 {
14883 extern int gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height;
14884 extern char *gray_bitmap_bits;
14885 dpyinfo->gray
14886 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
14887 gray_bitmap_bits,
14888 gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height,
14889 (unsigned long) 1, (unsigned long) 0, 1);
14890 }
14891
14892 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
14893 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
14894 #endif
14895
14896 #ifdef subprocesses
14897 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
14898 if (connection != 0)
14899 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
14900 #endif
14901
14902 #ifndef F_SETOWN_BUG
14903 #ifdef F_SETOWN
14904 #ifdef F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG
14905 /* stdin is a socket here */
14906 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, -getpid ());
14907 #else /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
14908 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
14909 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
14910 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
14911 #endif /* F_SETOWN_BUG */
14912
14913 #ifdef SIGIO
14914 if (interrupt_input)
14915 init_sigio (connection);
14916 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
14917
14918 #ifdef USE_LUCID
14919 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5 /* It seems X11R4 lacks XtCvtStringToFont, and XPointer. */
14920 /* Make sure that we have a valid font for dialog boxes
14921 so that Xt does not crash. */
14922 {
14923 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
14924 XrmValue d, fr, to;
14925 Font font;
14926 int count;
14927
14928 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
14929 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
14930 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
14931 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
14932 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
14933 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
14934 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
14935 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
14936 abort ();
14937 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
14938 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
14939 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
14940 }
14941 #endif
14942 #endif
14943
14944 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
14945 for debugging X code. */
14946 {
14947 Lisp_Object value;
14948 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
14949 build_string ("synchronous"),
14950 build_string ("Synchronous"),
14951 Qnil, Qnil);
14952 if (STRINGP (value)
14953 && (!strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "true")
14954 || !strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "on")))
14955 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
14956 }
14957
14958 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
14959
14960 return dpyinfo;
14961 }
14962 \f
14963 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, assuming all frames are already gone,
14964 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
14965
14966 void
14967 x_delete_display (dpyinfo)
14968 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
14969 {
14970 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
14971
14972 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
14973 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
14974 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
14975 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
14976 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
14977 else
14978 {
14979 Lisp_Object tail;
14980
14981 tail = x_display_name_list;
14982 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
14983 {
14984 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
14985 {
14986 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
14987 break;
14988 }
14989 tail = XCDR (tail);
14990 }
14991 }
14992
14993 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
14994 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
14995
14996 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
14997 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
14998 else
14999 {
15000 struct x_display_info *tail;
15001
15002 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
15003 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
15004 tail->next = tail->next->next;
15005 }
15006
15007 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT /* I'm told Xt does this itself. */
15008 #ifndef AIX /* On AIX, XCloseDisplay calls this. */
15009 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
15010 #endif
15011 #endif
15012 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
15013 if (--dpyinfo->kboard->reference_count == 0)
15014 delete_kboard (dpyinfo->kboard);
15015 #endif
15016 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
15017 if (dpyinfo->xim)
15018 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
15019 #endif
15020
15021 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table);
15022 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
15023 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
15024 xfree (dpyinfo);
15025 }
15026
15027 \f
15028 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
15029
15030 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
15031 {
15032 x_produce_glyphs,
15033 x_write_glyphs,
15034 x_insert_glyphs,
15035 x_clear_end_of_line,
15036 x_scroll_run,
15037 x_after_update_window_line,
15038 x_update_window_begin,
15039 x_update_window_end,
15040 XTcursor_to,
15041 x_flush,
15042 x_clear_mouse_face,
15043 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
15044 x_fix_overlapping_area
15045 };
15046
15047 void
15048 x_initialize ()
15049 {
15050 rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
15051
15052 clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
15053 ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
15054 delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
15055 ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
15056 reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
15057 set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
15058 update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
15059 update_end_hook = x_update_end;
15060 set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
15061 read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
15062 frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
15063 mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
15064 frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
15065 frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
15066 set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
15067 condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
15068 redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
15069 judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
15070 estimate_mode_line_height_hook = x_estimate_mode_line_height;
15071
15072 scroll_region_ok = 1; /* we'll scroll partial frames */
15073 char_ins_del_ok = 1;
15074 line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* we'll just blt 'em */
15075 fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well */
15076 memory_below_frame = 0; /* we don't remember what scrolls
15077 off the bottom */
15078 baud_rate = 19200;
15079
15080 x_noop_count = 0;
15081 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
15082 any_help_event_p = 0;
15083
15084 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
15085 Fset_input_mode (Qt, Qnil, Qt, Qnil);
15086
15087 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
15088 XtToolkitInitialize ();
15089
15090 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
15091
15092 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
15093 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
15094 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
15095 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
15096 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
15097 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
15098 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
15099
15100 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
15101
15102 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
15103 every 0.1s. This is necessary because some widget sets use
15104 timeouts internally, for example the LessTif menu bar, or the
15105 Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timouts aren't processed, these
15106 widgets don't behave normally. */
15107 {
15108 EMACS_TIME interval;
15109 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval, 0, 100000);
15110 start_atimer (ATIMER_CONTINUOUS, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
15111 }
15112 #endif
15113
15114 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
15115 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
15116 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
15117 #endif
15118
15119 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
15120 original error handler. */
15121 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
15122 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
15123
15124 /* Disable Window Change signals; they are handled by X events. */
15125 #ifdef SIGWINCH
15126 signal (SIGWINCH, SIG_DFL);
15127 #endif /* SIGWINCH */
15128
15129 signal (SIGPIPE, x_connection_signal);
15130
15131 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
15132 x_session_initialize ();
15133 #endif
15134 }
15135
15136
15137 void
15138 syms_of_xterm ()
15139 {
15140 staticpro (&x_error_message_string);
15141 x_error_message_string = Qnil;
15142
15143 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
15144 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
15145
15146 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
15147 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
15148
15149 staticpro (&Qvendor_specific_keysyms);
15150 Qvendor_specific_keysyms = intern ("vendor-specific-keysyms");
15151
15152 staticpro (&Qutf_8);
15153 Qutf_8 = intern ("utf-8");
15154 staticpro (&Qlatin_1);
15155 Qlatin_1 = intern ("latin-1");
15156
15157 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
15158 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
15159
15160 help_echo = Qnil;
15161 staticpro (&help_echo);
15162 help_echo_object = Qnil;
15163 staticpro (&help_echo_object);
15164 help_echo_window = Qnil;
15165 staticpro (&help_echo_window);
15166 previous_help_echo = Qnil;
15167 staticpro (&previous_help_echo);
15168 help_echo_pos = -1;
15169
15170 DEFVAR_BOOL ("mouse-autoselect-window", &mouse_autoselect_window,
15171 doc: /* *Non-nil means autoselect window with mouse pointer. */);
15172 mouse_autoselect_window = 0;
15173
15174 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-stretch-cursor", &x_stretch_cursor_p,
15175 doc: /* *Non-nil means draw block cursor as wide as the glyph under it.
15176 For example, if a block cursor is over a tab, it will be drawn as
15177 wide as that tab on the display. */);
15178 x_stretch_cursor_p = 0;
15179
15180 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
15181 &x_use_underline_position_properties,
15182 doc: /* *Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
15183 nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
15184 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
15185 to 4.1, set this to nil. */);
15186 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
15187
15188 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", &Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
15189 doc: /* What X toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses.
15190 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use X toolkit scroll bars.
15191 Otherwise, value is a symbol describing the X toolkit. */);
15192 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
15193 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
15194 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("motif");
15195 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
15196 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw3d");
15197 #else
15198 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw");
15199 #endif
15200 #else
15201 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
15202 #endif
15203
15204 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
15205 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
15206
15207 Qmodifier_value = intern ("modifier-value");
15208 Qalt = intern ("alt");
15209 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
15210 Qhyper = intern ("hyper");
15211 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
15212 Qmeta = intern ("meta");
15213 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
15214 Qsuper = intern ("super");
15215 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
15216
15217 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", &Vx_alt_keysym,
15218 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
15219 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
15220 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
15221 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
15222 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
15223
15224 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", &Vx_hyper_keysym,
15225 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
15226 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
15227 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
15228 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
15229 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
15230
15231 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", &Vx_meta_keysym,
15232 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
15233 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
15234 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
15235 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
15236 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
15237
15238 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", &Vx_super_keysym,
15239 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
15240 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
15241 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
15242 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
15243 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
15244
15245 }
15246
15247 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */